blob: 6eb07b5558530317c59498d2ed10f1c55b23821e [file] [log] [blame]
Chris Lattner5b183d82006-11-10 05:03:26 +00001//===--- SemaExpr.cpp - Semantic Analysis for Expressions -----------------===//
2//
3// The LLVM Compiler Infrastructure
4//
Chris Lattner5b12ab82007-12-29 19:59:25 +00005// This file is distributed under the University of Illinois Open Source
6// License. See LICENSE.TXT for details.
Chris Lattner5b183d82006-11-10 05:03:26 +00007//
8//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
9//
10// This file implements semantic analysis for expressions.
11//
12//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
13
John McCall83024632010-08-25 22:03:47 +000014#include "clang/Sema/SemaInternal.h"
Douglas Gregorc3a6ade2010-08-12 20:07:10 +000015#include "clang/Sema/Initialization.h"
16#include "clang/Sema/Lookup.h"
17#include "clang/Sema/AnalysisBasedWarnings.h"
Chris Lattnercb6a3822006-11-10 06:20:45 +000018#include "clang/AST/ASTContext.h"
Douglas Gregord1702062010-04-29 00:18:15 +000019#include "clang/AST/CXXInheritance.h"
Daniel Dunbar6e8aa532008-08-11 05:35:13 +000020#include "clang/AST/DeclObjC.h"
Anders Carlsson029fc692009-08-26 22:59:12 +000021#include "clang/AST/DeclTemplate.h"
Douglas Gregor8a01b2a2010-09-11 20:24:53 +000022#include "clang/AST/EvaluatedExprVisitor.h"
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +000023#include "clang/AST/Expr.h"
Chris Lattneraa9c7ae2008-04-08 04:40:51 +000024#include "clang/AST/ExprCXX.h"
Steve Naroff021ca182008-05-29 21:12:08 +000025#include "clang/AST/ExprObjC.h"
Douglas Gregor5597ab42010-05-07 23:12:07 +000026#include "clang/AST/RecursiveASTVisitor.h"
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +000027#include "clang/AST/TypeLoc.h"
Anders Carlsson029fc692009-08-26 22:59:12 +000028#include "clang/Basic/PartialDiagnostic.h"
Steve Narofff2fb89e2007-03-13 20:29:44 +000029#include "clang/Basic/SourceManager.h"
Chris Lattner5b183d82006-11-10 05:03:26 +000030#include "clang/Basic/TargetInfo.h"
Anders Carlsson029fc692009-08-26 22:59:12 +000031#include "clang/Lex/LiteralSupport.h"
32#include "clang/Lex/Preprocessor.h"
John McCall8b0666c2010-08-20 18:27:03 +000033#include "clang/Sema/DeclSpec.h"
34#include "clang/Sema/Designator.h"
35#include "clang/Sema/Scope.h"
John McCallaab3e412010-08-25 08:40:02 +000036#include "clang/Sema/ScopeInfo.h"
John McCall8b0666c2010-08-20 18:27:03 +000037#include "clang/Sema/ParsedTemplate.h"
John McCallde6836a2010-08-24 07:21:54 +000038#include "clang/Sema/Template.h"
Chris Lattner5b183d82006-11-10 05:03:26 +000039using namespace clang;
John McCallaab3e412010-08-25 08:40:02 +000040using namespace sema;
Chris Lattner5b183d82006-11-10 05:03:26 +000041
David Chisnall9f57c292009-08-17 16:35:33 +000042
Douglas Gregor171c45a2009-02-18 21:56:37 +000043/// \brief Determine whether the use of this declaration is valid, and
44/// emit any corresponding diagnostics.
45///
46/// This routine diagnoses various problems with referencing
47/// declarations that can occur when using a declaration. For example,
48/// it might warn if a deprecated or unavailable declaration is being
49/// used, or produce an error (and return true) if a C++0x deleted
50/// function is being used.
51///
Chris Lattnerb7df3c62009-10-25 22:31:57 +000052/// If IgnoreDeprecated is set to true, this should not want about deprecated
53/// decls.
54///
Douglas Gregor171c45a2009-02-18 21:56:37 +000055/// \returns true if there was an error (this declaration cannot be
56/// referenced), false otherwise.
Chris Lattnerb7df3c62009-10-25 22:31:57 +000057///
John McCall28a6aea2009-11-04 02:18:39 +000058bool Sema::DiagnoseUseOfDecl(NamedDecl *D, SourceLocation Loc) {
Douglas Gregor5bb5e4a2010-10-12 23:32:35 +000059 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus && isa<FunctionDecl>(D)) {
60 // If there were any diagnostics suppressed by template argument deduction,
61 // emit them now.
62 llvm::DenseMap<Decl *, llvm::SmallVector<PartialDiagnosticAt, 1> >::iterator
63 Pos = SuppressedDiagnostics.find(D->getCanonicalDecl());
64 if (Pos != SuppressedDiagnostics.end()) {
65 llvm::SmallVectorImpl<PartialDiagnosticAt> &Suppressed = Pos->second;
66 for (unsigned I = 0, N = Suppressed.size(); I != N; ++I)
67 Diag(Suppressed[I].first, Suppressed[I].second);
68
69 // Clear out the list of suppressed diagnostics, so that we don't emit
70 // them again for this specialization. However, we don't remove this
71 // entry from the table, because we want to avoid ever emitting these
72 // diagnostics again.
73 Suppressed.clear();
74 }
75 }
76
Chris Lattner4bf74fd2009-02-15 22:43:40 +000077 // See if the decl is deprecated.
Benjamin Kramerbfac7dc2010-10-09 15:49:00 +000078 if (const DeprecatedAttr *DA = D->getAttr<DeprecatedAttr>())
79 EmitDeprecationWarning(D, DA->getMessage(), Loc);
Chris Lattner4bf74fd2009-02-15 22:43:40 +000080
Chris Lattnera27dd592009-10-25 17:21:40 +000081 // See if the decl is unavailable
Fariborz Jahanianc74073c2010-10-06 23:12:32 +000082 if (const UnavailableAttr *UA = D->getAttr<UnavailableAttr>()) {
83 if (UA->getMessage().empty())
84 Diag(Loc, diag::err_unavailable) << D->getDeclName();
85 else
86 Diag(Loc, diag::err_unavailable_message)
Benjamin Kramerbfac7dc2010-10-09 15:49:00 +000087 << D->getDeclName() << UA->getMessage();
Chris Lattnera27dd592009-10-25 17:21:40 +000088 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_unavailable_here) << 0;
89 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +000090
Douglas Gregor171c45a2009-02-18 21:56:37 +000091 // See if this is a deleted function.
Douglas Gregorde681d42009-02-24 04:26:15 +000092 if (FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(D)) {
Douglas Gregor171c45a2009-02-18 21:56:37 +000093 if (FD->isDeleted()) {
94 Diag(Loc, diag::err_deleted_function_use);
95 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_unavailable_here) << true;
96 return true;
97 }
Douglas Gregorde681d42009-02-24 04:26:15 +000098 }
Douglas Gregor171c45a2009-02-18 21:56:37 +000099
Anders Carlsson73067a02010-10-22 23:37:08 +0000100 // Warn if this is used but marked unused.
101 if (D->hasAttr<UnusedAttr>())
102 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_used_but_marked_unused) << D->getDeclName();
103
Douglas Gregor171c45a2009-02-18 21:56:37 +0000104 return false;
Chris Lattner4bf74fd2009-02-15 22:43:40 +0000105}
106
Fariborz Jahanian027b8862009-05-13 18:09:35 +0000107/// DiagnoseSentinelCalls - This routine checks on method dispatch calls
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000108/// (and other functions in future), which have been declared with sentinel
Fariborz Jahanian027b8862009-05-13 18:09:35 +0000109/// attribute. It warns if call does not have the sentinel argument.
110///
111void Sema::DiagnoseSentinelCalls(NamedDecl *D, SourceLocation Loc,
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000112 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs) {
Argyrios Kyrtzidisb4b64ca2009-06-30 02:34:44 +0000113 const SentinelAttr *attr = D->getAttr<SentinelAttr>();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000114 if (!attr)
Fariborz Jahanian9e877212009-05-13 23:20:50 +0000115 return;
Douglas Gregorc298ffc2010-04-22 16:44:27 +0000116
117 // FIXME: In C++0x, if any of the arguments are parameter pack
118 // expansions, we can't check for the sentinel now.
Fariborz Jahanian9e877212009-05-13 23:20:50 +0000119 int sentinelPos = attr->getSentinel();
120 int nullPos = attr->getNullPos();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000121
Mike Stump87c57ac2009-05-16 07:39:55 +0000122 // FIXME. ObjCMethodDecl and FunctionDecl need be derived from the same common
123 // base class. Then we won't be needing two versions of the same code.
Fariborz Jahanian9e877212009-05-13 23:20:50 +0000124 unsigned int i = 0;
Fariborz Jahanian4a528032009-05-14 18:00:00 +0000125 bool warnNotEnoughArgs = false;
126 int isMethod = 0;
127 if (ObjCMethodDecl *MD = dyn_cast<ObjCMethodDecl>(D)) {
128 // skip over named parameters.
129 ObjCMethodDecl::param_iterator P, E = MD->param_end();
130 for (P = MD->param_begin(); (P != E && i < NumArgs); ++P) {
131 if (nullPos)
132 --nullPos;
133 else
134 ++i;
135 }
136 warnNotEnoughArgs = (P != E || i >= NumArgs);
137 isMethod = 1;
Mike Stump12b8ce12009-08-04 21:02:39 +0000138 } else if (FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(D)) {
Fariborz Jahanian4a528032009-05-14 18:00:00 +0000139 // skip over named parameters.
140 ObjCMethodDecl::param_iterator P, E = FD->param_end();
141 for (P = FD->param_begin(); (P != E && i < NumArgs); ++P) {
142 if (nullPos)
143 --nullPos;
144 else
145 ++i;
146 }
147 warnNotEnoughArgs = (P != E || i >= NumArgs);
Mike Stump12b8ce12009-08-04 21:02:39 +0000148 } else if (VarDecl *V = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(D)) {
Fariborz Jahanian0aa5c452009-05-15 20:33:25 +0000149 // block or function pointer call.
150 QualType Ty = V->getType();
151 if (Ty->isBlockPointerType() || Ty->isFunctionPointerType()) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000152 const FunctionType *FT = Ty->isFunctionPointerType()
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +0000153 ? Ty->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType()->getAs<FunctionType>()
154 : Ty->getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType()->getAs<FunctionType>();
Fariborz Jahanian0aa5c452009-05-15 20:33:25 +0000155 if (const FunctionProtoType *Proto = dyn_cast<FunctionProtoType>(FT)) {
156 unsigned NumArgsInProto = Proto->getNumArgs();
157 unsigned k;
158 for (k = 0; (k != NumArgsInProto && i < NumArgs); k++) {
159 if (nullPos)
160 --nullPos;
161 else
162 ++i;
163 }
164 warnNotEnoughArgs = (k != NumArgsInProto || i >= NumArgs);
165 }
166 if (Ty->isBlockPointerType())
167 isMethod = 2;
Mike Stump12b8ce12009-08-04 21:02:39 +0000168 } else
Fariborz Jahanian0aa5c452009-05-15 20:33:25 +0000169 return;
Mike Stump12b8ce12009-08-04 21:02:39 +0000170 } else
Fariborz Jahanian4a528032009-05-14 18:00:00 +0000171 return;
172
173 if (warnNotEnoughArgs) {
Fariborz Jahanian9e877212009-05-13 23:20:50 +0000174 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_not_enough_argument) << D->getDeclName();
Fariborz Jahanian4a528032009-05-14 18:00:00 +0000175 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_sentinel_here) << isMethod;
Fariborz Jahanian9e877212009-05-13 23:20:50 +0000176 return;
177 }
178 int sentinel = i;
179 while (sentinelPos > 0 && i < NumArgs-1) {
180 --sentinelPos;
181 ++i;
182 }
183 if (sentinelPos > 0) {
184 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_not_enough_argument) << D->getDeclName();
Fariborz Jahanian4a528032009-05-14 18:00:00 +0000185 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_sentinel_here) << isMethod;
Fariborz Jahanian9e877212009-05-13 23:20:50 +0000186 return;
187 }
188 while (i < NumArgs-1) {
189 ++i;
190 ++sentinel;
191 }
192 Expr *sentinelExpr = Args[sentinel];
John McCall7ddbcf42010-05-06 23:53:00 +0000193 if (!sentinelExpr) return;
194 if (sentinelExpr->isTypeDependent()) return;
195 if (sentinelExpr->isValueDependent()) return;
Anders Carlssone981a8c2010-11-05 15:21:33 +0000196
197 // nullptr_t is always treated as null.
198 if (sentinelExpr->getType()->isNullPtrType()) return;
199
Fariborz Jahanianc0b0ced2010-07-14 16:37:51 +0000200 if (sentinelExpr->getType()->isAnyPointerType() &&
John McCall7ddbcf42010-05-06 23:53:00 +0000201 sentinelExpr->IgnoreParenCasts()->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
202 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull))
203 return;
204
205 // Unfortunately, __null has type 'int'.
206 if (isa<GNUNullExpr>(sentinelExpr)) return;
207
208 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_missing_sentinel) << isMethod;
209 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_sentinel_here) << isMethod;
Fariborz Jahanian027b8862009-05-13 18:09:35 +0000210}
211
Douglas Gregor87f95b02009-02-26 21:00:50 +0000212SourceRange Sema::getExprRange(ExprTy *E) const {
213 Expr *Ex = (Expr *)E;
214 return Ex? Ex->getSourceRange() : SourceRange();
215}
216
Chris Lattner513165e2008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000217//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
218// Standard Promotions and Conversions
219//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
220
Chris Lattner513165e2008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000221/// DefaultFunctionArrayConversion (C99 6.3.2.1p3, C99 6.3.2.1p4).
222void Sema::DefaultFunctionArrayConversion(Expr *&E) {
223 QualType Ty = E->getType();
224 assert(!Ty.isNull() && "DefaultFunctionArrayConversion - missing type");
225
Chris Lattner513165e2008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000226 if (Ty->isFunctionType())
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000227 ImpCastExprToType(E, Context.getPointerType(Ty),
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +0000228 CK_FunctionToPointerDecay);
Chris Lattner61f60a02008-07-25 21:33:13 +0000229 else if (Ty->isArrayType()) {
230 // In C90 mode, arrays only promote to pointers if the array expression is
231 // an lvalue. The relevant legalese is C90 6.2.2.1p3: "an lvalue that has
232 // type 'array of type' is converted to an expression that has type 'pointer
233 // to type'...". In C99 this was changed to: C99 6.3.2.1p3: "an expression
234 // that has type 'array of type' ...". The relevant change is "an lvalue"
235 // (C90) to "an expression" (C99).
Argyrios Kyrtzidis9321c742008-09-11 04:25:59 +0000236 //
237 // C++ 4.2p1:
238 // An lvalue or rvalue of type "array of N T" or "array of unknown bound of
239 // T" can be converted to an rvalue of type "pointer to T".
240 //
241 if (getLangOptions().C99 || getLangOptions().CPlusPlus ||
242 E->isLvalue(Context) == Expr::LV_Valid)
Anders Carlsson8fc489d2009-08-07 23:48:20 +0000243 ImpCastExprToType(E, Context.getArrayDecayedType(Ty),
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +0000244 CK_ArrayToPointerDecay);
Chris Lattner61f60a02008-07-25 21:33:13 +0000245 }
Chris Lattner513165e2008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000246}
247
Douglas Gregorb92a1562010-02-03 00:27:59 +0000248void Sema::DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(Expr *&E) {
249 DefaultFunctionArrayConversion(E);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +0000250
Douglas Gregorb92a1562010-02-03 00:27:59 +0000251 QualType Ty = E->getType();
252 assert(!Ty.isNull() && "DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion - missing type");
253 if (!Ty->isDependentType() && Ty.hasQualifiers() &&
254 (!getLangOptions().CPlusPlus || !Ty->isRecordType()) &&
255 E->isLvalue(Context) == Expr::LV_Valid) {
256 // C++ [conv.lval]p1:
257 // [...] If T is a non-class type, the type of the rvalue is the
258 // cv-unqualified version of T. Otherwise, the type of the
259 // rvalue is T
260 //
261 // C99 6.3.2.1p2:
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +0000262 // If the lvalue has qualified type, the value has the unqualified
263 // version of the type of the lvalue; otherwise, the value has the
Douglas Gregorb92a1562010-02-03 00:27:59 +0000264 // type of the lvalue.
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +0000265 ImpCastExprToType(E, Ty.getUnqualifiedType(), CK_NoOp);
Douglas Gregorb92a1562010-02-03 00:27:59 +0000266 }
267}
268
269
Chris Lattner513165e2008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000270/// UsualUnaryConversions - Performs various conversions that are common to most
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000271/// operators (C99 6.3). The conversions of array and function types are
Chris Lattner513165e2008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000272/// sometimes surpressed. For example, the array->pointer conversion doesn't
273/// apply if the array is an argument to the sizeof or address (&) operators.
274/// In these instances, this routine should *not* be called.
275Expr *Sema::UsualUnaryConversions(Expr *&Expr) {
276 QualType Ty = Expr->getType();
277 assert(!Ty.isNull() && "UsualUnaryConversions - missing type");
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000278
Douglas Gregor8d9c5092009-05-01 20:41:21 +0000279 // C99 6.3.1.1p2:
280 //
281 // The following may be used in an expression wherever an int or
282 // unsigned int may be used:
283 // - an object or expression with an integer type whose integer
284 // conversion rank is less than or equal to the rank of int
285 // and unsigned int.
286 // - A bit-field of type _Bool, int, signed int, or unsigned int.
287 //
288 // If an int can represent all values of the original type, the
289 // value is converted to an int; otherwise, it is converted to an
290 // unsigned int. These are called the integer promotions. All
291 // other types are unchanged by the integer promotions.
Eli Friedman629ffb92009-08-20 04:21:42 +0000292 QualType PTy = Context.isPromotableBitField(Expr);
293 if (!PTy.isNull()) {
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +0000294 ImpCastExprToType(Expr, PTy, CK_IntegralCast);
Eli Friedman629ffb92009-08-20 04:21:42 +0000295 return Expr;
296 }
Douglas Gregor8d9c5092009-05-01 20:41:21 +0000297 if (Ty->isPromotableIntegerType()) {
Eli Friedman5ae98ee2009-08-19 07:44:53 +0000298 QualType PT = Context.getPromotedIntegerType(Ty);
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +0000299 ImpCastExprToType(Expr, PT, CK_IntegralCast);
Douglas Gregor8d9c5092009-05-01 20:41:21 +0000300 return Expr;
Eli Friedman629ffb92009-08-20 04:21:42 +0000301 }
302
Douglas Gregorb92a1562010-02-03 00:27:59 +0000303 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(Expr);
Chris Lattner513165e2008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000304 return Expr;
305}
306
Chris Lattner2ce500f2008-07-25 22:25:12 +0000307/// DefaultArgumentPromotion (C99 6.5.2.2p6). Used for function calls that
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000308/// do not have a prototype. Arguments that have type float are promoted to
Chris Lattner2ce500f2008-07-25 22:25:12 +0000309/// double. All other argument types are converted by UsualUnaryConversions().
310void Sema::DefaultArgumentPromotion(Expr *&Expr) {
311 QualType Ty = Expr->getType();
312 assert(!Ty.isNull() && "DefaultArgumentPromotion - missing type");
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000313
Chris Lattner2ce500f2008-07-25 22:25:12 +0000314 // If this is a 'float' (CVR qualified or typedef) promote to double.
Chris Lattnerbb53efb2010-05-16 04:01:30 +0000315 if (Ty->isSpecificBuiltinType(BuiltinType::Float))
316 return ImpCastExprToType(Expr, Context.DoubleTy,
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +0000317 CK_FloatingCast);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000318
Chris Lattner2ce500f2008-07-25 22:25:12 +0000319 UsualUnaryConversions(Expr);
320}
321
Chris Lattnera8a7d0f2009-04-12 08:11:20 +0000322/// DefaultVariadicArgumentPromotion - Like DefaultArgumentPromotion, but
323/// will warn if the resulting type is not a POD type, and rejects ObjC
324/// interfaces passed by value. This returns true if the argument type is
325/// completely illegal.
Chris Lattnerbb53efb2010-05-16 04:01:30 +0000326bool Sema::DefaultVariadicArgumentPromotion(Expr *&Expr, VariadicCallType CT,
327 FunctionDecl *FDecl) {
Anders Carlssona7d069d2009-01-16 16:48:51 +0000328 DefaultArgumentPromotion(Expr);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000329
Chris Lattnerbb53efb2010-05-16 04:01:30 +0000330 // __builtin_va_start takes the second argument as a "varargs" argument, but
331 // it doesn't actually do anything with it. It doesn't need to be non-pod
332 // etc.
333 if (FDecl && FDecl->getBuiltinID() == Builtin::BI__builtin_va_start)
334 return false;
335
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +0000336 if (Expr->getType()->isObjCObjectType() &&
Douglas Gregorda8cdbc2009-12-22 01:01:55 +0000337 DiagRuntimeBehavior(Expr->getLocStart(),
338 PDiag(diag::err_cannot_pass_objc_interface_to_vararg)
339 << Expr->getType() << CT))
340 return true;
Douglas Gregor7ca84af2009-12-12 07:25:49 +0000341
Douglas Gregorda8cdbc2009-12-22 01:01:55 +0000342 if (!Expr->getType()->isPODType() &&
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +0000343 DiagRuntimeBehavior(Expr->getLocStart(),
Douglas Gregorda8cdbc2009-12-22 01:01:55 +0000344 PDiag(diag::warn_cannot_pass_non_pod_arg_to_vararg)
345 << Expr->getType() << CT))
346 return true;
Chris Lattnera8a7d0f2009-04-12 08:11:20 +0000347
348 return false;
Anders Carlssona7d069d2009-01-16 16:48:51 +0000349}
350
351
Chris Lattner513165e2008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000352/// UsualArithmeticConversions - Performs various conversions that are common to
353/// binary operators (C99 6.3.1.8). If both operands aren't arithmetic, this
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000354/// routine returns the first non-arithmetic type found. The client is
Chris Lattner513165e2008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000355/// responsible for emitting appropriate error diagnostics.
356/// FIXME: verify the conversion rules for "complex int" are consistent with
357/// GCC.
358QualType Sema::UsualArithmeticConversions(Expr *&lhsExpr, Expr *&rhsExpr,
359 bool isCompAssign) {
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +0000360 if (!isCompAssign)
Chris Lattner513165e2008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000361 UsualUnaryConversions(lhsExpr);
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +0000362
363 UsualUnaryConversions(rhsExpr);
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +0000364
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000365 // For conversion purposes, we ignore any qualifiers.
Chris Lattner513165e2008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000366 // For example, "const float" and "float" are equivalent.
Chris Lattner574dee62008-07-26 22:17:49 +0000367 QualType lhs =
368 Context.getCanonicalType(lhsExpr->getType()).getUnqualifiedType();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000369 QualType rhs =
Chris Lattner574dee62008-07-26 22:17:49 +0000370 Context.getCanonicalType(rhsExpr->getType()).getUnqualifiedType();
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +0000371
372 // If both types are identical, no conversion is needed.
373 if (lhs == rhs)
374 return lhs;
375
376 // If either side is a non-arithmetic type (e.g. a pointer), we are done.
377 // The caller can deal with this (e.g. pointer + int).
378 if (!lhs->isArithmeticType() || !rhs->isArithmeticType())
379 return lhs;
380
Douglas Gregord2c2d172009-05-02 00:36:19 +0000381 // Perform bitfield promotions.
Eli Friedman629ffb92009-08-20 04:21:42 +0000382 QualType LHSBitfieldPromoteTy = Context.isPromotableBitField(lhsExpr);
Douglas Gregord2c2d172009-05-02 00:36:19 +0000383 if (!LHSBitfieldPromoteTy.isNull())
384 lhs = LHSBitfieldPromoteTy;
Eli Friedman629ffb92009-08-20 04:21:42 +0000385 QualType RHSBitfieldPromoteTy = Context.isPromotableBitField(rhsExpr);
Douglas Gregord2c2d172009-05-02 00:36:19 +0000386 if (!RHSBitfieldPromoteTy.isNull())
387 rhs = RHSBitfieldPromoteTy;
388
Eli Friedman5ae98ee2009-08-19 07:44:53 +0000389 QualType destType = Context.UsualArithmeticConversionsType(lhs, rhs);
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +0000390 if (!isCompAssign)
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +0000391 ImpCastExprToType(lhsExpr, destType, CK_Unknown);
392 ImpCastExprToType(rhsExpr, destType, CK_Unknown);
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +0000393 return destType;
394}
395
Chris Lattner513165e2008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000396//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
397// Semantic Analysis for various Expression Types
398//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
399
400
Steve Naroff83895f72007-09-16 03:34:24 +0000401/// ActOnStringLiteral - The specified tokens were lexed as pasted string
Chris Lattner5b183d82006-11-10 05:03:26 +0000402/// fragments (e.g. "foo" "bar" L"baz"). The result string has to handle string
403/// concatenation ([C99 5.1.1.2, translation phase #6]), so it may come from
404/// multiple tokens. However, the common case is that StringToks points to one
405/// string.
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +0000406///
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +0000407ExprResult
Alexis Hunt3b791862010-08-30 17:47:05 +0000408Sema::ActOnStringLiteral(const Token *StringToks, unsigned NumStringToks) {
Chris Lattner5b183d82006-11-10 05:03:26 +0000409 assert(NumStringToks && "Must have at least one string!");
410
Chris Lattner8a24e582009-01-16 18:51:42 +0000411 StringLiteralParser Literal(StringToks, NumStringToks, PP);
Steve Naroff4f88b312007-03-13 22:37:02 +0000412 if (Literal.hadError)
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +0000413 return ExprError();
Chris Lattner5b183d82006-11-10 05:03:26 +0000414
Chris Lattner23b7eb62007-06-15 23:05:46 +0000415 llvm::SmallVector<SourceLocation, 4> StringTokLocs;
Chris Lattner5b183d82006-11-10 05:03:26 +0000416 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumStringToks; ++i)
417 StringTokLocs.push_back(StringToks[i].getLocation());
Chris Lattner36fc8792008-02-11 00:02:17 +0000418
Chris Lattner36fc8792008-02-11 00:02:17 +0000419 QualType StrTy = Context.CharTy;
Argyrios Kyrtzidiscbad7252008-08-09 17:20:01 +0000420 if (Literal.AnyWide) StrTy = Context.getWCharType();
Chris Lattner36fc8792008-02-11 00:02:17 +0000421 if (Literal.Pascal) StrTy = Context.UnsignedCharTy;
Douglas Gregoraa1e21d2008-09-12 00:47:35 +0000422
423 // A C++ string literal has a const-qualified element type (C++ 2.13.4p1).
Chris Lattnera8687ae2010-06-15 18:05:34 +0000424 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus || getLangOptions().ConstStrings)
Douglas Gregoraa1e21d2008-09-12 00:47:35 +0000425 StrTy.addConst();
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +0000426
Chris Lattner36fc8792008-02-11 00:02:17 +0000427 // Get an array type for the string, according to C99 6.4.5. This includes
428 // the nul terminator character as well as the string length for pascal
429 // strings.
430 StrTy = Context.getConstantArrayType(StrTy,
Chris Lattnerd42c29f2009-02-26 23:01:51 +0000431 llvm::APInt(32, Literal.GetNumStringChars()+1),
Chris Lattner36fc8792008-02-11 00:02:17 +0000432 ArrayType::Normal, 0);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000433
Chris Lattner5b183d82006-11-10 05:03:26 +0000434 // Pass &StringTokLocs[0], StringTokLocs.size() to factory!
Alexis Hunt3b791862010-08-30 17:47:05 +0000435 return Owned(StringLiteral::Create(Context, Literal.GetString(),
436 Literal.GetStringLength(),
437 Literal.AnyWide, StrTy,
438 &StringTokLocs[0],
439 StringTokLocs.size()));
Chris Lattner5b183d82006-11-10 05:03:26 +0000440}
441
Chris Lattner2a9d9892008-10-20 05:16:36 +0000442/// ShouldSnapshotBlockValueReference - Return true if a reference inside of
443/// CurBlock to VD should cause it to be snapshotted (as we do for auto
444/// variables defined outside the block) or false if this is not needed (e.g.
445/// for values inside the block or for globals).
446///
Douglas Gregor4f13beb2010-03-01 20:44:28 +0000447/// This also keeps the 'hasBlockDeclRefExprs' in the BlockScopeInfo records
Chris Lattner497d7b02009-04-21 22:26:47 +0000448/// up-to-date.
449///
Douglas Gregor9a28e842010-03-01 23:15:13 +0000450static bool ShouldSnapshotBlockValueReference(Sema &S, BlockScopeInfo *CurBlock,
Chris Lattner2a9d9892008-10-20 05:16:36 +0000451 ValueDecl *VD) {
452 // If the value is defined inside the block, we couldn't snapshot it even if
453 // we wanted to.
454 if (CurBlock->TheDecl == VD->getDeclContext())
455 return false;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000456
Chris Lattner2a9d9892008-10-20 05:16:36 +0000457 // If this is an enum constant or function, it is constant, don't snapshot.
458 if (isa<EnumConstantDecl>(VD) || isa<FunctionDecl>(VD))
459 return false;
460
461 // If this is a reference to an extern, static, or global variable, no need to
462 // snapshot it.
463 // FIXME: What about 'const' variables in C++?
464 if (const VarDecl *Var = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(VD))
Chris Lattner497d7b02009-04-21 22:26:47 +0000465 if (!Var->hasLocalStorage())
466 return false;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000467
Chris Lattner497d7b02009-04-21 22:26:47 +0000468 // Blocks that have these can't be constant.
469 CurBlock->hasBlockDeclRefExprs = true;
470
471 // If we have nested blocks, the decl may be declared in an outer block (in
472 // which case that outer block doesn't get "hasBlockDeclRefExprs") or it may
473 // be defined outside all of the current blocks (in which case the blocks do
474 // all get the bit). Walk the nesting chain.
Douglas Gregor9a28e842010-03-01 23:15:13 +0000475 for (unsigned I = S.FunctionScopes.size() - 1; I; --I) {
476 BlockScopeInfo *NextBlock = dyn_cast<BlockScopeInfo>(S.FunctionScopes[I]);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +0000477
Douglas Gregor9a28e842010-03-01 23:15:13 +0000478 if (!NextBlock)
479 continue;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +0000480
Chris Lattner497d7b02009-04-21 22:26:47 +0000481 // If we found the defining block for the variable, don't mark the block as
482 // having a reference outside it.
483 if (NextBlock->TheDecl == VD->getDeclContext())
484 break;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000485
Chris Lattner497d7b02009-04-21 22:26:47 +0000486 // Otherwise, the DeclRef from the inner block causes the outer one to need
487 // a snapshot as well.
488 NextBlock->hasBlockDeclRefExprs = true;
489 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000490
Chris Lattner2a9d9892008-10-20 05:16:36 +0000491 return true;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000492}
493
Chris Lattner2a9d9892008-10-20 05:16:36 +0000494
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +0000495ExprResult
John McCallce546572009-12-08 09:08:17 +0000496Sema::BuildDeclRefExpr(ValueDecl *D, QualType Ty, SourceLocation Loc,
Sebastian Redl3d3f75a2009-02-03 20:19:35 +0000497 const CXXScopeSpec *SS) {
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +0000498 DeclarationNameInfo NameInfo(D->getDeclName(), Loc);
499 return BuildDeclRefExpr(D, Ty, NameInfo, SS);
500}
501
502/// BuildDeclRefExpr - Build a DeclRefExpr.
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +0000503ExprResult
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +0000504Sema::BuildDeclRefExpr(ValueDecl *D, QualType Ty,
505 const DeclarationNameInfo &NameInfo,
506 const CXXScopeSpec *SS) {
Anders Carlsson364035d12009-06-26 19:16:07 +0000507 if (Context.getCanonicalType(Ty) == Context.UndeducedAutoTy) {
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +0000508 Diag(NameInfo.getLoc(),
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000509 diag::err_auto_variable_cannot_appear_in_own_initializer)
Anders Carlsson364035d12009-06-26 19:16:07 +0000510 << D->getDeclName();
511 return ExprError();
512 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000513
Anders Carlsson946b86d2009-06-24 00:10:43 +0000514 if (const VarDecl *VD = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(D)) {
Douglas Gregor15243332010-04-27 21:10:04 +0000515 if (isa<NonTypeTemplateParmDecl>(VD)) {
516 // Non-type template parameters can be referenced anywhere they are
517 // visible.
Douglas Gregora8a089b2010-07-13 18:40:04 +0000518 Ty = Ty.getNonLValueExprType(Context);
Douglas Gregor15243332010-04-27 21:10:04 +0000519 } else if (const CXXMethodDecl *MD = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(CurContext)) {
Anders Carlsson946b86d2009-06-24 00:10:43 +0000520 if (const FunctionDecl *FD = MD->getParent()->isLocalClass()) {
521 if (VD->hasLocalStorage() && VD->getDeclContext() != CurContext) {
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +0000522 Diag(NameInfo.getLoc(),
523 diag::err_reference_to_local_var_in_enclosing_function)
Anders Carlsson946b86d2009-06-24 00:10:43 +0000524 << D->getIdentifier() << FD->getDeclName();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000525 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_local_variable_declared_here)
Anders Carlsson946b86d2009-06-24 00:10:43 +0000526 << D->getIdentifier();
527 return ExprError();
528 }
529 }
530 }
531 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000532
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +0000533 MarkDeclarationReferenced(NameInfo.getLoc(), D);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000534
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +0000535 return Owned(DeclRefExpr::Create(Context,
536 SS? (NestedNameSpecifier *)SS->getScopeRep() : 0,
537 SS? SS->getRange() : SourceRange(),
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +0000538 D, NameInfo, Ty));
Douglas Gregorc7acfdf2009-01-06 05:10:23 +0000539}
540
Douglas Gregord5846a12009-04-15 06:41:24 +0000541/// \brief Given a field that represents a member of an anonymous
542/// struct/union, build the path from that field's context to the
543/// actual member.
544///
545/// Construct the sequence of field member references we'll have to
546/// perform to get to the field in the anonymous union/struct. The
547/// list of members is built from the field outward, so traverse it
548/// backwards to go from an object in the current context to the field
549/// we found.
550///
551/// \returns The variable from which the field access should begin,
552/// for an anonymous struct/union that is not a member of another
553/// class. Otherwise, returns NULL.
554VarDecl *Sema::BuildAnonymousStructUnionMemberPath(FieldDecl *Field,
555 llvm::SmallVectorImpl<FieldDecl *> &Path) {
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000556 assert(Field->getDeclContext()->isRecord() &&
557 cast<RecordDecl>(Field->getDeclContext())->isAnonymousStructOrUnion()
558 && "Field must be stored inside an anonymous struct or union");
559
Douglas Gregord5846a12009-04-15 06:41:24 +0000560 Path.push_back(Field);
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000561 VarDecl *BaseObject = 0;
562 DeclContext *Ctx = Field->getDeclContext();
563 do {
564 RecordDecl *Record = cast<RecordDecl>(Ctx);
John McCall61925b02010-05-21 01:17:40 +0000565 ValueDecl *AnonObject = Record->getAnonymousStructOrUnionObject();
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000566 if (FieldDecl *AnonField = dyn_cast<FieldDecl>(AnonObject))
Douglas Gregord5846a12009-04-15 06:41:24 +0000567 Path.push_back(AnonField);
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000568 else {
569 BaseObject = cast<VarDecl>(AnonObject);
570 break;
571 }
572 Ctx = Ctx->getParent();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000573 } while (Ctx->isRecord() &&
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000574 cast<RecordDecl>(Ctx)->isAnonymousStructOrUnion());
Douglas Gregord5846a12009-04-15 06:41:24 +0000575
576 return BaseObject;
577}
578
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +0000579ExprResult
Douglas Gregord5846a12009-04-15 06:41:24 +0000580Sema::BuildAnonymousStructUnionMemberReference(SourceLocation Loc,
581 FieldDecl *Field,
582 Expr *BaseObjectExpr,
583 SourceLocation OpLoc) {
584 llvm::SmallVector<FieldDecl *, 4> AnonFields;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000585 VarDecl *BaseObject = BuildAnonymousStructUnionMemberPath(Field,
Douglas Gregord5846a12009-04-15 06:41:24 +0000586 AnonFields);
587
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000588 // Build the expression that refers to the base object, from
589 // which we will build a sequence of member references to each
590 // of the anonymous union objects and, eventually, the field we
591 // found via name lookup.
592 bool BaseObjectIsPointer = false;
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +0000593 Qualifiers BaseQuals;
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000594 if (BaseObject) {
595 // BaseObject is an anonymous struct/union variable (and is,
596 // therefore, not part of another non-anonymous record).
Douglas Gregorc9c02ed2009-06-19 23:52:42 +0000597 MarkDeclarationReferenced(Loc, BaseObject);
Steve Narofff6009ed2009-01-21 00:14:39 +0000598 BaseObjectExpr = new (Context) DeclRefExpr(BaseObject,BaseObject->getType(),
Devang Patele25b5f82010-10-12 23:23:25 +0000599 Loc);
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +0000600 BaseQuals
601 = Context.getCanonicalType(BaseObject->getType()).getQualifiers();
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000602 } else if (BaseObjectExpr) {
603 // The caller provided the base object expression. Determine
604 // whether its a pointer and whether it adds any qualifiers to the
605 // anonymous struct/union fields we're looking into.
606 QualType ObjectType = BaseObjectExpr->getType();
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +0000607 if (const PointerType *ObjectPtr = ObjectType->getAs<PointerType>()) {
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000608 BaseObjectIsPointer = true;
609 ObjectType = ObjectPtr->getPointeeType();
610 }
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +0000611 BaseQuals
612 = Context.getCanonicalType(ObjectType).getQualifiers();
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000613 } else {
614 // We've found a member of an anonymous struct/union that is
615 // inside a non-anonymous struct/union, so in a well-formed
616 // program our base object expression is "this".
John McCall87fe5d52010-05-20 01:18:31 +0000617 DeclContext *DC = getFunctionLevelDeclContext();
618 if (CXXMethodDecl *MD = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(DC)) {
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000619 if (!MD->isStatic()) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000620 QualType AnonFieldType
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000621 = Context.getTagDeclType(
622 cast<RecordDecl>(AnonFields.back()->getDeclContext()));
623 QualType ThisType = Context.getTagDeclType(MD->getParent());
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000624 if ((Context.getCanonicalType(AnonFieldType)
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000625 == Context.getCanonicalType(ThisType)) ||
626 IsDerivedFrom(ThisType, AnonFieldType)) {
627 // Our base object expression is "this".
Douglas Gregor4b654412009-12-24 20:23:34 +0000628 BaseObjectExpr = new (Context) CXXThisExpr(Loc,
Douglas Gregorb15af892010-01-07 23:12:05 +0000629 MD->getThisType(Context),
630 /*isImplicit=*/true);
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000631 BaseObjectIsPointer = true;
632 }
633 } else {
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +0000634 return ExprError(Diag(Loc,diag::err_invalid_member_use_in_static_method)
635 << Field->getDeclName());
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000636 }
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +0000637 BaseQuals = Qualifiers::fromCVRMask(MD->getTypeQualifiers());
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000638 }
639
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000640 if (!BaseObjectExpr)
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +0000641 return ExprError(Diag(Loc, diag::err_invalid_non_static_member_use)
642 << Field->getDeclName());
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000643 }
644
645 // Build the implicit member references to the field of the
646 // anonymous struct/union.
647 Expr *Result = BaseObjectExpr;
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +0000648 Qualifiers ResultQuals = BaseQuals;
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000649 for (llvm::SmallVector<FieldDecl *, 4>::reverse_iterator
650 FI = AnonFields.rbegin(), FIEnd = AnonFields.rend();
651 FI != FIEnd; ++FI) {
652 QualType MemberType = (*FI)->getType();
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +0000653 Qualifiers MemberTypeQuals =
654 Context.getCanonicalType(MemberType).getQualifiers();
655
656 // CVR attributes from the base are picked up by members,
657 // except that 'mutable' members don't pick up 'const'.
658 if ((*FI)->isMutable())
659 ResultQuals.removeConst();
660
661 // GC attributes are never picked up by members.
662 ResultQuals.removeObjCGCAttr();
663
664 // TR 18037 does not allow fields to be declared with address spaces.
665 assert(!MemberTypeQuals.hasAddressSpace());
666
667 Qualifiers NewQuals = ResultQuals + MemberTypeQuals;
668 if (NewQuals != MemberTypeQuals)
669 MemberType = Context.getQualifiedType(MemberType, NewQuals);
670
Douglas Gregorc9c02ed2009-06-19 23:52:42 +0000671 MarkDeclarationReferenced(Loc, *FI);
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +0000672 PerformObjectMemberConversion(Result, /*FIXME:Qualifier=*/0, *FI, *FI);
Douglas Gregorc1905232009-08-26 22:36:53 +0000673 // FIXME: Might this end up being a qualified name?
Steve Narofff6009ed2009-01-21 00:14:39 +0000674 Result = new (Context) MemberExpr(Result, BaseObjectIsPointer, *FI,
675 OpLoc, MemberType);
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000676 BaseObjectIsPointer = false;
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +0000677 ResultQuals = NewQuals;
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000678 }
679
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +0000680 return Owned(Result);
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000681}
682
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +0000683/// Decomposes the given name into a DeclarationNameInfo, its location, and
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +0000684/// possibly a list of template arguments.
685///
686/// If this produces template arguments, it is permitted to call
687/// DecomposeTemplateName.
688///
689/// This actually loses a lot of source location information for
690/// non-standard name kinds; we should consider preserving that in
691/// some way.
692static void DecomposeUnqualifiedId(Sema &SemaRef,
693 const UnqualifiedId &Id,
694 TemplateArgumentListInfo &Buffer,
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +0000695 DeclarationNameInfo &NameInfo,
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +0000696 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *&TemplateArgs) {
697 if (Id.getKind() == UnqualifiedId::IK_TemplateId) {
698 Buffer.setLAngleLoc(Id.TemplateId->LAngleLoc);
699 Buffer.setRAngleLoc(Id.TemplateId->RAngleLoc);
700
701 ASTTemplateArgsPtr TemplateArgsPtr(SemaRef,
702 Id.TemplateId->getTemplateArgs(),
703 Id.TemplateId->NumArgs);
704 SemaRef.translateTemplateArguments(TemplateArgsPtr, Buffer);
705 TemplateArgsPtr.release();
706
John McCall3e56fd42010-08-23 07:28:44 +0000707 TemplateName TName = Id.TemplateId->Template.get();
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +0000708 SourceLocation TNameLoc = Id.TemplateId->TemplateNameLoc;
709 NameInfo = SemaRef.Context.getNameForTemplate(TName, TNameLoc);
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +0000710 TemplateArgs = &Buffer;
711 } else {
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +0000712 NameInfo = SemaRef.GetNameFromUnqualifiedId(Id);
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +0000713 TemplateArgs = 0;
714 }
715}
716
John McCall69f9dbc2010-02-08 19:26:07 +0000717/// Determines whether the given record is "fully-formed" at the given
718/// location, i.e. whether a qualified lookup into it is assured of
719/// getting consistent results already.
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +0000720static bool IsFullyFormedScope(Sema &SemaRef, CXXRecordDecl *Record) {
John McCall69f9dbc2010-02-08 19:26:07 +0000721 if (!Record->hasDefinition())
722 return false;
723
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +0000724 for (CXXRecordDecl::base_class_iterator I = Record->bases_begin(),
725 E = Record->bases_end(); I != E; ++I) {
726 CanQualType BaseT = SemaRef.Context.getCanonicalType((*I).getType());
727 CanQual<RecordType> BaseRT = BaseT->getAs<RecordType>();
728 if (!BaseRT) return false;
729
730 CXXRecordDecl *BaseRecord = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(BaseRT->getDecl());
John McCall69f9dbc2010-02-08 19:26:07 +0000731 if (!BaseRecord->hasDefinition() ||
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +0000732 !IsFullyFormedScope(SemaRef, BaseRecord))
733 return false;
734 }
735
736 return true;
737}
738
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +0000739/// Determines if the given class is provably not derived from all of
740/// the prospective base classes.
741static bool IsProvablyNotDerivedFrom(Sema &SemaRef,
742 CXXRecordDecl *Record,
743 const llvm::SmallPtrSet<CXXRecordDecl*, 4> &Bases) {
John McCalla6d407c2009-12-01 22:28:41 +0000744 if (Bases.count(Record->getCanonicalDecl()))
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +0000745 return false;
746
Douglas Gregor0a5a2212010-02-11 01:04:33 +0000747 RecordDecl *RD = Record->getDefinition();
John McCalla6d407c2009-12-01 22:28:41 +0000748 if (!RD) return false;
749 Record = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(RD);
750
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +0000751 for (CXXRecordDecl::base_class_iterator I = Record->bases_begin(),
752 E = Record->bases_end(); I != E; ++I) {
753 CanQualType BaseT = SemaRef.Context.getCanonicalType((*I).getType());
754 CanQual<RecordType> BaseRT = BaseT->getAs<RecordType>();
755 if (!BaseRT) return false;
756
757 CXXRecordDecl *BaseRecord = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(BaseRT->getDecl());
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +0000758 if (!IsProvablyNotDerivedFrom(SemaRef, BaseRecord, Bases))
759 return false;
760 }
761
762 return true;
763}
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +0000764
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +0000765enum IMAKind {
766 /// The reference is definitely not an instance member access.
767 IMA_Static,
768
769 /// The reference may be an implicit instance member access.
770 IMA_Mixed,
771
772 /// The reference may be to an instance member, but it is invalid if
773 /// so, because the context is not an instance method.
774 IMA_Mixed_StaticContext,
775
776 /// The reference may be to an instance member, but it is invalid if
777 /// so, because the context is from an unrelated class.
778 IMA_Mixed_Unrelated,
779
780 /// The reference is definitely an implicit instance member access.
781 IMA_Instance,
782
783 /// The reference may be to an unresolved using declaration.
784 IMA_Unresolved,
785
786 /// The reference may be to an unresolved using declaration and the
787 /// context is not an instance method.
788 IMA_Unresolved_StaticContext,
789
790 /// The reference is to a member of an anonymous structure in a
791 /// non-class context.
792 IMA_AnonymousMember,
793
794 /// All possible referrents are instance members and the current
795 /// context is not an instance method.
796 IMA_Error_StaticContext,
797
798 /// All possible referrents are instance members of an unrelated
799 /// class.
800 IMA_Error_Unrelated
801};
802
803/// The given lookup names class member(s) and is not being used for
804/// an address-of-member expression. Classify the type of access
805/// according to whether it's possible that this reference names an
806/// instance member. This is best-effort; it is okay to
807/// conservatively answer "yes", in which case some errors will simply
808/// not be caught until template-instantiation.
809static IMAKind ClassifyImplicitMemberAccess(Sema &SemaRef,
810 const LookupResult &R) {
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +0000811 assert(!R.empty() && (*R.begin())->isCXXClassMember());
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +0000812
John McCall87fe5d52010-05-20 01:18:31 +0000813 DeclContext *DC = SemaRef.getFunctionLevelDeclContext();
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +0000814 bool isStaticContext =
John McCall87fe5d52010-05-20 01:18:31 +0000815 (!isa<CXXMethodDecl>(DC) ||
816 cast<CXXMethodDecl>(DC)->isStatic());
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +0000817
818 if (R.isUnresolvableResult())
819 return isStaticContext ? IMA_Unresolved_StaticContext : IMA_Unresolved;
820
821 // Collect all the declaring classes of instance members we find.
822 bool hasNonInstance = false;
823 llvm::SmallPtrSet<CXXRecordDecl*, 4> Classes;
824 for (LookupResult::iterator I = R.begin(), E = R.end(); I != E; ++I) {
John McCalla8ae2222010-04-06 21:38:20 +0000825 NamedDecl *D = *I;
826 if (D->isCXXInstanceMember()) {
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +0000827 CXXRecordDecl *R = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(D->getDeclContext());
828
829 // If this is a member of an anonymous record, move out to the
830 // innermost non-anonymous struct or union. If there isn't one,
831 // that's a special case.
832 while (R->isAnonymousStructOrUnion()) {
833 R = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(R->getParent());
834 if (!R) return IMA_AnonymousMember;
835 }
836 Classes.insert(R->getCanonicalDecl());
837 }
838 else
839 hasNonInstance = true;
840 }
841
842 // If we didn't find any instance members, it can't be an implicit
843 // member reference.
844 if (Classes.empty())
845 return IMA_Static;
846
847 // If the current context is not an instance method, it can't be
848 // an implicit member reference.
849 if (isStaticContext)
850 return (hasNonInstance ? IMA_Mixed_StaticContext : IMA_Error_StaticContext);
851
852 // If we can prove that the current context is unrelated to all the
853 // declaring classes, it can't be an implicit member reference (in
854 // which case it's an error if any of those members are selected).
855 if (IsProvablyNotDerivedFrom(SemaRef,
John McCall87fe5d52010-05-20 01:18:31 +0000856 cast<CXXMethodDecl>(DC)->getParent(),
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +0000857 Classes))
858 return (hasNonInstance ? IMA_Mixed_Unrelated : IMA_Error_Unrelated);
859
860 return (hasNonInstance ? IMA_Mixed : IMA_Instance);
861}
862
863/// Diagnose a reference to a field with no object available.
864static void DiagnoseInstanceReference(Sema &SemaRef,
865 const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
866 const LookupResult &R) {
867 SourceLocation Loc = R.getNameLoc();
868 SourceRange Range(Loc);
869 if (SS.isSet()) Range.setBegin(SS.getRange().getBegin());
870
871 if (R.getAsSingle<FieldDecl>()) {
872 if (CXXMethodDecl *MD = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(SemaRef.CurContext)) {
873 if (MD->isStatic()) {
874 // "invalid use of member 'x' in static member function"
875 SemaRef.Diag(Loc, diag::err_invalid_member_use_in_static_method)
876 << Range << R.getLookupName();
877 return;
878 }
879 }
880
881 SemaRef.Diag(Loc, diag::err_invalid_non_static_member_use)
882 << R.getLookupName() << Range;
883 return;
884 }
885
886 SemaRef.Diag(Loc, diag::err_member_call_without_object) << Range;
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +0000887}
888
John McCalld681c392009-12-16 08:11:27 +0000889/// Diagnose an empty lookup.
890///
891/// \return false if new lookup candidates were found
Nick Lewyckyc96c37f2010-07-06 19:51:49 +0000892bool Sema::DiagnoseEmptyLookup(Scope *S, CXXScopeSpec &SS, LookupResult &R,
893 CorrectTypoContext CTC) {
John McCalld681c392009-12-16 08:11:27 +0000894 DeclarationName Name = R.getLookupName();
895
John McCalld681c392009-12-16 08:11:27 +0000896 unsigned diagnostic = diag::err_undeclared_var_use;
Douglas Gregor598b08f2009-12-31 05:20:13 +0000897 unsigned diagnostic_suggest = diag::err_undeclared_var_use_suggest;
John McCalld681c392009-12-16 08:11:27 +0000898 if (Name.getNameKind() == DeclarationName::CXXOperatorName ||
899 Name.getNameKind() == DeclarationName::CXXLiteralOperatorName ||
Douglas Gregor598b08f2009-12-31 05:20:13 +0000900 Name.getNameKind() == DeclarationName::CXXConversionFunctionName) {
John McCalld681c392009-12-16 08:11:27 +0000901 diagnostic = diag::err_undeclared_use;
Douglas Gregor598b08f2009-12-31 05:20:13 +0000902 diagnostic_suggest = diag::err_undeclared_use_suggest;
903 }
John McCalld681c392009-12-16 08:11:27 +0000904
Douglas Gregor598b08f2009-12-31 05:20:13 +0000905 // If the original lookup was an unqualified lookup, fake an
906 // unqualified lookup. This is useful when (for example) the
907 // original lookup would not have found something because it was a
908 // dependent name.
Nick Lewyckyc96c37f2010-07-06 19:51:49 +0000909 for (DeclContext *DC = SS.isEmpty() ? CurContext : 0;
Douglas Gregor598b08f2009-12-31 05:20:13 +0000910 DC; DC = DC->getParent()) {
John McCalld681c392009-12-16 08:11:27 +0000911 if (isa<CXXRecordDecl>(DC)) {
912 LookupQualifiedName(R, DC);
913
914 if (!R.empty()) {
915 // Don't give errors about ambiguities in this lookup.
916 R.suppressDiagnostics();
917
918 CXXMethodDecl *CurMethod = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(CurContext);
919 bool isInstance = CurMethod &&
920 CurMethod->isInstance() &&
921 DC == CurMethod->getParent();
922
923 // Give a code modification hint to insert 'this->'.
924 // TODO: fixit for inserting 'Base<T>::' in the other cases.
925 // Actually quite difficult!
Nick Lewyckyc96c37f2010-07-06 19:51:49 +0000926 if (isInstance) {
Nick Lewyckyc96c37f2010-07-06 19:51:49 +0000927 UnresolvedLookupExpr *ULE = cast<UnresolvedLookupExpr>(
928 CallsUndergoingInstantiation.back()->getCallee());
Nick Lewyckyfe712382010-08-20 20:54:15 +0000929 CXXMethodDecl *DepMethod = cast_or_null<CXXMethodDecl>(
Nick Lewyckyc96c37f2010-07-06 19:51:49 +0000930 CurMethod->getInstantiatedFromMemberFunction());
Eli Friedman04831922010-08-22 01:00:03 +0000931 if (DepMethod) {
Nick Lewyckyfe712382010-08-20 20:54:15 +0000932 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diagnostic) << Name
933 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(R.getNameLoc(), "this->");
934 QualType DepThisType = DepMethod->getThisType(Context);
935 CXXThisExpr *DepThis = new (Context) CXXThisExpr(
936 R.getNameLoc(), DepThisType, false);
937 TemplateArgumentListInfo TList;
938 if (ULE->hasExplicitTemplateArgs())
939 ULE->copyTemplateArgumentsInto(TList);
940 CXXDependentScopeMemberExpr *DepExpr =
941 CXXDependentScopeMemberExpr::Create(
942 Context, DepThis, DepThisType, true, SourceLocation(),
943 ULE->getQualifier(), ULE->getQualifierRange(), NULL,
944 R.getLookupNameInfo(), &TList);
945 CallsUndergoingInstantiation.back()->setCallee(DepExpr);
Eli Friedman04831922010-08-22 01:00:03 +0000946 } else {
Nick Lewyckyfe712382010-08-20 20:54:15 +0000947 // FIXME: we should be able to handle this case too. It is correct
948 // to add this-> here. This is a workaround for PR7947.
949 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diagnostic) << Name;
Eli Friedman04831922010-08-22 01:00:03 +0000950 }
Nick Lewyckyc96c37f2010-07-06 19:51:49 +0000951 } else {
John McCalld681c392009-12-16 08:11:27 +0000952 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diagnostic) << Name;
Nick Lewyckyc96c37f2010-07-06 19:51:49 +0000953 }
John McCalld681c392009-12-16 08:11:27 +0000954
955 // Do we really want to note all of these?
956 for (LookupResult::iterator I = R.begin(), E = R.end(); I != E; ++I)
957 Diag((*I)->getLocation(), diag::note_dependent_var_use);
958
959 // Tell the callee to try to recover.
960 return false;
961 }
Douglas Gregor86b8d9f2010-08-09 22:38:14 +0000962
963 R.clear();
John McCalld681c392009-12-16 08:11:27 +0000964 }
965 }
966
Douglas Gregor598b08f2009-12-31 05:20:13 +0000967 // We didn't find anything, so try to correct for a typo.
Douglas Gregor280e1ee2010-04-14 20:04:41 +0000968 DeclarationName Corrected;
Daniel Dunbarf7ced252010-06-02 15:46:52 +0000969 if (S && (Corrected = CorrectTypo(R, S, &SS, 0, false, CTC))) {
Douglas Gregor280e1ee2010-04-14 20:04:41 +0000970 if (!R.empty()) {
971 if (isa<ValueDecl>(*R.begin()) || isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(*R.begin())) {
972 if (SS.isEmpty())
973 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diagnostic_suggest) << Name << R.getLookupName()
974 << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(R.getNameLoc(),
975 R.getLookupName().getAsString());
976 else
977 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diag::err_no_member_suggest)
978 << Name << computeDeclContext(SS, false) << R.getLookupName()
979 << SS.getRange()
980 << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(R.getNameLoc(),
981 R.getLookupName().getAsString());
982 if (NamedDecl *ND = R.getAsSingle<NamedDecl>())
983 Diag(ND->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_decl)
984 << ND->getDeclName();
985
986 // Tell the callee to try to recover.
987 return false;
988 }
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +0000989
Douglas Gregor280e1ee2010-04-14 20:04:41 +0000990 if (isa<TypeDecl>(*R.begin()) || isa<ObjCInterfaceDecl>(*R.begin())) {
991 // FIXME: If we ended up with a typo for a type name or
992 // Objective-C class name, we're in trouble because the parser
993 // is in the wrong place to recover. Suggest the typo
994 // correction, but don't make it a fix-it since we're not going
995 // to recover well anyway.
996 if (SS.isEmpty())
997 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diagnostic_suggest) << Name << R.getLookupName();
998 else
999 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diag::err_no_member_suggest)
1000 << Name << computeDeclContext(SS, false) << R.getLookupName()
1001 << SS.getRange();
1002
1003 // Don't try to recover; it won't work.
1004 return true;
1005 }
1006 } else {
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00001007 // FIXME: We found a keyword. Suggest it, but don't provide a fix-it
Douglas Gregor280e1ee2010-04-14 20:04:41 +00001008 // because we aren't able to recover.
Douglas Gregor25363982010-01-01 00:15:04 +00001009 if (SS.isEmpty())
Douglas Gregor280e1ee2010-04-14 20:04:41 +00001010 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diagnostic_suggest) << Name << Corrected;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001011 else
Douglas Gregor25363982010-01-01 00:15:04 +00001012 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diag::err_no_member_suggest)
Douglas Gregor280e1ee2010-04-14 20:04:41 +00001013 << Name << computeDeclContext(SS, false) << Corrected
1014 << SS.getRange();
Douglas Gregor25363982010-01-01 00:15:04 +00001015 return true;
1016 }
Douglas Gregor25363982010-01-01 00:15:04 +00001017 R.clear();
Douglas Gregor598b08f2009-12-31 05:20:13 +00001018 }
1019
1020 // Emit a special diagnostic for failed member lookups.
1021 // FIXME: computing the declaration context might fail here (?)
1022 if (!SS.isEmpty()) {
1023 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diag::err_no_member)
1024 << Name << computeDeclContext(SS, false)
1025 << SS.getRange();
1026 return true;
1027 }
1028
John McCalld681c392009-12-16 08:11:27 +00001029 // Give up, we can't recover.
1030 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diagnostic) << Name;
1031 return true;
1032}
1033
Douglas Gregor05fcf842010-11-02 20:36:02 +00001034ObjCPropertyDecl *Sema::canSynthesizeProvisionalIvar(IdentifierInfo *II) {
1035 ObjCMethodDecl *CurMeth = getCurMethodDecl();
Fariborz Jahanian86151342010-07-22 23:33:21 +00001036 ObjCInterfaceDecl *IDecl = CurMeth->getClassInterface();
1037 if (!IDecl)
1038 return 0;
1039 ObjCImplementationDecl *ClassImpDecl = IDecl->getImplementation();
1040 if (!ClassImpDecl)
1041 return 0;
Douglas Gregor05fcf842010-11-02 20:36:02 +00001042 ObjCPropertyDecl *property = LookupPropertyDecl(IDecl, II);
Fariborz Jahanian86151342010-07-22 23:33:21 +00001043 if (!property)
1044 return 0;
1045 if (ObjCPropertyImplDecl *PIDecl = ClassImpDecl->FindPropertyImplDecl(II))
Douglas Gregor05fcf842010-11-02 20:36:02 +00001046 if (PIDecl->getPropertyImplementation() == ObjCPropertyImplDecl::Dynamic ||
1047 PIDecl->getPropertyIvarDecl())
Fariborz Jahanian86151342010-07-22 23:33:21 +00001048 return 0;
1049 return property;
1050}
1051
Douglas Gregor05fcf842010-11-02 20:36:02 +00001052bool Sema::canSynthesizeProvisionalIvar(ObjCPropertyDecl *Property) {
1053 ObjCMethodDecl *CurMeth = getCurMethodDecl();
1054 ObjCInterfaceDecl *IDecl = CurMeth->getClassInterface();
1055 if (!IDecl)
1056 return false;
1057 ObjCImplementationDecl *ClassImpDecl = IDecl->getImplementation();
1058 if (!ClassImpDecl)
1059 return false;
1060 if (ObjCPropertyImplDecl *PIDecl
1061 = ClassImpDecl->FindPropertyImplDecl(Property->getIdentifier()))
1062 if (PIDecl->getPropertyImplementation() == ObjCPropertyImplDecl::Dynamic ||
1063 PIDecl->getPropertyIvarDecl())
1064 return false;
1065
1066 return true;
1067}
1068
Fariborz Jahanian18722982010-07-17 00:59:30 +00001069static ObjCIvarDecl *SynthesizeProvisionalIvar(Sema &SemaRef,
Fariborz Jahanian7b70eb42010-07-30 16:59:05 +00001070 LookupResult &Lookup,
Fariborz Jahanian18722982010-07-17 00:59:30 +00001071 IdentifierInfo *II,
1072 SourceLocation NameLoc) {
1073 ObjCMethodDecl *CurMeth = SemaRef.getCurMethodDecl();
Fariborz Jahanian7b70eb42010-07-30 16:59:05 +00001074 bool LookForIvars;
1075 if (Lookup.empty())
1076 LookForIvars = true;
1077 else if (CurMeth->isClassMethod())
1078 LookForIvars = false;
1079 else
1080 LookForIvars = (Lookup.isSingleResult() &&
1081 Lookup.getFoundDecl()->isDefinedOutsideFunctionOrMethod());
1082 if (!LookForIvars)
1083 return 0;
1084
Fariborz Jahanian18722982010-07-17 00:59:30 +00001085 ObjCInterfaceDecl *IDecl = CurMeth->getClassInterface();
1086 if (!IDecl)
1087 return 0;
1088 ObjCImplementationDecl *ClassImpDecl = IDecl->getImplementation();
Fariborz Jahanian2a360892010-07-19 16:14:33 +00001089 if (!ClassImpDecl)
1090 return 0;
Fariborz Jahanian18722982010-07-17 00:59:30 +00001091 bool DynamicImplSeen = false;
1092 ObjCPropertyDecl *property = SemaRef.LookupPropertyDecl(IDecl, II);
1093 if (!property)
1094 return 0;
Fariborz Jahanianbfcbc852010-10-19 19:08:23 +00001095 if (ObjCPropertyImplDecl *PIDecl = ClassImpDecl->FindPropertyImplDecl(II)) {
Fariborz Jahanian18722982010-07-17 00:59:30 +00001096 DynamicImplSeen =
1097 (PIDecl->getPropertyImplementation() == ObjCPropertyImplDecl::Dynamic);
Fariborz Jahanianbfcbc852010-10-19 19:08:23 +00001098 // property implementation has a designated ivar. No need to assume a new
1099 // one.
1100 if (!DynamicImplSeen && PIDecl->getPropertyIvarDecl())
1101 return 0;
1102 }
Fariborz Jahanian18722982010-07-17 00:59:30 +00001103 if (!DynamicImplSeen) {
Fariborz Jahanian2a360892010-07-19 16:14:33 +00001104 QualType PropType = SemaRef.Context.getCanonicalType(property->getType());
1105 ObjCIvarDecl *Ivar = ObjCIvarDecl::Create(SemaRef.Context, ClassImpDecl,
Fariborz Jahanian18722982010-07-17 00:59:30 +00001106 NameLoc,
1107 II, PropType, /*Dinfo=*/0,
1108 ObjCIvarDecl::Protected,
1109 (Expr *)0, true);
1110 ClassImpDecl->addDecl(Ivar);
1111 IDecl->makeDeclVisibleInContext(Ivar, false);
1112 property->setPropertyIvarDecl(Ivar);
1113 return Ivar;
1114 }
1115 return 0;
1116}
1117
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00001118ExprResult Sema::ActOnIdExpression(Scope *S,
John McCall24d18942010-08-24 22:52:39 +00001119 CXXScopeSpec &SS,
1120 UnqualifiedId &Id,
1121 bool HasTrailingLParen,
1122 bool isAddressOfOperand) {
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001123 assert(!(isAddressOfOperand && HasTrailingLParen) &&
1124 "cannot be direct & operand and have a trailing lparen");
1125
1126 if (SS.isInvalid())
Douglas Gregored8f2882009-01-30 01:04:22 +00001127 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregor90a1a652009-03-19 17:26:29 +00001128
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00001129 TemplateArgumentListInfo TemplateArgsBuffer;
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001130
1131 // Decompose the UnqualifiedId into the following data.
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00001132 DeclarationNameInfo NameInfo;
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001133 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs;
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00001134 DecomposeUnqualifiedId(*this, Id, TemplateArgsBuffer, NameInfo, TemplateArgs);
Douglas Gregor90a1a652009-03-19 17:26:29 +00001135
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00001136 DeclarationName Name = NameInfo.getName();
Douglas Gregor4ea80432008-11-18 15:03:34 +00001137 IdentifierInfo *II = Name.getAsIdentifierInfo();
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00001138 SourceLocation NameLoc = NameInfo.getLoc();
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001139
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001140 // C++ [temp.dep.expr]p3:
1141 // An id-expression is type-dependent if it contains:
Douglas Gregorea0a0a92010-01-11 18:40:55 +00001142 // -- an identifier that was declared with a dependent type,
1143 // (note: handled after lookup)
1144 // -- a template-id that is dependent,
1145 // (note: handled in BuildTemplateIdExpr)
1146 // -- a conversion-function-id that specifies a dependent type,
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001147 // -- a nested-name-specifier that contains a class-name that
1148 // names a dependent type.
1149 // Determine whether this is a member of an unknown specialization;
1150 // we need to handle these differently.
Eli Friedman964dbda2010-08-06 23:41:47 +00001151 bool DependentID = false;
1152 if (Name.getNameKind() == DeclarationName::CXXConversionFunctionName &&
1153 Name.getCXXNameType()->isDependentType()) {
1154 DependentID = true;
1155 } else if (SS.isSet()) {
1156 DeclContext *DC = computeDeclContext(SS, false);
1157 if (DC) {
1158 if (RequireCompleteDeclContext(SS, DC))
1159 return ExprError();
1160 // FIXME: We should be checking whether DC is the current instantiation.
1161 if (CXXRecordDecl *RD = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(DC))
1162 DependentID = !IsFullyFormedScope(*this, RD);
1163 } else {
1164 DependentID = true;
1165 }
1166 }
1167
1168 if (DependentID) {
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00001169 return ActOnDependentIdExpression(SS, NameInfo, isAddressOfOperand,
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001170 TemplateArgs);
1171 }
Fariborz Jahanian86151342010-07-22 23:33:21 +00001172 bool IvarLookupFollowUp = false;
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001173 // Perform the required lookup.
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00001174 LookupResult R(*this, NameInfo, LookupOrdinaryName);
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001175 if (TemplateArgs) {
Douglas Gregor3e51e172010-05-20 20:58:56 +00001176 // Lookup the template name again to correctly establish the context in
1177 // which it was found. This is really unfortunate as we already did the
1178 // lookup to determine that it was a template name in the first place. If
1179 // this becomes a performance hit, we can work harder to preserve those
1180 // results until we get here but it's likely not worth it.
Douglas Gregor786123d2010-05-21 23:18:07 +00001181 bool MemberOfUnknownSpecialization;
1182 LookupTemplateName(R, S, SS, QualType(), /*EnteringContext=*/false,
1183 MemberOfUnknownSpecialization);
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001184 } else {
Fariborz Jahanian86151342010-07-22 23:33:21 +00001185 IvarLookupFollowUp = (!SS.isSet() && II && getCurMethodDecl());
Fariborz Jahanian6fada5b2010-01-12 23:58:59 +00001186 LookupParsedName(R, S, &SS, !IvarLookupFollowUp);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001187
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001188 // If this reference is in an Objective-C method, then we need to do
1189 // some special Objective-C lookup, too.
Fariborz Jahanian6fada5b2010-01-12 23:58:59 +00001190 if (IvarLookupFollowUp) {
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00001191 ExprResult E(LookupInObjCMethod(R, S, II, true));
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001192 if (E.isInvalid())
1193 return ExprError();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001194
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001195 Expr *Ex = E.takeAs<Expr>();
1196 if (Ex) return Owned(Ex);
Fariborz Jahanian18722982010-07-17 00:59:30 +00001197 // Synthesize ivars lazily
1198 if (getLangOptions().ObjCNonFragileABI2) {
Fariborz Jahanian7b70eb42010-07-30 16:59:05 +00001199 if (SynthesizeProvisionalIvar(*this, R, II, NameLoc))
Fariborz Jahanian18722982010-07-17 00:59:30 +00001200 return ActOnIdExpression(S, SS, Id, HasTrailingLParen,
1201 isAddressOfOperand);
1202 }
Fariborz Jahanian18d90a92010-08-13 18:09:39 +00001203 // for further use, this must be set to false if in class method.
1204 IvarLookupFollowUp = getCurMethodDecl()->isInstanceMethod();
Steve Naroffebf4cb42008-06-02 23:03:37 +00001205 }
Chris Lattner59a25942008-03-31 00:36:02 +00001206 }
Douglas Gregorf15f5d32009-02-16 19:28:42 +00001207
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001208 if (R.isAmbiguous())
1209 return ExprError();
1210
Douglas Gregor171c45a2009-02-18 21:56:37 +00001211 // Determine whether this name might be a candidate for
1212 // argument-dependent lookup.
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001213 bool ADL = UseArgumentDependentLookup(SS, R, HasTrailingLParen);
Douglas Gregor171c45a2009-02-18 21:56:37 +00001214
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001215 if (R.empty() && !ADL) {
Bill Wendling4073ed52007-02-13 01:51:42 +00001216 // Otherwise, this could be an implicitly declared function reference (legal
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001217 // in C90, extension in C99, forbidden in C++).
1218 if (HasTrailingLParen && II && !getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
1219 NamedDecl *D = ImplicitlyDefineFunction(NameLoc, *II, S);
1220 if (D) R.addDecl(D);
1221 }
1222
1223 // If this name wasn't predeclared and if this is not a function
1224 // call, diagnose the problem.
1225 if (R.empty()) {
Douglas Gregor5fd04d42010-05-18 16:14:23 +00001226 if (DiagnoseEmptyLookup(S, SS, R, CTC_Unknown))
John McCalld681c392009-12-16 08:11:27 +00001227 return ExprError();
1228
1229 assert(!R.empty() &&
1230 "DiagnoseEmptyLookup returned false but added no results");
Douglas Gregor35b0bac2010-01-03 18:01:57 +00001231
1232 // If we found an Objective-C instance variable, let
1233 // LookupInObjCMethod build the appropriate expression to
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001234 // reference the ivar.
Douglas Gregor35b0bac2010-01-03 18:01:57 +00001235 if (ObjCIvarDecl *Ivar = R.getAsSingle<ObjCIvarDecl>()) {
1236 R.clear();
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00001237 ExprResult E(LookupInObjCMethod(R, S, Ivar->getIdentifier()));
Douglas Gregor35b0bac2010-01-03 18:01:57 +00001238 assert(E.isInvalid() || E.get());
1239 return move(E);
1240 }
Steve Naroff92e30f82007-04-02 22:35:25 +00001241 }
Chris Lattner17ed4872006-11-20 04:58:19 +00001242 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001243
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001244 // This is guaranteed from this point on.
1245 assert(!R.empty() || ADL);
1246
1247 if (VarDecl *Var = R.getAsSingle<VarDecl>()) {
Fariborz Jahanian86151342010-07-22 23:33:21 +00001248 if (getLangOptions().ObjCNonFragileABI && IvarLookupFollowUp &&
Fariborz Jahanianc15dfd82010-07-29 16:53:53 +00001249 !getLangOptions().ObjCNonFragileABI2 &&
1250 Var->isFileVarDecl()) {
Douglas Gregor05fcf842010-11-02 20:36:02 +00001251 ObjCPropertyDecl *Property = canSynthesizeProvisionalIvar(II);
Fariborz Jahanian86151342010-07-22 23:33:21 +00001252 if (Property) {
1253 Diag(NameLoc, diag::warn_ivar_variable_conflict) << Var->getDeclName();
1254 Diag(Property->getLocation(), diag::note_property_declare);
Fariborz Jahanian18d90a92010-08-13 18:09:39 +00001255 Diag(Var->getLocation(), diag::note_global_declared_at);
Fariborz Jahanian86151342010-07-22 23:33:21 +00001256 }
1257 }
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001258 } else if (FunctionDecl *Func = R.getAsSingle<FunctionDecl>()) {
Douglas Gregor3256d042009-06-30 15:47:41 +00001259 if (!getLangOptions().CPlusPlus && !Func->hasPrototype()) {
1260 // C99 DR 316 says that, if a function type comes from a
1261 // function definition (without a prototype), that type is only
1262 // used for checking compatibility. Therefore, when referencing
1263 // the function, we pretend that we don't have the full function
1264 // type.
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001265 if (DiagnoseUseOfDecl(Func, NameLoc))
Douglas Gregor3256d042009-06-30 15:47:41 +00001266 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +00001267
Douglas Gregor3256d042009-06-30 15:47:41 +00001268 QualType T = Func->getType();
1269 QualType NoProtoType = T;
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00001270 if (const FunctionProtoType *Proto = T->getAs<FunctionProtoType>())
Eli Friedmanb41ad0f2010-05-17 02:50:18 +00001271 NoProtoType = Context.getFunctionNoProtoType(Proto->getResultType(),
1272 Proto->getExtInfo());
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001273 return BuildDeclRefExpr(Func, NoProtoType, NameLoc, &SS);
Douglas Gregor3256d042009-06-30 15:47:41 +00001274 }
1275 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001276
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00001277 // Check whether this might be a C++ implicit instance member access.
John McCall24d18942010-08-24 22:52:39 +00001278 // C++ [class.mfct.non-static]p3:
1279 // When an id-expression that is not part of a class member access
1280 // syntax and not used to form a pointer to member is used in the
1281 // body of a non-static member function of class X, if name lookup
1282 // resolves the name in the id-expression to a non-static non-type
1283 // member of some class C, the id-expression is transformed into a
1284 // class member access expression using (*this) as the
1285 // postfix-expression to the left of the . operator.
John McCall8d08b9b2010-08-27 09:08:28 +00001286 //
1287 // But we don't actually need to do this for '&' operands if R
1288 // resolved to a function or overloaded function set, because the
1289 // expression is ill-formed if it actually works out to be a
1290 // non-static member function:
1291 //
1292 // C++ [expr.ref]p4:
1293 // Otherwise, if E1.E2 refers to a non-static member function. . .
1294 // [t]he expression can be used only as the left-hand operand of a
1295 // member function call.
1296 //
1297 // There are other safeguards against such uses, but it's important
1298 // to get this right here so that we don't end up making a
1299 // spuriously dependent expression if we're inside a dependent
1300 // instance method.
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00001301 if (!R.empty() && (*R.begin())->isCXXClassMember()) {
John McCall8d08b9b2010-08-27 09:08:28 +00001302 bool MightBeImplicitMember;
1303 if (!isAddressOfOperand)
1304 MightBeImplicitMember = true;
1305 else if (!SS.isEmpty())
1306 MightBeImplicitMember = false;
1307 else if (R.isOverloadedResult())
1308 MightBeImplicitMember = false;
Douglas Gregor1262b062010-08-30 16:00:47 +00001309 else if (R.isUnresolvableResult())
1310 MightBeImplicitMember = true;
John McCall8d08b9b2010-08-27 09:08:28 +00001311 else
1312 MightBeImplicitMember = isa<FieldDecl>(R.getFoundDecl());
1313
1314 if (MightBeImplicitMember)
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00001315 return BuildPossibleImplicitMemberExpr(SS, R, TemplateArgs);
John McCallb53bbd42009-11-22 01:44:31 +00001316 }
1317
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001318 if (TemplateArgs)
1319 return BuildTemplateIdExpr(SS, R, ADL, *TemplateArgs);
John McCallb53bbd42009-11-22 01:44:31 +00001320
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001321 return BuildDeclarationNameExpr(SS, R, ADL);
1322}
1323
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00001324/// Builds an expression which might be an implicit member expression.
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00001325ExprResult
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00001326Sema::BuildPossibleImplicitMemberExpr(const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
1327 LookupResult &R,
1328 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs) {
1329 switch (ClassifyImplicitMemberAccess(*this, R)) {
1330 case IMA_Instance:
1331 return BuildImplicitMemberExpr(SS, R, TemplateArgs, true);
1332
1333 case IMA_AnonymousMember:
1334 assert(R.isSingleResult());
1335 return BuildAnonymousStructUnionMemberReference(R.getNameLoc(),
1336 R.getAsSingle<FieldDecl>());
1337
1338 case IMA_Mixed:
1339 case IMA_Mixed_Unrelated:
1340 case IMA_Unresolved:
1341 return BuildImplicitMemberExpr(SS, R, TemplateArgs, false);
1342
1343 case IMA_Static:
1344 case IMA_Mixed_StaticContext:
1345 case IMA_Unresolved_StaticContext:
1346 if (TemplateArgs)
1347 return BuildTemplateIdExpr(SS, R, false, *TemplateArgs);
1348 return BuildDeclarationNameExpr(SS, R, false);
1349
1350 case IMA_Error_StaticContext:
1351 case IMA_Error_Unrelated:
1352 DiagnoseInstanceReference(*this, SS, R);
1353 return ExprError();
1354 }
1355
1356 llvm_unreachable("unexpected instance member access kind");
1357 return ExprError();
1358}
1359
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00001360/// BuildQualifiedDeclarationNameExpr - Build a C++ qualified
1361/// declaration name, generally during template instantiation.
1362/// There's a large number of things which don't need to be done along
1363/// this path.
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00001364ExprResult
Jeffrey Yasskinc76498d2010-04-08 16:38:48 +00001365Sema::BuildQualifiedDeclarationNameExpr(CXXScopeSpec &SS,
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00001366 const DeclarationNameInfo &NameInfo) {
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001367 DeclContext *DC;
Douglas Gregora02bb342010-04-28 07:04:26 +00001368 if (!(DC = computeDeclContext(SS, false)) || DC->isDependentContext())
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00001369 return BuildDependentDeclRefExpr(SS, NameInfo, 0);
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001370
John McCall0b66eb32010-05-01 00:40:08 +00001371 if (RequireCompleteDeclContext(SS, DC))
Douglas Gregora02bb342010-04-28 07:04:26 +00001372 return ExprError();
1373
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00001374 LookupResult R(*this, NameInfo, LookupOrdinaryName);
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001375 LookupQualifiedName(R, DC);
1376
1377 if (R.isAmbiguous())
1378 return ExprError();
1379
1380 if (R.empty()) {
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00001381 Diag(NameInfo.getLoc(), diag::err_no_member)
1382 << NameInfo.getName() << DC << SS.getRange();
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001383 return ExprError();
1384 }
1385
1386 return BuildDeclarationNameExpr(SS, R, /*ADL*/ false);
1387}
1388
1389/// LookupInObjCMethod - The parser has read a name in, and Sema has
1390/// detected that we're currently inside an ObjC method. Perform some
1391/// additional lookup.
1392///
1393/// Ideally, most of this would be done by lookup, but there's
1394/// actually quite a lot of extra work involved.
1395///
1396/// Returns a null sentinel to indicate trivial success.
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00001397ExprResult
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001398Sema::LookupInObjCMethod(LookupResult &Lookup, Scope *S,
Chris Lattnera36ec422010-04-11 08:28:14 +00001399 IdentifierInfo *II, bool AllowBuiltinCreation) {
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001400 SourceLocation Loc = Lookup.getNameLoc();
Chris Lattner87313662010-04-12 05:10:17 +00001401 ObjCMethodDecl *CurMethod = getCurMethodDecl();
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00001402
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001403 // There are two cases to handle here. 1) scoped lookup could have failed,
1404 // in which case we should look for an ivar. 2) scoped lookup could have
1405 // found a decl, but that decl is outside the current instance method (i.e.
1406 // a global variable). In these two cases, we do a lookup for an ivar with
1407 // this name, if the lookup sucedes, we replace it our current decl.
1408
1409 // If we're in a class method, we don't normally want to look for
1410 // ivars. But if we don't find anything else, and there's an
1411 // ivar, that's an error.
Chris Lattner87313662010-04-12 05:10:17 +00001412 bool IsClassMethod = CurMethod->isClassMethod();
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001413
1414 bool LookForIvars;
1415 if (Lookup.empty())
1416 LookForIvars = true;
1417 else if (IsClassMethod)
1418 LookForIvars = false;
1419 else
1420 LookForIvars = (Lookup.isSingleResult() &&
1421 Lookup.getFoundDecl()->isDefinedOutsideFunctionOrMethod());
Fariborz Jahanian45878032010-02-09 19:31:38 +00001422 ObjCInterfaceDecl *IFace = 0;
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001423 if (LookForIvars) {
Chris Lattner87313662010-04-12 05:10:17 +00001424 IFace = CurMethod->getClassInterface();
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001425 ObjCInterfaceDecl *ClassDeclared;
1426 if (ObjCIvarDecl *IV = IFace->lookupInstanceVariable(II, ClassDeclared)) {
1427 // Diagnose using an ivar in a class method.
1428 if (IsClassMethod)
1429 return ExprError(Diag(Loc, diag::error_ivar_use_in_class_method)
1430 << IV->getDeclName());
1431
1432 // If we're referencing an invalid decl, just return this as a silent
1433 // error node. The error diagnostic was already emitted on the decl.
1434 if (IV->isInvalidDecl())
1435 return ExprError();
1436
1437 // Check if referencing a field with __attribute__((deprecated)).
1438 if (DiagnoseUseOfDecl(IV, Loc))
1439 return ExprError();
1440
1441 // Diagnose the use of an ivar outside of the declaring class.
1442 if (IV->getAccessControl() == ObjCIvarDecl::Private &&
1443 ClassDeclared != IFace)
1444 Diag(Loc, diag::error_private_ivar_access) << IV->getDeclName();
1445
1446 // FIXME: This should use a new expr for a direct reference, don't
1447 // turn this into Self->ivar, just return a BareIVarExpr or something.
1448 IdentifierInfo &II = Context.Idents.get("self");
1449 UnqualifiedId SelfName;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001450 SelfName.setIdentifier(&II, SourceLocation());
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001451 CXXScopeSpec SelfScopeSpec;
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00001452 ExprResult SelfExpr = ActOnIdExpression(S, SelfScopeSpec,
Douglas Gregora1ed39b2010-09-22 16:33:13 +00001453 SelfName, false, false);
1454 if (SelfExpr.isInvalid())
1455 return ExprError();
1456
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001457 MarkDeclarationReferenced(Loc, IV);
1458 return Owned(new (Context)
1459 ObjCIvarRefExpr(IV, IV->getType(), Loc,
1460 SelfExpr.takeAs<Expr>(), true, true));
1461 }
Chris Lattner87313662010-04-12 05:10:17 +00001462 } else if (CurMethod->isInstanceMethod()) {
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001463 // We should warn if a local variable hides an ivar.
Chris Lattner87313662010-04-12 05:10:17 +00001464 ObjCInterfaceDecl *IFace = CurMethod->getClassInterface();
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001465 ObjCInterfaceDecl *ClassDeclared;
1466 if (ObjCIvarDecl *IV = IFace->lookupInstanceVariable(II, ClassDeclared)) {
1467 if (IV->getAccessControl() != ObjCIvarDecl::Private ||
1468 IFace == ClassDeclared)
1469 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_ivar_use_hidden) << IV->getDeclName();
1470 }
1471 }
1472
Fariborz Jahanian6fada5b2010-01-12 23:58:59 +00001473 if (Lookup.empty() && II && AllowBuiltinCreation) {
1474 // FIXME. Consolidate this with similar code in LookupName.
1475 if (unsigned BuiltinID = II->getBuiltinID()) {
1476 if (!(getLangOptions().CPlusPlus &&
1477 Context.BuiltinInfo.isPredefinedLibFunction(BuiltinID))) {
1478 NamedDecl *D = LazilyCreateBuiltin((IdentifierInfo *)II, BuiltinID,
1479 S, Lookup.isForRedeclaration(),
1480 Lookup.getNameLoc());
1481 if (D) Lookup.addDecl(D);
1482 }
1483 }
1484 }
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001485 // Sentinel value saying that we didn't do anything special.
1486 return Owned((Expr*) 0);
Douglas Gregor3256d042009-06-30 15:47:41 +00001487}
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001488
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001489/// \brief Cast a base object to a member's actual type.
1490///
1491/// Logically this happens in three phases:
1492///
1493/// * First we cast from the base type to the naming class.
1494/// The naming class is the class into which we were looking
1495/// when we found the member; it's the qualifier type if a
1496/// qualifier was provided, and otherwise it's the base type.
1497///
1498/// * Next we cast from the naming class to the declaring class.
1499/// If the member we found was brought into a class's scope by
1500/// a using declaration, this is that class; otherwise it's
1501/// the class declaring the member.
1502///
1503/// * Finally we cast from the declaring class to the "true"
1504/// declaring class of the member. This conversion does not
1505/// obey access control.
Fariborz Jahanian3f150832009-07-29 19:40:11 +00001506bool
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001507Sema::PerformObjectMemberConversion(Expr *&From,
1508 NestedNameSpecifier *Qualifier,
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001509 NamedDecl *FoundDecl,
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001510 NamedDecl *Member) {
1511 CXXRecordDecl *RD = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(Member->getDeclContext());
1512 if (!RD)
1513 return false;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001514
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001515 QualType DestRecordType;
1516 QualType DestType;
1517 QualType FromRecordType;
1518 QualType FromType = From->getType();
1519 bool PointerConversions = false;
1520 if (isa<FieldDecl>(Member)) {
1521 DestRecordType = Context.getCanonicalType(Context.getTypeDeclType(RD));
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001522
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001523 if (FromType->getAs<PointerType>()) {
1524 DestType = Context.getPointerType(DestRecordType);
1525 FromRecordType = FromType->getPointeeType();
1526 PointerConversions = true;
1527 } else {
1528 DestType = DestRecordType;
1529 FromRecordType = FromType;
Fariborz Jahanianbb67b822009-07-29 18:40:24 +00001530 }
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001531 } else if (CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Member)) {
1532 if (Method->isStatic())
1533 return false;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001534
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001535 DestType = Method->getThisType(Context);
1536 DestRecordType = DestType->getPointeeType();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001537
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001538 if (FromType->getAs<PointerType>()) {
1539 FromRecordType = FromType->getPointeeType();
1540 PointerConversions = true;
1541 } else {
1542 FromRecordType = FromType;
1543 DestType = DestRecordType;
1544 }
1545 } else {
1546 // No conversion necessary.
1547 return false;
1548 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001549
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001550 if (DestType->isDependentType() || FromType->isDependentType())
1551 return false;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001552
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001553 // If the unqualified types are the same, no conversion is necessary.
1554 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromRecordType, DestRecordType))
1555 return false;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001556
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001557 SourceRange FromRange = From->getSourceRange();
1558 SourceLocation FromLoc = FromRange.getBegin();
1559
John McCall2536c6d2010-08-25 10:28:54 +00001560 ExprValueKind VK = CastCategory(From);
Sebastian Redlc57d34b2010-07-20 04:20:21 +00001561
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001562 // C++ [class.member.lookup]p8:
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001563 // [...] Ambiguities can often be resolved by qualifying a name with its
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001564 // class name.
1565 //
1566 // If the member was a qualified name and the qualified referred to a
1567 // specific base subobject type, we'll cast to that intermediate type
1568 // first and then to the object in which the member is declared. That allows
1569 // one to resolve ambiguities in, e.g., a diamond-shaped hierarchy such as:
1570 //
1571 // class Base { public: int x; };
1572 // class Derived1 : public Base { };
1573 // class Derived2 : public Base { };
1574 // class VeryDerived : public Derived1, public Derived2 { void f(); };
1575 //
1576 // void VeryDerived::f() {
1577 // x = 17; // error: ambiguous base subobjects
1578 // Derived1::x = 17; // okay, pick the Base subobject of Derived1
1579 // }
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001580 if (Qualifier) {
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001581 QualType QType = QualType(Qualifier->getAsType(), 0);
1582 assert(!QType.isNull() && "lookup done with dependent qualifier?");
1583 assert(QType->isRecordType() && "lookup done with non-record type");
1584
1585 QualType QRecordType = QualType(QType->getAs<RecordType>(), 0);
1586
1587 // In C++98, the qualifier type doesn't actually have to be a base
1588 // type of the object type, in which case we just ignore it.
1589 // Otherwise build the appropriate casts.
1590 if (IsDerivedFrom(FromRecordType, QRecordType)) {
John McCallcf142162010-08-07 06:22:56 +00001591 CXXCastPath BasePath;
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001592 if (CheckDerivedToBaseConversion(FromRecordType, QRecordType,
Anders Carlssonb78feca2010-04-24 19:22:20 +00001593 FromLoc, FromRange, &BasePath))
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001594 return true;
1595
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001596 if (PointerConversions)
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001597 QType = Context.getPointerType(QType);
John McCall2536c6d2010-08-25 10:28:54 +00001598 ImpCastExprToType(From, QType, CK_UncheckedDerivedToBase,
1599 VK, &BasePath);
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001600
1601 FromType = QType;
1602 FromRecordType = QRecordType;
1603
1604 // If the qualifier type was the same as the destination type,
1605 // we're done.
1606 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromRecordType, DestRecordType))
1607 return false;
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001608 }
1609 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001610
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001611 bool IgnoreAccess = false;
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001612
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001613 // If we actually found the member through a using declaration, cast
1614 // down to the using declaration's type.
1615 //
1616 // Pointer equality is fine here because only one declaration of a
1617 // class ever has member declarations.
1618 if (FoundDecl->getDeclContext() != Member->getDeclContext()) {
1619 assert(isa<UsingShadowDecl>(FoundDecl));
1620 QualType URecordType = Context.getTypeDeclType(
1621 cast<CXXRecordDecl>(FoundDecl->getDeclContext()));
1622
1623 // We only need to do this if the naming-class to declaring-class
1624 // conversion is non-trivial.
1625 if (!Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromRecordType, URecordType)) {
1626 assert(IsDerivedFrom(FromRecordType, URecordType));
John McCallcf142162010-08-07 06:22:56 +00001627 CXXCastPath BasePath;
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001628 if (CheckDerivedToBaseConversion(FromRecordType, URecordType,
Anders Carlssonb78feca2010-04-24 19:22:20 +00001629 FromLoc, FromRange, &BasePath))
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001630 return true;
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00001631
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001632 QualType UType = URecordType;
1633 if (PointerConversions)
1634 UType = Context.getPointerType(UType);
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00001635 ImpCastExprToType(From, UType, CK_UncheckedDerivedToBase,
John McCall2536c6d2010-08-25 10:28:54 +00001636 VK, &BasePath);
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001637 FromType = UType;
1638 FromRecordType = URecordType;
1639 }
1640
1641 // We don't do access control for the conversion from the
1642 // declaring class to the true declaring class.
1643 IgnoreAccess = true;
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001644 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001645
John McCallcf142162010-08-07 06:22:56 +00001646 CXXCastPath BasePath;
Anders Carlssonb78feca2010-04-24 19:22:20 +00001647 if (CheckDerivedToBaseConversion(FromRecordType, DestRecordType,
1648 FromLoc, FromRange, &BasePath,
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001649 IgnoreAccess))
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001650 return true;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001651
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00001652 ImpCastExprToType(From, DestType, CK_UncheckedDerivedToBase,
John McCall2536c6d2010-08-25 10:28:54 +00001653 VK, &BasePath);
Fariborz Jahanian3f150832009-07-29 19:40:11 +00001654 return false;
Fariborz Jahanianbb67b822009-07-29 18:40:24 +00001655}
Douglas Gregor3256d042009-06-30 15:47:41 +00001656
Douglas Gregorf405d7e2009-08-31 23:41:50 +00001657/// \brief Build a MemberExpr AST node.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001658static MemberExpr *BuildMemberExpr(ASTContext &C, Expr *Base, bool isArrow,
Eli Friedman2cfcef62009-12-04 06:40:45 +00001659 const CXXScopeSpec &SS, ValueDecl *Member,
John McCalla8ae2222010-04-06 21:38:20 +00001660 DeclAccessPair FoundDecl,
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00001661 const DeclarationNameInfo &MemberNameInfo,
1662 QualType Ty,
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001663 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs = 0) {
1664 NestedNameSpecifier *Qualifier = 0;
1665 SourceRange QualifierRange;
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00001666 if (SS.isSet()) {
1667 Qualifier = (NestedNameSpecifier *) SS.getScopeRep();
1668 QualifierRange = SS.getRange();
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001669 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001670
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001671 return MemberExpr::Create(C, Base, isArrow, Qualifier, QualifierRange,
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00001672 Member, FoundDecl, MemberNameInfo,
1673 TemplateArgs, Ty);
Douglas Gregorc1905232009-08-26 22:36:53 +00001674}
1675
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00001676/// Builds an implicit member access expression. The current context
1677/// is known to be an instance method, and the given unqualified lookup
1678/// set is known to contain only instance members, at least one of which
1679/// is from an appropriate type.
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00001680ExprResult
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00001681Sema::BuildImplicitMemberExpr(const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
1682 LookupResult &R,
1683 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs,
1684 bool IsKnownInstance) {
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001685 assert(!R.empty() && !R.isAmbiguous());
1686
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001687 SourceLocation Loc = R.getNameLoc();
Sebastian Redl3d3f75a2009-02-03 20:19:35 +00001688
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +00001689 // We may have found a field within an anonymous union or struct
1690 // (C++ [class.union]).
Douglas Gregor6493d9c2009-10-22 07:08:30 +00001691 // FIXME: This needs to happen post-isImplicitMemberReference?
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001692 // FIXME: template-ids inside anonymous structs?
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00001693 if (FieldDecl *FD = R.getAsSingle<FieldDecl>())
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +00001694 if (cast<RecordDecl>(FD->getDeclContext())->isAnonymousStructOrUnion())
John McCallb53bbd42009-11-22 01:44:31 +00001695 return BuildAnonymousStructUnionMemberReference(Loc, FD);
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001696
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00001697 // If this is known to be an instance access, go ahead and build a
1698 // 'this' expression now.
John McCall87fe5d52010-05-20 01:18:31 +00001699 DeclContext *DC = getFunctionLevelDeclContext();
1700 QualType ThisType = cast<CXXMethodDecl>(DC)->getThisType(Context);
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00001701 Expr *This = 0; // null signifies implicit access
1702 if (IsKnownInstance) {
Douglas Gregorb15af892010-01-07 23:12:05 +00001703 SourceLocation Loc = R.getNameLoc();
1704 if (SS.getRange().isValid())
1705 Loc = SS.getRange().getBegin();
1706 This = new (Context) CXXThisExpr(Loc, ThisType, /*isImplicit=*/true);
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00001707 }
1708
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00001709 return BuildMemberReferenceExpr(This, ThisType,
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00001710 /*OpLoc*/ SourceLocation(),
1711 /*IsArrow*/ true,
John McCall38836f02010-01-15 08:34:02 +00001712 SS,
1713 /*FirstQualifierInScope*/ 0,
1714 R, TemplateArgs);
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001715}
1716
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001717bool Sema::UseArgumentDependentLookup(const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
John McCallb53bbd42009-11-22 01:44:31 +00001718 const LookupResult &R,
1719 bool HasTrailingLParen) {
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001720 // Only when used directly as the postfix-expression of a call.
1721 if (!HasTrailingLParen)
1722 return false;
1723
1724 // Never if a scope specifier was provided.
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001725 if (SS.isSet())
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001726 return false;
1727
1728 // Only in C++ or ObjC++.
John McCallb53bbd42009-11-22 01:44:31 +00001729 if (!getLangOptions().CPlusPlus)
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001730 return false;
1731
1732 // Turn off ADL when we find certain kinds of declarations during
1733 // normal lookup:
1734 for (LookupResult::iterator I = R.begin(), E = R.end(); I != E; ++I) {
1735 NamedDecl *D = *I;
1736
1737 // C++0x [basic.lookup.argdep]p3:
1738 // -- a declaration of a class member
1739 // Since using decls preserve this property, we check this on the
1740 // original decl.
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00001741 if (D->isCXXClassMember())
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001742 return false;
1743
1744 // C++0x [basic.lookup.argdep]p3:
1745 // -- a block-scope function declaration that is not a
1746 // using-declaration
1747 // NOTE: we also trigger this for function templates (in fact, we
1748 // don't check the decl type at all, since all other decl types
1749 // turn off ADL anyway).
1750 if (isa<UsingShadowDecl>(D))
1751 D = cast<UsingShadowDecl>(D)->getTargetDecl();
1752 else if (D->getDeclContext()->isFunctionOrMethod())
1753 return false;
1754
1755 // C++0x [basic.lookup.argdep]p3:
1756 // -- a declaration that is neither a function or a function
1757 // template
1758 // And also for builtin functions.
1759 if (isa<FunctionDecl>(D)) {
1760 FunctionDecl *FDecl = cast<FunctionDecl>(D);
1761
1762 // But also builtin functions.
1763 if (FDecl->getBuiltinID() && FDecl->isImplicit())
1764 return false;
1765 } else if (!isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D))
1766 return false;
1767 }
1768
1769 return true;
1770}
1771
1772
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001773/// Diagnoses obvious problems with the use of the given declaration
1774/// as an expression. This is only actually called for lookups that
1775/// were not overloaded, and it doesn't promise that the declaration
1776/// will in fact be used.
1777static bool CheckDeclInExpr(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc, NamedDecl *D) {
1778 if (isa<TypedefDecl>(D)) {
1779 S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_unexpected_typedef) << D->getDeclName();
1780 return true;
1781 }
1782
1783 if (isa<ObjCInterfaceDecl>(D)) {
1784 S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_unexpected_interface) << D->getDeclName();
1785 return true;
1786 }
1787
1788 if (isa<NamespaceDecl>(D)) {
1789 S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_unexpected_namespace) << D->getDeclName();
1790 return true;
1791 }
1792
1793 return false;
1794}
1795
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00001796ExprResult
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001797Sema::BuildDeclarationNameExpr(const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
John McCallb53bbd42009-11-22 01:44:31 +00001798 LookupResult &R,
1799 bool NeedsADL) {
John McCall3a60c872009-12-08 22:45:53 +00001800 // If this is a single, fully-resolved result and we don't need ADL,
1801 // just build an ordinary singleton decl ref.
Douglas Gregor4b4844f2010-01-29 17:15:43 +00001802 if (!NeedsADL && R.isSingleResult() && !R.getAsSingle<FunctionTemplateDecl>())
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00001803 return BuildDeclarationNameExpr(SS, R.getLookupNameInfo(),
1804 R.getFoundDecl());
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001805
1806 // We only need to check the declaration if there's exactly one
1807 // result, because in the overloaded case the results can only be
1808 // functions and function templates.
John McCallb53bbd42009-11-22 01:44:31 +00001809 if (R.isSingleResult() &&
1810 CheckDeclInExpr(*this, R.getNameLoc(), R.getFoundDecl()))
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001811 return ExprError();
1812
John McCall58cc69d2010-01-27 01:50:18 +00001813 // Otherwise, just build an unresolved lookup expression. Suppress
1814 // any lookup-related diagnostics; we'll hash these out later, when
1815 // we've picked a target.
1816 R.suppressDiagnostics();
1817
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001818 bool Dependent
1819 = UnresolvedLookupExpr::ComputeDependence(R.begin(), R.end(), 0);
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001820 UnresolvedLookupExpr *ULE
John McCall58cc69d2010-01-27 01:50:18 +00001821 = UnresolvedLookupExpr::Create(Context, Dependent, R.getNamingClass(),
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001822 (NestedNameSpecifier*) SS.getScopeRep(),
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00001823 SS.getRange(), R.getLookupNameInfo(),
Douglas Gregor30a4f4c2010-05-23 18:57:34 +00001824 NeedsADL, R.isOverloadedResult(),
1825 R.begin(), R.end());
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001826
1827 return Owned(ULE);
1828}
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001829
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001830
1831/// \brief Complete semantic analysis for a reference to the given declaration.
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00001832ExprResult
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001833Sema::BuildDeclarationNameExpr(const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00001834 const DeclarationNameInfo &NameInfo,
1835 NamedDecl *D) {
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001836 assert(D && "Cannot refer to a NULL declaration");
John McCall283b9012009-11-22 00:44:51 +00001837 assert(!isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D) &&
1838 "Cannot refer unambiguously to a function template");
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001839
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00001840 SourceLocation Loc = NameInfo.getLoc();
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001841 if (CheckDeclInExpr(*this, Loc, D))
1842 return ExprError();
Steve Narofff1e53692007-03-23 22:27:02 +00001843
Douglas Gregore7488b92009-12-01 16:58:18 +00001844 if (TemplateDecl *Template = dyn_cast<TemplateDecl>(D)) {
1845 // Specifically diagnose references to class templates that are missing
1846 // a template argument list.
1847 Diag(Loc, diag::err_template_decl_ref)
1848 << Template << SS.getRange();
1849 Diag(Template->getLocation(), diag::note_template_decl_here);
1850 return ExprError();
1851 }
1852
1853 // Make sure that we're referring to a value.
1854 ValueDecl *VD = dyn_cast<ValueDecl>(D);
1855 if (!VD) {
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001856 Diag(Loc, diag::err_ref_non_value)
Douglas Gregore7488b92009-12-01 16:58:18 +00001857 << D << SS.getRange();
John McCallb48971d2009-12-18 18:35:10 +00001858 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_declared_at);
Douglas Gregore7488b92009-12-01 16:58:18 +00001859 return ExprError();
1860 }
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001861
Douglas Gregor171c45a2009-02-18 21:56:37 +00001862 // Check whether this declaration can be used. Note that we suppress
1863 // this check when we're going to perform argument-dependent lookup
1864 // on this function name, because this might not be the function
1865 // that overload resolution actually selects.
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001866 if (DiagnoseUseOfDecl(VD, Loc))
Douglas Gregor171c45a2009-02-18 21:56:37 +00001867 return ExprError();
1868
Steve Naroff8de9c3a2008-09-05 22:11:13 +00001869 // Only create DeclRefExpr's for valid Decl's.
1870 if (VD->isInvalidDecl())
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001871 return ExprError();
1872
Chris Lattner2a9d9892008-10-20 05:16:36 +00001873 // If the identifier reference is inside a block, and it refers to a value
1874 // that is outside the block, create a BlockDeclRefExpr instead of a
1875 // DeclRefExpr. This ensures the value is treated as a copy-in snapshot when
1876 // the block is formed.
Steve Naroff8de9c3a2008-09-05 22:11:13 +00001877 //
Chris Lattner2a9d9892008-10-20 05:16:36 +00001878 // We do not do this for things like enum constants, global variables, etc,
1879 // as they do not get snapshotted.
1880 //
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001881 if (getCurBlock() &&
Douglas Gregor9a28e842010-03-01 23:15:13 +00001882 ShouldSnapshotBlockValueReference(*this, getCurBlock(), VD)) {
Mike Stump7dafa0d2010-01-05 02:56:35 +00001883 if (VD->getType().getTypePtr()->isVariablyModifiedType()) {
1884 Diag(Loc, diag::err_ref_vm_type);
1885 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_declared_at);
1886 return ExprError();
1887 }
1888
Fariborz Jahanianfa24e102010-03-16 23:39:51 +00001889 if (VD->getType()->isArrayType()) {
Mike Stump8971a862010-01-05 03:10:36 +00001890 Diag(Loc, diag::err_ref_array_type);
1891 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_declared_at);
1892 return ExprError();
1893 }
1894
Douglas Gregorc9c02ed2009-06-19 23:52:42 +00001895 MarkDeclarationReferenced(Loc, VD);
Eli Friedman7fa3faa2009-03-22 23:00:19 +00001896 QualType ExprTy = VD->getType().getNonReferenceType();
Steve Naroff1d95e5a2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00001897 // The BlocksAttr indicates the variable is bound by-reference.
Argyrios Kyrtzidisb4b64ca2009-06-30 02:34:44 +00001898 if (VD->getAttr<BlocksAttr>())
Eli Friedman7fa3faa2009-03-22 23:00:19 +00001899 return Owned(new (Context) BlockDeclRefExpr(VD, ExprTy, Loc, true));
Fariborz Jahanian3fd73102009-06-19 23:37:08 +00001900 // This is to record that a 'const' was actually synthesize and added.
1901 bool constAdded = !ExprTy.isConstQualified();
Steve Naroff1d95e5a2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00001902 // Variable will be bound by-copy, make it const within the closure.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001903
Eli Friedman7fa3faa2009-03-22 23:00:19 +00001904 ExprTy.addConst();
Fariborz Jahanian70c0b082010-07-12 17:26:57 +00001905 QualType T = VD->getType();
Fariborz Jahanianea882cd2010-06-04 21:35:44 +00001906 BlockDeclRefExpr *BDRE = new (Context) BlockDeclRefExpr(VD,
1907 ExprTy, Loc, false,
Fariborz Jahanianc289bce2010-07-12 18:12:03 +00001908 constAdded);
Fariborz Jahanian4239aa12010-07-09 22:21:32 +00001909 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
1910 if (!T->isDependentType() && !T->isReferenceType()) {
1911 Expr *E = new (Context)
1912 DeclRefExpr(const_cast<ValueDecl*>(BDRE->getDecl()), T,
1913 SourceLocation());
Fariborz Jahanian2a5deb52010-11-11 00:11:38 +00001914 if (T->getAs<RecordType>())
1915 if (!T->isUnionType()) {
1916 ExprResult Res = PerformCopyInitialization(
Fariborz Jahanian4239aa12010-07-09 22:21:32 +00001917 InitializedEntity::InitializeBlock(VD->getLocation(),
Fariborz Jahanian28ed9272010-06-07 16:14:00 +00001918 T, false),
Fariborz Jahanian4239aa12010-07-09 22:21:32 +00001919 SourceLocation(),
1920 Owned(E));
Fariborz Jahanian2a5deb52010-11-11 00:11:38 +00001921 if (!Res.isInvalid()) {
1922 Res = MaybeCreateCXXExprWithTemporaries(Res.get());
1923 Expr *Init = Res.takeAs<Expr>();
1924 BDRE->setCopyConstructorExpr(Init);
1925 }
Fariborz Jahanian4239aa12010-07-09 22:21:32 +00001926 }
Fariborz Jahanianea882cd2010-06-04 21:35:44 +00001927 }
1928 }
1929 return Owned(BDRE);
Steve Naroff1d95e5a2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00001930 }
1931 // If this reference is not in a block or if the referenced variable is
1932 // within the block, create a normal DeclRefExpr.
Douglas Gregor4619e432008-12-05 23:32:09 +00001933
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00001934 return BuildDeclRefExpr(VD, VD->getType().getNonReferenceType(),
1935 NameInfo, &SS);
Chris Lattner17ed4872006-11-20 04:58:19 +00001936}
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00001937
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00001938ExprResult Sema::ActOnPredefinedExpr(SourceLocation Loc,
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001939 tok::TokenKind Kind) {
Chris Lattner6307f192008-08-10 01:53:14 +00001940 PredefinedExpr::IdentType IT;
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001941
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00001942 switch (Kind) {
Chris Lattner317e6ba2008-01-12 18:39:25 +00001943 default: assert(0 && "Unknown simple primary expr!");
Chris Lattner6307f192008-08-10 01:53:14 +00001944 case tok::kw___func__: IT = PredefinedExpr::Func; break; // [C99 6.4.2.2]
1945 case tok::kw___FUNCTION__: IT = PredefinedExpr::Function; break;
1946 case tok::kw___PRETTY_FUNCTION__: IT = PredefinedExpr::PrettyFunction; break;
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00001947 }
Chris Lattner317e6ba2008-01-12 18:39:25 +00001948
Chris Lattnera81a0272008-01-12 08:14:25 +00001949 // Pre-defined identifiers are of type char[x], where x is the length of the
1950 // string.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001951
Anders Carlsson2fb08242009-09-08 18:24:21 +00001952 Decl *currentDecl = getCurFunctionOrMethodDecl();
Fariborz Jahanian94627442010-07-23 21:53:24 +00001953 if (!currentDecl && getCurBlock())
1954 currentDecl = getCurBlock()->TheDecl;
Anders Carlsson2fb08242009-09-08 18:24:21 +00001955 if (!currentDecl) {
Chris Lattnerf45c5ec2008-12-12 05:05:20 +00001956 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_predef_outside_function);
Anders Carlsson2fb08242009-09-08 18:24:21 +00001957 currentDecl = Context.getTranslationUnitDecl();
Chris Lattnerf45c5ec2008-12-12 05:05:20 +00001958 }
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001959
Anders Carlsson0b209a82009-09-11 01:22:35 +00001960 QualType ResTy;
1961 if (cast<DeclContext>(currentDecl)->isDependentContext()) {
1962 ResTy = Context.DependentTy;
1963 } else {
Anders Carlsson5bd8d192010-02-11 18:20:28 +00001964 unsigned Length = PredefinedExpr::ComputeName(IT, currentDecl).length();
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001965
Anders Carlsson0b209a82009-09-11 01:22:35 +00001966 llvm::APInt LengthI(32, Length + 1);
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00001967 ResTy = Context.CharTy.withConst();
Anders Carlsson0b209a82009-09-11 01:22:35 +00001968 ResTy = Context.getConstantArrayType(ResTy, LengthI, ArrayType::Normal, 0);
1969 }
Steve Narofff6009ed2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00001970 return Owned(new (Context) PredefinedExpr(Loc, ResTy, IT));
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00001971}
1972
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00001973ExprResult Sema::ActOnCharacterConstant(const Token &Tok) {
Chris Lattner23b7eb62007-06-15 23:05:46 +00001974 llvm::SmallString<16> CharBuffer;
Douglas Gregordc970f02010-03-16 22:30:13 +00001975 bool Invalid = false;
1976 llvm::StringRef ThisTok = PP.getSpelling(Tok, CharBuffer, &Invalid);
1977 if (Invalid)
1978 return ExprError();
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001979
Benjamin Kramer0a1abd42010-02-27 13:44:12 +00001980 CharLiteralParser Literal(ThisTok.begin(), ThisTok.end(), Tok.getLocation(),
1981 PP);
Steve Naroffae4143e2007-04-26 20:39:23 +00001982 if (Literal.hadError())
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001983 return ExprError();
Chris Lattneref24b382008-03-01 08:32:21 +00001984
Chris Lattnerc3847ba2009-12-30 21:19:39 +00001985 QualType Ty;
1986 if (!getLangOptions().CPlusPlus)
1987 Ty = Context.IntTy; // 'x' and L'x' -> int in C.
1988 else if (Literal.isWide())
1989 Ty = Context.WCharTy; // L'x' -> wchar_t in C++.
Eli Friedmaneb1df702010-02-03 18:21:45 +00001990 else if (Literal.isMultiChar())
1991 Ty = Context.IntTy; // 'wxyz' -> int in C++.
Chris Lattnerc3847ba2009-12-30 21:19:39 +00001992 else
1993 Ty = Context.CharTy; // 'x' -> char in C++
Chris Lattneref24b382008-03-01 08:32:21 +00001994
Sebastian Redl20614a72009-01-20 22:23:13 +00001995 return Owned(new (Context) CharacterLiteral(Literal.getValue(),
1996 Literal.isWide(),
Chris Lattnerc3847ba2009-12-30 21:19:39 +00001997 Ty, Tok.getLocation()));
Steve Naroffae4143e2007-04-26 20:39:23 +00001998}
1999
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00002000ExprResult Sema::ActOnNumericConstant(const Token &Tok) {
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002001 // Fast path for a single digit (which is quite common). A single digit
Steve Narofff2fb89e2007-03-13 20:29:44 +00002002 // cannot have a trigraph, escaped newline, radix prefix, or type suffix.
2003 if (Tok.getLength() == 1) {
Chris Lattner9240b3e2009-01-26 22:36:52 +00002004 const char Val = PP.getSpellingOfSingleCharacterNumericConstant(Tok);
Chris Lattnerc4c18192009-01-16 07:10:29 +00002005 unsigned IntSize = Context.Target.getIntWidth();
Argyrios Kyrtzidis43b20572010-08-28 09:06:06 +00002006 return Owned(IntegerLiteral::Create(Context, llvm::APInt(IntSize, Val-'0'),
Steve Naroff5faaef72009-01-20 19:53:53 +00002007 Context.IntTy, Tok.getLocation()));
Steve Narofff2fb89e2007-03-13 20:29:44 +00002008 }
Ted Kremeneke9814182009-01-13 23:19:12 +00002009
Chris Lattner23b7eb62007-06-15 23:05:46 +00002010 llvm::SmallString<512> IntegerBuffer;
Chris Lattnera1cf5f92008-09-30 20:53:45 +00002011 // Add padding so that NumericLiteralParser can overread by one character.
2012 IntegerBuffer.resize(Tok.getLength()+1);
Steve Naroff8160ea22007-03-06 01:09:46 +00002013 const char *ThisTokBegin = &IntegerBuffer[0];
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002014
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00002015 // Get the spelling of the token, which eliminates trigraphs, etc.
Douglas Gregordc970f02010-03-16 22:30:13 +00002016 bool Invalid = false;
2017 unsigned ActualLength = PP.getSpelling(Tok, ThisTokBegin, &Invalid);
2018 if (Invalid)
2019 return ExprError();
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002020
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002021 NumericLiteralParser Literal(ThisTokBegin, ThisTokBegin+ActualLength,
Steve Naroff451d8f162007-03-12 23:22:38 +00002022 Tok.getLocation(), PP);
Steve Narofff2fb89e2007-03-13 20:29:44 +00002023 if (Literal.hadError)
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002024 return ExprError();
2025
Chris Lattner1c20a172007-08-26 03:42:43 +00002026 Expr *Res;
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002027
Chris Lattner1c20a172007-08-26 03:42:43 +00002028 if (Literal.isFloatingLiteral()) {
Chris Lattnerec0a6d92007-09-22 18:29:59 +00002029 QualType Ty;
Chris Lattner9a8d1d92008-06-30 18:32:54 +00002030 if (Literal.isFloat)
Chris Lattnerec0a6d92007-09-22 18:29:59 +00002031 Ty = Context.FloatTy;
Chris Lattner9a8d1d92008-06-30 18:32:54 +00002032 else if (!Literal.isLong)
Chris Lattnerec0a6d92007-09-22 18:29:59 +00002033 Ty = Context.DoubleTy;
Chris Lattner9a8d1d92008-06-30 18:32:54 +00002034 else
Chris Lattner7570e9c2008-03-08 08:52:55 +00002035 Ty = Context.LongDoubleTy;
Chris Lattner9a8d1d92008-06-30 18:32:54 +00002036
2037 const llvm::fltSemantics &Format = Context.getFloatTypeSemantics(Ty);
2038
John McCall53b93a02009-12-24 09:08:04 +00002039 using llvm::APFloat;
2040 APFloat Val(Format);
2041
2042 APFloat::opStatus result = Literal.GetFloatValue(Val);
John McCall122c8312009-12-24 11:09:08 +00002043
2044 // Overflow is always an error, but underflow is only an error if
2045 // we underflowed to zero (APFloat reports denormals as underflow).
2046 if ((result & APFloat::opOverflow) ||
2047 ((result & APFloat::opUnderflow) && Val.isZero())) {
John McCall53b93a02009-12-24 09:08:04 +00002048 unsigned diagnostic;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00002049 llvm::SmallString<20> buffer;
John McCall53b93a02009-12-24 09:08:04 +00002050 if (result & APFloat::opOverflow) {
John McCall62abc942010-02-26 23:35:57 +00002051 diagnostic = diag::warn_float_overflow;
John McCall53b93a02009-12-24 09:08:04 +00002052 APFloat::getLargest(Format).toString(buffer);
2053 } else {
John McCall62abc942010-02-26 23:35:57 +00002054 diagnostic = diag::warn_float_underflow;
John McCall53b93a02009-12-24 09:08:04 +00002055 APFloat::getSmallest(Format).toString(buffer);
2056 }
2057
2058 Diag(Tok.getLocation(), diagnostic)
2059 << Ty
2060 << llvm::StringRef(buffer.data(), buffer.size());
2061 }
2062
2063 bool isExact = (result == APFloat::opOK);
Argyrios Kyrtzidis43b20572010-08-28 09:06:06 +00002064 Res = FloatingLiteral::Create(Context, Val, isExact, Ty, Tok.getLocation());
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002065
Chris Lattner1c20a172007-08-26 03:42:43 +00002066 } else if (!Literal.isIntegerLiteral()) {
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002067 return ExprError();
Chris Lattner1c20a172007-08-26 03:42:43 +00002068 } else {
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00002069 QualType Ty;
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00002070
Neil Boothac582c52007-08-29 22:00:19 +00002071 // long long is a C99 feature.
2072 if (!getLangOptions().C99 && !getLangOptions().CPlusPlus0x &&
Neil Booth4a1ee052007-08-29 22:13:52 +00002073 Literal.isLongLong)
Neil Boothac582c52007-08-29 22:00:19 +00002074 Diag(Tok.getLocation(), diag::ext_longlong);
2075
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00002076 // Get the value in the widest-possible width.
Chris Lattner37e05872008-03-05 18:54:05 +00002077 llvm::APInt ResultVal(Context.Target.getIntMaxTWidth(), 0);
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002078
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00002079 if (Literal.GetIntegerValue(ResultVal)) {
2080 // If this value didn't fit into uintmax_t, warn and force to ull.
2081 Diag(Tok.getLocation(), diag::warn_integer_too_large);
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00002082 Ty = Context.UnsignedLongLongTy;
2083 assert(Context.getTypeSize(Ty) == ResultVal.getBitWidth() &&
Chris Lattner37e05872008-03-05 18:54:05 +00002084 "long long is not intmax_t?");
Steve Naroff09ef4742007-03-09 23:16:33 +00002085 } else {
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00002086 // If this value fits into a ULL, try to figure out what else it fits into
2087 // according to the rules of C99 6.4.4.1p5.
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002088
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00002089 // Octal, Hexadecimal, and integers with a U suffix are allowed to
2090 // be an unsigned int.
2091 bool AllowUnsigned = Literal.isUnsigned || Literal.getRadix() != 10;
2092
2093 // Check from smallest to largest, picking the smallest type we can.
Chris Lattner55258cf2008-05-09 05:59:00 +00002094 unsigned Width = 0;
Chris Lattner7b939cf2007-08-23 21:58:08 +00002095 if (!Literal.isLong && !Literal.isLongLong) {
2096 // Are int/unsigned possibilities?
Chris Lattner55258cf2008-05-09 05:59:00 +00002097 unsigned IntSize = Context.Target.getIntWidth();
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002098
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00002099 // Does it fit in a unsigned int?
2100 if (ResultVal.isIntN(IntSize)) {
2101 // Does it fit in a signed int?
2102 if (!Literal.isUnsigned && ResultVal[IntSize-1] == 0)
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00002103 Ty = Context.IntTy;
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00002104 else if (AllowUnsigned)
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00002105 Ty = Context.UnsignedIntTy;
Chris Lattner55258cf2008-05-09 05:59:00 +00002106 Width = IntSize;
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00002107 }
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00002108 }
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002109
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00002110 // Are long/unsigned long possibilities?
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00002111 if (Ty.isNull() && !Literal.isLongLong) {
Chris Lattner55258cf2008-05-09 05:59:00 +00002112 unsigned LongSize = Context.Target.getLongWidth();
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002113
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00002114 // Does it fit in a unsigned long?
2115 if (ResultVal.isIntN(LongSize)) {
2116 // Does it fit in a signed long?
2117 if (!Literal.isUnsigned && ResultVal[LongSize-1] == 0)
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00002118 Ty = Context.LongTy;
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00002119 else if (AllowUnsigned)
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00002120 Ty = Context.UnsignedLongTy;
Chris Lattner55258cf2008-05-09 05:59:00 +00002121 Width = LongSize;
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00002122 }
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002123 }
2124
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00002125 // Finally, check long long if needed.
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00002126 if (Ty.isNull()) {
Chris Lattner55258cf2008-05-09 05:59:00 +00002127 unsigned LongLongSize = Context.Target.getLongLongWidth();
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002128
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00002129 // Does it fit in a unsigned long long?
2130 if (ResultVal.isIntN(LongLongSize)) {
2131 // Does it fit in a signed long long?
2132 if (!Literal.isUnsigned && ResultVal[LongLongSize-1] == 0)
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00002133 Ty = Context.LongLongTy;
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00002134 else if (AllowUnsigned)
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00002135 Ty = Context.UnsignedLongLongTy;
Chris Lattner55258cf2008-05-09 05:59:00 +00002136 Width = LongLongSize;
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00002137 }
2138 }
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002139
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00002140 // If we still couldn't decide a type, we probably have something that
2141 // does not fit in a signed long long, but has no U suffix.
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00002142 if (Ty.isNull()) {
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00002143 Diag(Tok.getLocation(), diag::warn_integer_too_large_for_signed);
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00002144 Ty = Context.UnsignedLongLongTy;
Chris Lattner55258cf2008-05-09 05:59:00 +00002145 Width = Context.Target.getLongLongWidth();
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00002146 }
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002147
Chris Lattner55258cf2008-05-09 05:59:00 +00002148 if (ResultVal.getBitWidth() != Width)
2149 ResultVal.trunc(Width);
Steve Naroff09ef4742007-03-09 23:16:33 +00002150 }
Argyrios Kyrtzidis43b20572010-08-28 09:06:06 +00002151 Res = IntegerLiteral::Create(Context, ResultVal, Ty, Tok.getLocation());
Steve Naroff09ef4742007-03-09 23:16:33 +00002152 }
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002153
Chris Lattner1c20a172007-08-26 03:42:43 +00002154 // If this is an imaginary literal, create the ImaginaryLiteral wrapper.
2155 if (Literal.isImaginary)
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002156 Res = new (Context) ImaginaryLiteral(Res,
Steve Narofff6009ed2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00002157 Context.getComplexType(Res->getType()));
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002158
2159 return Owned(Res);
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00002160}
2161
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00002162ExprResult Sema::ActOnParenExpr(SourceLocation L,
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00002163 SourceLocation R, Expr *E) {
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00002164 assert((E != 0) && "ActOnParenExpr() missing expr");
Steve Narofff6009ed2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00002165 return Owned(new (Context) ParenExpr(L, R, E));
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00002166}
2167
Steve Naroff71b59a92007-06-04 22:22:31 +00002168/// The UsualUnaryConversions() function is *not* called by this routine.
Steve Naroffa78fe7e2007-05-16 19:47:19 +00002169/// See C99 6.3.2.1p[2-4] for more details.
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00002170bool Sema::CheckSizeOfAlignOfOperand(QualType exprType,
Sebastian Redl6f282892008-11-11 17:56:53 +00002171 SourceLocation OpLoc,
John McCall36e7fe32010-10-12 00:20:44 +00002172 SourceRange ExprRange,
Sebastian Redl6f282892008-11-11 17:56:53 +00002173 bool isSizeof) {
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00002174 if (exprType->isDependentType())
2175 return false;
2176
Sebastian Redl22e2e5c2009-11-23 17:18:46 +00002177 // C++ [expr.sizeof]p2: "When applied to a reference or a reference type,
2178 // the result is the size of the referenced type."
2179 // C++ [expr.alignof]p3: "When alignof is applied to a reference type, the
2180 // result shall be the alignment of the referenced type."
2181 if (const ReferenceType *Ref = exprType->getAs<ReferenceType>())
2182 exprType = Ref->getPointeeType();
2183
Steve Naroff043d45d2007-05-15 02:32:35 +00002184 // C99 6.5.3.4p1:
John McCall4c98fd82009-11-04 07:28:41 +00002185 if (exprType->isFunctionType()) {
Chris Lattner62975a72009-04-24 00:30:45 +00002186 // alignof(function) is allowed as an extension.
Chris Lattnerb1355b12009-01-24 19:46:37 +00002187 if (isSizeof)
2188 Diag(OpLoc, diag::ext_sizeof_function_type) << ExprRange;
2189 return false;
2190 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002191
Chris Lattner62975a72009-04-24 00:30:45 +00002192 // Allow sizeof(void)/alignof(void) as an extension.
Chris Lattnerb1355b12009-01-24 19:46:37 +00002193 if (exprType->isVoidType()) {
Chris Lattner3b054132008-11-19 05:08:23 +00002194 Diag(OpLoc, diag::ext_sizeof_void_type)
2195 << (isSizeof ? "sizeof" : "__alignof") << ExprRange;
Chris Lattnerb1355b12009-01-24 19:46:37 +00002196 return false;
2197 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002198
Chris Lattner62975a72009-04-24 00:30:45 +00002199 if (RequireCompleteType(OpLoc, exprType,
Douglas Gregor906db8a2009-12-15 16:44:32 +00002200 PDiag(diag::err_sizeof_alignof_incomplete_type)
2201 << int(!isSizeof) << ExprRange))
Chris Lattner62975a72009-04-24 00:30:45 +00002202 return true;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002203
Chris Lattner62975a72009-04-24 00:30:45 +00002204 // Reject sizeof(interface) and sizeof(interface<proto>) in 64-bit mode.
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00002205 if (LangOpts.ObjCNonFragileABI && exprType->isObjCObjectType()) {
Chris Lattner62975a72009-04-24 00:30:45 +00002206 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_sizeof_nonfragile_interface)
Chris Lattnercd2a8c52009-04-24 22:30:50 +00002207 << exprType << isSizeof << ExprRange;
2208 return true;
Chris Lattner37920f52009-04-21 19:55:16 +00002209 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002210
Chris Lattner62975a72009-04-24 00:30:45 +00002211 return false;
Steve Naroff043d45d2007-05-15 02:32:35 +00002212}
2213
John McCall36e7fe32010-10-12 00:20:44 +00002214static bool CheckAlignOfExpr(Sema &S, Expr *E, SourceLocation OpLoc,
2215 SourceRange ExprRange) {
Chris Lattner8dff0172009-01-24 20:17:12 +00002216 E = E->IgnoreParens();
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00002217
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002218 // alignof decl is always ok.
Chris Lattner8dff0172009-01-24 20:17:12 +00002219 if (isa<DeclRefExpr>(E))
2220 return false;
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00002221
2222 // Cannot know anything else if the expression is dependent.
2223 if (E->isTypeDependent())
2224 return false;
2225
Douglas Gregor71235ec2009-05-02 02:18:30 +00002226 if (E->getBitField()) {
John McCall36e7fe32010-10-12 00:20:44 +00002227 S. Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_sizeof_alignof_bitfield) << 1 << ExprRange;
Douglas Gregor71235ec2009-05-02 02:18:30 +00002228 return true;
Chris Lattner8dff0172009-01-24 20:17:12 +00002229 }
Douglas Gregor71235ec2009-05-02 02:18:30 +00002230
2231 // Alignment of a field access is always okay, so long as it isn't a
2232 // bit-field.
2233 if (MemberExpr *ME = dyn_cast<MemberExpr>(E))
Mike Stump212005c2009-07-22 18:58:19 +00002234 if (isa<FieldDecl>(ME->getMemberDecl()))
Douglas Gregor71235ec2009-05-02 02:18:30 +00002235 return false;
2236
John McCall36e7fe32010-10-12 00:20:44 +00002237 return S.CheckSizeOfAlignOfOperand(E->getType(), OpLoc, ExprRange, false);
Chris Lattner8dff0172009-01-24 20:17:12 +00002238}
2239
Douglas Gregor0950e412009-03-13 21:01:28 +00002240/// \brief Build a sizeof or alignof expression given a type operand.
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00002241ExprResult
John McCallbcd03502009-12-07 02:54:59 +00002242Sema::CreateSizeOfAlignOfExpr(TypeSourceInfo *TInfo,
John McCall4c98fd82009-11-04 07:28:41 +00002243 SourceLocation OpLoc,
Douglas Gregor0950e412009-03-13 21:01:28 +00002244 bool isSizeOf, SourceRange R) {
John McCallbcd03502009-12-07 02:54:59 +00002245 if (!TInfo)
Douglas Gregor0950e412009-03-13 21:01:28 +00002246 return ExprError();
2247
John McCallbcd03502009-12-07 02:54:59 +00002248 QualType T = TInfo->getType();
John McCall4c98fd82009-11-04 07:28:41 +00002249
Douglas Gregor0950e412009-03-13 21:01:28 +00002250 if (!T->isDependentType() &&
2251 CheckSizeOfAlignOfOperand(T, OpLoc, R, isSizeOf))
2252 return ExprError();
2253
2254 // C99 6.5.3.4p4: the type (an unsigned integer type) is size_t.
John McCallbcd03502009-12-07 02:54:59 +00002255 return Owned(new (Context) SizeOfAlignOfExpr(isSizeOf, TInfo,
Douglas Gregor0950e412009-03-13 21:01:28 +00002256 Context.getSizeType(), OpLoc,
2257 R.getEnd()));
2258}
2259
2260/// \brief Build a sizeof or alignof expression given an expression
2261/// operand.
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00002262ExprResult
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002263Sema::CreateSizeOfAlignOfExpr(Expr *E, SourceLocation OpLoc,
Douglas Gregor0950e412009-03-13 21:01:28 +00002264 bool isSizeOf, SourceRange R) {
2265 // Verify that the operand is valid.
2266 bool isInvalid = false;
2267 if (E->isTypeDependent()) {
2268 // Delay type-checking for type-dependent expressions.
2269 } else if (!isSizeOf) {
John McCall36e7fe32010-10-12 00:20:44 +00002270 isInvalid = CheckAlignOfExpr(*this, E, OpLoc, R);
Douglas Gregor71235ec2009-05-02 02:18:30 +00002271 } else if (E->getBitField()) { // C99 6.5.3.4p1.
Douglas Gregor0950e412009-03-13 21:01:28 +00002272 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_sizeof_alignof_bitfield) << 0;
2273 isInvalid = true;
John McCall36226622010-10-12 02:09:17 +00002274 } else if (E->getType()->isPlaceholderType()) {
2275 ExprResult PE = CheckPlaceholderExpr(E, OpLoc);
2276 if (PE.isInvalid()) return ExprError();
2277 return CreateSizeOfAlignOfExpr(PE.take(), OpLoc, isSizeOf, R);
Douglas Gregor0950e412009-03-13 21:01:28 +00002278 } else {
2279 isInvalid = CheckSizeOfAlignOfOperand(E->getType(), OpLoc, R, true);
2280 }
2281
2282 if (isInvalid)
2283 return ExprError();
2284
2285 // C99 6.5.3.4p4: the type (an unsigned integer type) is size_t.
2286 return Owned(new (Context) SizeOfAlignOfExpr(isSizeOf, E,
2287 Context.getSizeType(), OpLoc,
2288 R.getEnd()));
2289}
2290
Sebastian Redl6f282892008-11-11 17:56:53 +00002291/// ActOnSizeOfAlignOfExpr - Handle @c sizeof(type) and @c sizeof @c expr and
2292/// the same for @c alignof and @c __alignof
2293/// Note that the ArgRange is invalid if isType is false.
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00002294ExprResult
Sebastian Redl6f282892008-11-11 17:56:53 +00002295Sema::ActOnSizeOfAlignOfExpr(SourceLocation OpLoc, bool isSizeof, bool isType,
2296 void *TyOrEx, const SourceRange &ArgRange) {
Chris Lattner0d8b1a12006-11-20 04:34:45 +00002297 // If error parsing type, ignore.
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00002298 if (TyOrEx == 0) return ExprError();
Steve Naroff043d45d2007-05-15 02:32:35 +00002299
Sebastian Redl6f282892008-11-11 17:56:53 +00002300 if (isType) {
John McCallbcd03502009-12-07 02:54:59 +00002301 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo;
John McCallba7bf592010-08-24 05:47:05 +00002302 (void) GetTypeFromParser(ParsedType::getFromOpaquePtr(TyOrEx), &TInfo);
John McCallbcd03502009-12-07 02:54:59 +00002303 return CreateSizeOfAlignOfExpr(TInfo, OpLoc, isSizeof, ArgRange);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002304 }
Sebastian Redl6f282892008-11-11 17:56:53 +00002305
Douglas Gregor0950e412009-03-13 21:01:28 +00002306 Expr *ArgEx = (Expr *)TyOrEx;
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00002307 ExprResult Result
Douglas Gregor0950e412009-03-13 21:01:28 +00002308 = CreateSizeOfAlignOfExpr(ArgEx, OpLoc, isSizeof, ArgEx->getSourceRange());
2309
Douglas Gregor0950e412009-03-13 21:01:28 +00002310 return move(Result);
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00002311}
2312
Chris Lattner709322b2009-02-17 08:12:06 +00002313QualType Sema::CheckRealImagOperand(Expr *&V, SourceLocation Loc, bool isReal) {
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00002314 if (V->isTypeDependent())
2315 return Context.DependentTy;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002316
Chris Lattnere267f5d2007-08-26 05:39:26 +00002317 // These operators return the element type of a complex type.
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00002318 if (const ComplexType *CT = V->getType()->getAs<ComplexType>())
Chris Lattner30b5dd02007-08-24 21:16:53 +00002319 return CT->getElementType();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002320
Chris Lattnere267f5d2007-08-26 05:39:26 +00002321 // Otherwise they pass through real integer and floating point types here.
2322 if (V->getType()->isArithmeticType())
2323 return V->getType();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002324
John McCall36226622010-10-12 02:09:17 +00002325 // Test for placeholders.
2326 ExprResult PR = CheckPlaceholderExpr(V, Loc);
2327 if (PR.isInvalid()) return QualType();
2328 if (PR.take() != V) {
2329 V = PR.take();
2330 return CheckRealImagOperand(V, Loc, isReal);
2331 }
2332
Chris Lattnere267f5d2007-08-26 05:39:26 +00002333 // Reject anything else.
Chris Lattner709322b2009-02-17 08:12:06 +00002334 Diag(Loc, diag::err_realimag_invalid_type) << V->getType()
2335 << (isReal ? "__real" : "__imag");
Chris Lattnere267f5d2007-08-26 05:39:26 +00002336 return QualType();
Chris Lattner30b5dd02007-08-24 21:16:53 +00002337}
2338
2339
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00002340
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00002341ExprResult
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00002342Sema::ActOnPostfixUnaryOp(Scope *S, SourceLocation OpLoc,
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00002343 tok::TokenKind Kind, Expr *Input) {
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00002344 UnaryOperatorKind Opc;
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00002345 switch (Kind) {
2346 default: assert(0 && "Unknown unary op!");
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00002347 case tok::plusplus: Opc = UO_PostInc; break;
2348 case tok::minusminus: Opc = UO_PostDec; break;
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00002349 }
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00002350
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00002351 return BuildUnaryOp(S, OpLoc, Opc, Input);
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00002352}
2353
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00002354ExprResult
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00002355Sema::ActOnArraySubscriptExpr(Scope *S, Expr *Base, SourceLocation LLoc,
2356 Expr *Idx, SourceLocation RLoc) {
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00002357 // Since this might be a postfix expression, get rid of ParenListExprs.
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00002358 ExprResult Result = MaybeConvertParenListExprToParenExpr(S, Base);
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00002359 if (Result.isInvalid()) return ExprError();
2360 Base = Result.take();
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00002361
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00002362 Expr *LHSExp = Base, *RHSExp = Idx;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002363
Douglas Gregor40412ac2008-11-19 17:17:41 +00002364 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus &&
Douglas Gregor7a77a6b2009-05-19 00:01:19 +00002365 (LHSExp->isTypeDependent() || RHSExp->isTypeDependent())) {
Douglas Gregor7a77a6b2009-05-19 00:01:19 +00002366 return Owned(new (Context) ArraySubscriptExpr(LHSExp, RHSExp,
2367 Context.DependentTy, RLoc));
2368 }
2369
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002370 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus &&
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00002371 (LHSExp->getType()->isRecordType() ||
Eli Friedman254a1a22008-12-15 22:34:21 +00002372 LHSExp->getType()->isEnumeralType() ||
2373 RHSExp->getType()->isRecordType() ||
2374 RHSExp->getType()->isEnumeralType())) {
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00002375 return CreateOverloadedArraySubscriptExpr(LLoc, RLoc, Base, Idx);
Douglas Gregor40412ac2008-11-19 17:17:41 +00002376 }
2377
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00002378 return CreateBuiltinArraySubscriptExpr(Base, LLoc, Idx, RLoc);
Sebastian Redladba46e2009-10-29 20:17:01 +00002379}
2380
2381
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00002382ExprResult
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00002383Sema::CreateBuiltinArraySubscriptExpr(Expr *Base, SourceLocation LLoc,
2384 Expr *Idx, SourceLocation RLoc) {
2385 Expr *LHSExp = Base;
2386 Expr *RHSExp = Idx;
Sebastian Redladba46e2009-10-29 20:17:01 +00002387
Chris Lattner36d572b2007-07-16 00:14:47 +00002388 // Perform default conversions.
Douglas Gregorb92a1562010-02-03 00:27:59 +00002389 if (!LHSExp->getType()->getAs<VectorType>())
2390 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(LHSExp);
2391 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(RHSExp);
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00002392
Chris Lattner36d572b2007-07-16 00:14:47 +00002393 QualType LHSTy = LHSExp->getType(), RHSTy = RHSExp->getType();
Steve Narofff1e53692007-03-23 22:27:02 +00002394
Steve Naroffc1aadb12007-03-28 21:49:40 +00002395 // C99 6.5.2.1p2: the expression e1[e2] is by definition precisely equivalent
Chris Lattnerf17bd422007-08-30 17:45:32 +00002396 // to the expression *((e1)+(e2)). This means the array "Base" may actually be
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002397 // in the subscript position. As a result, we need to derive the array base
Steve Narofff1e53692007-03-23 22:27:02 +00002398 // and index from the expression types.
Chris Lattner36d572b2007-07-16 00:14:47 +00002399 Expr *BaseExpr, *IndexExpr;
2400 QualType ResultType;
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00002401 if (LHSTy->isDependentType() || RHSTy->isDependentType()) {
2402 BaseExpr = LHSExp;
2403 IndexExpr = RHSExp;
2404 ResultType = Context.DependentTy;
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00002405 } else if (const PointerType *PTy = LHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()) {
Chris Lattner36d572b2007-07-16 00:14:47 +00002406 BaseExpr = LHSExp;
2407 IndexExpr = RHSExp;
Chris Lattner36d572b2007-07-16 00:14:47 +00002408 ResultType = PTy->getPointeeType();
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00002409 } else if (const PointerType *PTy = RHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()) {
Chris Lattneraee0cfd2007-07-16 00:23:25 +00002410 // Handle the uncommon case of "123[Ptr]".
Chris Lattner36d572b2007-07-16 00:14:47 +00002411 BaseExpr = RHSExp;
2412 IndexExpr = LHSExp;
Chris Lattner36d572b2007-07-16 00:14:47 +00002413 ResultType = PTy->getPointeeType();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002414 } else if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *PTy =
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00002415 LHSTy->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()) {
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00002416 BaseExpr = LHSExp;
2417 IndexExpr = RHSExp;
2418 ResultType = PTy->getPointeeType();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002419 } else if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *PTy =
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00002420 RHSTy->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()) {
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00002421 // Handle the uncommon case of "123[Ptr]".
2422 BaseExpr = RHSExp;
2423 IndexExpr = LHSExp;
2424 ResultType = PTy->getPointeeType();
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00002425 } else if (const VectorType *VTy = LHSTy->getAs<VectorType>()) {
Chris Lattner41977962007-07-31 19:29:30 +00002426 BaseExpr = LHSExp; // vectors: V[123]
Chris Lattner36d572b2007-07-16 00:14:47 +00002427 IndexExpr = RHSExp;
Nate Begemanc1bf0612009-01-18 00:45:31 +00002428
Chris Lattner36d572b2007-07-16 00:14:47 +00002429 // FIXME: need to deal with const...
2430 ResultType = VTy->getElementType();
Eli Friedmanab2784f2009-04-25 23:46:54 +00002431 } else if (LHSTy->isArrayType()) {
2432 // If we see an array that wasn't promoted by
Douglas Gregorb92a1562010-02-03 00:27:59 +00002433 // DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion, it must be an array that
Eli Friedmanab2784f2009-04-25 23:46:54 +00002434 // wasn't promoted because of the C90 rule that doesn't
2435 // allow promoting non-lvalue arrays. Warn, then
2436 // force the promotion here.
2437 Diag(LHSExp->getLocStart(), diag::ext_subscript_non_lvalue) <<
2438 LHSExp->getSourceRange();
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00002439 ImpCastExprToType(LHSExp, Context.getArrayDecayedType(LHSTy),
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00002440 CK_ArrayToPointerDecay);
Eli Friedmanab2784f2009-04-25 23:46:54 +00002441 LHSTy = LHSExp->getType();
2442
2443 BaseExpr = LHSExp;
2444 IndexExpr = RHSExp;
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00002445 ResultType = LHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Eli Friedmanab2784f2009-04-25 23:46:54 +00002446 } else if (RHSTy->isArrayType()) {
2447 // Same as previous, except for 123[f().a] case
2448 Diag(RHSExp->getLocStart(), diag::ext_subscript_non_lvalue) <<
2449 RHSExp->getSourceRange();
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00002450 ImpCastExprToType(RHSExp, Context.getArrayDecayedType(RHSTy),
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00002451 CK_ArrayToPointerDecay);
Eli Friedmanab2784f2009-04-25 23:46:54 +00002452 RHSTy = RHSExp->getType();
2453
2454 BaseExpr = RHSExp;
2455 IndexExpr = LHSExp;
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00002456 ResultType = RHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Steve Naroffb3096442007-06-09 03:47:53 +00002457 } else {
Chris Lattner003af242009-04-25 22:50:55 +00002458 return ExprError(Diag(LLoc, diag::err_typecheck_subscript_value)
2459 << LHSExp->getSourceRange() << RHSExp->getSourceRange());
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00002460 }
Steve Naroffc1aadb12007-03-28 21:49:40 +00002461 // C99 6.5.2.1p1
Douglas Gregor5cc2c8b2010-07-23 15:58:24 +00002462 if (!IndexExpr->getType()->isIntegerType() && !IndexExpr->isTypeDependent())
Chris Lattner003af242009-04-25 22:50:55 +00002463 return ExprError(Diag(LLoc, diag::err_typecheck_subscript_not_integer)
2464 << IndexExpr->getSourceRange());
Steve Naroffb29cdd52007-07-10 18:23:31 +00002465
Daniel Dunbar4782a6e2009-09-17 06:31:17 +00002466 if ((IndexExpr->getType()->isSpecificBuiltinType(BuiltinType::Char_S) ||
Sam Weinigb7608d72009-09-14 20:14:57 +00002467 IndexExpr->getType()->isSpecificBuiltinType(BuiltinType::Char_U))
2468 && !IndexExpr->isTypeDependent())
Sam Weinig914244e2009-09-14 01:58:58 +00002469 Diag(LLoc, diag::warn_subscript_is_char) << IndexExpr->getSourceRange();
2470
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00002471 // C99 6.5.2.1p1: "shall have type "pointer to *object* type". Similarly,
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002472 // C++ [expr.sub]p1: The type "T" shall be a completely-defined object
2473 // type. Note that Functions are not objects, and that (in C99 parlance)
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00002474 // incomplete types are not object types.
2475 if (ResultType->isFunctionType()) {
2476 Diag(BaseExpr->getLocStart(), diag::err_subscript_function_type)
2477 << ResultType << BaseExpr->getSourceRange();
2478 return ExprError();
2479 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002480
Abramo Bagnara3aabb4b2010-09-13 06:50:07 +00002481 if (ResultType->isVoidType() && !getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
2482 // GNU extension: subscripting on pointer to void
2483 Diag(LLoc, diag::ext_gnu_void_ptr)
2484 << BaseExpr->getSourceRange();
2485 } else if (!ResultType->isDependentType() &&
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002486 RequireCompleteType(LLoc, ResultType,
Anders Carlssond624e162009-08-26 23:45:07 +00002487 PDiag(diag::err_subscript_incomplete_type)
2488 << BaseExpr->getSourceRange()))
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00002489 return ExprError();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002490
Chris Lattner62975a72009-04-24 00:30:45 +00002491 // Diagnose bad cases where we step over interface counts.
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00002492 if (ResultType->isObjCObjectType() && LangOpts.ObjCNonFragileABI) {
Chris Lattner62975a72009-04-24 00:30:45 +00002493 Diag(LLoc, diag::err_subscript_nonfragile_interface)
2494 << ResultType << BaseExpr->getSourceRange();
2495 return ExprError();
2496 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002497
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002498 return Owned(new (Context) ArraySubscriptExpr(LHSExp, RHSExp,
Steve Narofff6009ed2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00002499 ResultType, RLoc));
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00002500}
2501
Steve Narofff8fd09e2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002502QualType Sema::
Nate Begemance4d7fc2008-04-18 23:10:10 +00002503CheckExtVectorComponent(QualType baseType, SourceLocation OpLoc,
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002504 const IdentifierInfo *CompName,
Anders Carlssonf571c112009-08-26 18:25:21 +00002505 SourceLocation CompLoc) {
Daniel Dunbarc0429402009-10-18 02:09:38 +00002506 // FIXME: Share logic with ExtVectorElementExpr::containsDuplicateElements,
2507 // see FIXME there.
2508 //
2509 // FIXME: This logic can be greatly simplified by splitting it along
2510 // halving/not halving and reworking the component checking.
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00002511 const ExtVectorType *vecType = baseType->getAs<ExtVectorType>();
Nate Begemanf322eab2008-05-09 06:41:27 +00002512
Steve Narofff8fd09e2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002513 // The vector accessor can't exceed the number of elements.
Daniel Dunbar2c422dc92009-10-18 20:26:12 +00002514 const char *compStr = CompName->getNameStart();
Nate Begemanbb70bf62009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002515
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002516 // This flag determines whether or not the component is one of the four
Nate Begemanbb70bf62009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002517 // special names that indicate a subset of exactly half the elements are
2518 // to be selected.
2519 bool HalvingSwizzle = false;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002520
Nate Begemanbb70bf62009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002521 // This flag determines whether or not CompName has an 's' char prefix,
2522 // indicating that it is a string of hex values to be used as vector indices.
Nate Begeman0359e122009-06-25 21:06:09 +00002523 bool HexSwizzle = *compStr == 's' || *compStr == 'S';
Nate Begemanf322eab2008-05-09 06:41:27 +00002524
2525 // Check that we've found one of the special components, or that the component
2526 // names must come from the same set.
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002527 if (!strcmp(compStr, "hi") || !strcmp(compStr, "lo") ||
Nate Begemanbb70bf62009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002528 !strcmp(compStr, "even") || !strcmp(compStr, "odd")) {
2529 HalvingSwizzle = true;
Nate Begemanf322eab2008-05-09 06:41:27 +00002530 } else if (vecType->getPointAccessorIdx(*compStr) != -1) {
Chris Lattner7e152db2007-08-02 22:33:49 +00002531 do
2532 compStr++;
2533 while (*compStr && vecType->getPointAccessorIdx(*compStr) != -1);
Nate Begemanbb70bf62009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002534 } else if (HexSwizzle || vecType->getNumericAccessorIdx(*compStr) != -1) {
Chris Lattner7e152db2007-08-02 22:33:49 +00002535 do
2536 compStr++;
Nate Begemanbb70bf62009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002537 while (*compStr && vecType->getNumericAccessorIdx(*compStr) != -1);
Chris Lattner7e152db2007-08-02 22:33:49 +00002538 }
Nate Begemanbb70bf62009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002539
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002540 if (!HalvingSwizzle && *compStr) {
Steve Narofff8fd09e2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002541 // We didn't get to the end of the string. This means the component names
2542 // didn't come from the same set *or* we encountered an illegal name.
Chris Lattner3b054132008-11-19 05:08:23 +00002543 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_ext_vector_component_name_illegal)
Benjamin Kramere8394df2010-08-11 14:47:12 +00002544 << llvm::StringRef(compStr, 1) << SourceRange(CompLoc);
Steve Narofff8fd09e2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002545 return QualType();
2546 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002547
Nate Begemanbb70bf62009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002548 // Ensure no component accessor exceeds the width of the vector type it
2549 // operates on.
2550 if (!HalvingSwizzle) {
Daniel Dunbar2c422dc92009-10-18 20:26:12 +00002551 compStr = CompName->getNameStart();
Nate Begemanbb70bf62009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002552
2553 if (HexSwizzle)
Steve Narofff8fd09e2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002554 compStr++;
Nate Begemanbb70bf62009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002555
2556 while (*compStr) {
2557 if (!vecType->isAccessorWithinNumElements(*compStr++)) {
2558 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_ext_vector_component_exceeds_length)
2559 << baseType << SourceRange(CompLoc);
2560 return QualType();
2561 }
2562 }
Steve Narofff8fd09e2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002563 }
Nate Begemanf322eab2008-05-09 06:41:27 +00002564
Steve Narofff8fd09e2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002565 // The component accessor looks fine - now we need to compute the actual type.
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002566 // The vector type is implied by the component accessor. For example,
Steve Narofff8fd09e2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002567 // vec4.b is a float, vec4.xy is a vec2, vec4.rgb is a vec3, etc.
Nate Begemanbb70bf62009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002568 // vec4.s0 is a float, vec4.s23 is a vec3, etc.
Nate Begemanf322eab2008-05-09 06:41:27 +00002569 // vec4.hi, vec4.lo, vec4.e, and vec4.o all return vec2.
Nate Begemanac8183a2009-12-15 18:13:04 +00002570 unsigned CompSize = HalvingSwizzle ? (vecType->getNumElements() + 1) / 2
Anders Carlssonf571c112009-08-26 18:25:21 +00002571 : CompName->getLength();
Nate Begemanbb70bf62009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002572 if (HexSwizzle)
2573 CompSize--;
2574
Steve Narofff8fd09e2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002575 if (CompSize == 1)
2576 return vecType->getElementType();
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002577
Nate Begemance4d7fc2008-04-18 23:10:10 +00002578 QualType VT = Context.getExtVectorType(vecType->getElementType(), CompSize);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002579 // Now look up the TypeDefDecl from the vector type. Without this,
Nate Begemance4d7fc2008-04-18 23:10:10 +00002580 // diagostics look bad. We want extended vector types to appear built-in.
2581 for (unsigned i = 0, E = ExtVectorDecls.size(); i != E; ++i) {
2582 if (ExtVectorDecls[i]->getUnderlyingType() == VT)
2583 return Context.getTypedefType(ExtVectorDecls[i]);
Steve Naroffddf5a1d2007-07-29 16:33:31 +00002584 }
2585 return VT; // should never get here (a typedef type should always be found).
Steve Narofff8fd09e2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002586}
2587
Fariborz Jahanianf3f903a2010-10-11 21:29:12 +00002588static Decl *FindGetterSetterNameDeclFromProtocolList(const ObjCProtocolDecl*PDecl,
Anders Carlssonf571c112009-08-26 18:25:21 +00002589 IdentifierInfo *Member,
Douglas Gregorbcced4e2009-04-09 21:40:53 +00002590 const Selector &Sel,
2591 ASTContext &Context) {
Fariborz Jahanianf3f903a2010-10-11 21:29:12 +00002592 if (Member)
2593 if (ObjCPropertyDecl *PD = PDecl->FindPropertyDeclaration(Member))
2594 return PD;
Argyrios Kyrtzidiscfbfe782009-06-30 02:36:12 +00002595 if (ObjCMethodDecl *OMD = PDecl->getInstanceMethod(Sel))
Fariborz Jahaniand302bbd02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002596 return OMD;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002597
Fariborz Jahaniand302bbd02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002598 for (ObjCProtocolDecl::protocol_iterator I = PDecl->protocol_begin(),
2599 E = PDecl->protocol_end(); I != E; ++I) {
Fariborz Jahanianf3f903a2010-10-11 21:29:12 +00002600 if (Decl *D = FindGetterSetterNameDeclFromProtocolList(*I, Member, Sel,
2601 Context))
Fariborz Jahaniand302bbd02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002602 return D;
2603 }
2604 return 0;
2605}
2606
Fariborz Jahanianf3f903a2010-10-11 21:29:12 +00002607static Decl *FindGetterSetterNameDecl(const ObjCObjectPointerType *QIdTy,
2608 IdentifierInfo *Member,
2609 const Selector &Sel,
2610 ASTContext &Context) {
Fariborz Jahaniand302bbd02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002611 // Check protocols on qualified interfaces.
2612 Decl *GDecl = 0;
Steve Narofffb4330f2009-06-17 22:40:22 +00002613 for (ObjCObjectPointerType::qual_iterator I = QIdTy->qual_begin(),
Fariborz Jahaniand302bbd02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002614 E = QIdTy->qual_end(); I != E; ++I) {
Fariborz Jahanianf3f903a2010-10-11 21:29:12 +00002615 if (Member)
2616 if (ObjCPropertyDecl *PD = (*I)->FindPropertyDeclaration(Member)) {
2617 GDecl = PD;
2618 break;
2619 }
2620 // Also must look for a getter or setter name which uses property syntax.
Argyrios Kyrtzidiscfbfe782009-06-30 02:36:12 +00002621 if (ObjCMethodDecl *OMD = (*I)->getInstanceMethod(Sel)) {
Fariborz Jahaniand302bbd02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002622 GDecl = OMD;
2623 break;
2624 }
2625 }
2626 if (!GDecl) {
Steve Narofffb4330f2009-06-17 22:40:22 +00002627 for (ObjCObjectPointerType::qual_iterator I = QIdTy->qual_begin(),
Fariborz Jahaniand302bbd02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002628 E = QIdTy->qual_end(); I != E; ++I) {
2629 // Search in the protocol-qualifier list of current protocol.
Fariborz Jahanianf3f903a2010-10-11 21:29:12 +00002630 GDecl = FindGetterSetterNameDeclFromProtocolList(*I, Member, Sel,
2631 Context);
Fariborz Jahaniand302bbd02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002632 if (GDecl)
2633 return GDecl;
2634 }
2635 }
2636 return GDecl;
2637}
Chris Lattner4bf74fd2009-02-15 22:43:40 +00002638
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00002639ExprResult
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00002640Sema::ActOnDependentMemberExpr(Expr *BaseExpr, QualType BaseType,
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002641 bool IsArrow, SourceLocation OpLoc,
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002642 const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
2643 NamedDecl *FirstQualifierInScope,
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00002644 const DeclarationNameInfo &NameInfo,
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002645 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs) {
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002646 // Even in dependent contexts, try to diagnose base expressions with
2647 // obviously wrong types, e.g.:
2648 //
2649 // T* t;
2650 // t.f;
2651 //
2652 // In Obj-C++, however, the above expression is valid, since it could be
2653 // accessing the 'f' property if T is an Obj-C interface. The extra check
2654 // allows this, while still reporting an error if T is a struct pointer.
2655 if (!IsArrow) {
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002656 const PointerType *PT = BaseType->getAs<PointerType>();
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002657 if (PT && (!getLangOptions().ObjC1 ||
2658 PT->getPointeeType()->isRecordType())) {
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002659 assert(BaseExpr && "cannot happen with implicit member accesses");
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00002660 Diag(NameInfo.getLoc(), diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_struct_union)
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002661 << BaseType << BaseExpr->getSourceRange();
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002662 return ExprError();
2663 }
2664 }
2665
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00002666 assert(BaseType->isDependentType() ||
2667 NameInfo.getName().isDependentName() ||
Douglas Gregor41f90302010-04-12 20:54:26 +00002668 isDependentScopeSpecifier(SS));
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002669
2670 // Get the type being accessed in BaseType. If this is an arrow, the BaseExpr
2671 // must have pointer type, and the accessed type is the pointee.
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002672 return Owned(CXXDependentScopeMemberExpr::Create(Context, BaseExpr, BaseType,
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002673 IsArrow, OpLoc,
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00002674 SS.getScopeRep(),
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002675 SS.getRange(),
2676 FirstQualifierInScope,
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00002677 NameInfo, TemplateArgs));
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002678}
2679
2680/// We know that the given qualified member reference points only to
2681/// declarations which do not belong to the static type of the base
2682/// expression. Diagnose the problem.
2683static void DiagnoseQualifiedMemberReference(Sema &SemaRef,
2684 Expr *BaseExpr,
2685 QualType BaseType,
John McCallcd4b4772009-12-02 03:53:29 +00002686 const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002687 const LookupResult &R) {
John McCallcd4b4772009-12-02 03:53:29 +00002688 // If this is an implicit member access, use a different set of
2689 // diagnostics.
2690 if (!BaseExpr)
2691 return DiagnoseInstanceReference(SemaRef, SS, R);
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002692
John McCall1e67dd62010-04-27 01:43:38 +00002693 SemaRef.Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diag::err_qualified_member_of_unrelated)
2694 << SS.getRange() << R.getRepresentativeDecl() << BaseType;
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002695}
2696
2697// Check whether the declarations we found through a nested-name
2698// specifier in a member expression are actually members of the base
2699// type. The restriction here is:
2700//
2701// C++ [expr.ref]p2:
2702// ... In these cases, the id-expression shall name a
2703// member of the class or of one of its base classes.
2704//
2705// So it's perfectly legitimate for the nested-name specifier to name
2706// an unrelated class, and for us to find an overload set including
2707// decls from classes which are not superclasses, as long as the decl
2708// we actually pick through overload resolution is from a superclass.
2709bool Sema::CheckQualifiedMemberReference(Expr *BaseExpr,
2710 QualType BaseType,
John McCallcd4b4772009-12-02 03:53:29 +00002711 const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002712 const LookupResult &R) {
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002713 const RecordType *BaseRT = BaseType->getAs<RecordType>();
2714 if (!BaseRT) {
2715 // We can't check this yet because the base type is still
2716 // dependent.
2717 assert(BaseType->isDependentType());
2718 return false;
2719 }
2720 CXXRecordDecl *BaseRecord = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(BaseRT->getDecl());
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002721
2722 for (LookupResult::iterator I = R.begin(), E = R.end(); I != E; ++I) {
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002723 // If this is an implicit member reference and we find a
2724 // non-instance member, it's not an error.
John McCalla8ae2222010-04-06 21:38:20 +00002725 if (!BaseExpr && !(*I)->isCXXInstanceMember())
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002726 return false;
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002727
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002728 // Note that we use the DC of the decl, not the underlying decl.
Eli Friedman75300492010-07-27 20:51:02 +00002729 DeclContext *DC = (*I)->getDeclContext();
2730 while (DC->isTransparentContext())
2731 DC = DC->getParent();
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002732
Douglas Gregora9c3e822010-07-28 22:27:52 +00002733 if (!DC->isRecord())
2734 continue;
2735
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002736 llvm::SmallPtrSet<CXXRecordDecl*,4> MemberRecord;
Eli Friedman75300492010-07-27 20:51:02 +00002737 MemberRecord.insert(cast<CXXRecordDecl>(DC)->getCanonicalDecl());
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002738
2739 if (!IsProvablyNotDerivedFrom(*this, BaseRecord, MemberRecord))
2740 return false;
2741 }
2742
John McCallcd4b4772009-12-02 03:53:29 +00002743 DiagnoseQualifiedMemberReference(*this, BaseExpr, BaseType, SS, R);
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002744 return true;
2745}
2746
2747static bool
2748LookupMemberExprInRecord(Sema &SemaRef, LookupResult &R,
2749 SourceRange BaseRange, const RecordType *RTy,
John McCalle9cccd82010-06-16 08:42:20 +00002750 SourceLocation OpLoc, CXXScopeSpec &SS,
2751 bool HasTemplateArgs) {
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002752 RecordDecl *RDecl = RTy->getDecl();
2753 if (SemaRef.RequireCompleteType(OpLoc, QualType(RTy, 0),
Douglas Gregor89336232010-03-29 23:34:08 +00002754 SemaRef.PDiag(diag::err_typecheck_incomplete_tag)
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002755 << BaseRange))
2756 return true;
2757
John McCalle9cccd82010-06-16 08:42:20 +00002758 if (HasTemplateArgs) {
2759 // LookupTemplateName doesn't expect these both to exist simultaneously.
2760 QualType ObjectType = SS.isSet() ? QualType() : QualType(RTy, 0);
2761
2762 bool MOUS;
2763 SemaRef.LookupTemplateName(R, 0, SS, ObjectType, false, MOUS);
2764 return false;
2765 }
2766
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002767 DeclContext *DC = RDecl;
2768 if (SS.isSet()) {
2769 // If the member name was a qualified-id, look into the
2770 // nested-name-specifier.
2771 DC = SemaRef.computeDeclContext(SS, false);
2772
John McCall0b66eb32010-05-01 00:40:08 +00002773 if (SemaRef.RequireCompleteDeclContext(SS, DC)) {
John McCallcd4b4772009-12-02 03:53:29 +00002774 SemaRef.Diag(SS.getRange().getEnd(), diag::err_typecheck_incomplete_tag)
2775 << SS.getRange() << DC;
2776 return true;
2777 }
2778
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002779 assert(DC && "Cannot handle non-computable dependent contexts in lookup");
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00002780
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002781 if (!isa<TypeDecl>(DC)) {
2782 SemaRef.Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diag::err_qualified_member_nonclass)
2783 << DC << SS.getRange();
2784 return true;
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002785 }
2786 }
2787
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002788 // The record definition is complete, now look up the member.
2789 SemaRef.LookupQualifiedName(R, DC);
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002790
Douglas Gregoraf2bd472009-12-31 07:42:17 +00002791 if (!R.empty())
2792 return false;
2793
2794 // We didn't find anything with the given name, so try to correct
2795 // for typos.
2796 DeclarationName Name = R.getLookupName();
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00002797 if (SemaRef.CorrectTypo(R, 0, &SS, DC, false, Sema::CTC_MemberLookup) &&
Douglas Gregor280e1ee2010-04-14 20:04:41 +00002798 !R.empty() &&
Douglas Gregoraf2bd472009-12-31 07:42:17 +00002799 (isa<ValueDecl>(*R.begin()) || isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(*R.begin()))) {
2800 SemaRef.Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diag::err_no_member_suggest)
2801 << Name << DC << R.getLookupName() << SS.getRange()
Douglas Gregora771f462010-03-31 17:46:05 +00002802 << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(R.getNameLoc(),
2803 R.getLookupName().getAsString());
Douglas Gregor6da83622010-01-07 00:17:44 +00002804 if (NamedDecl *ND = R.getAsSingle<NamedDecl>())
2805 SemaRef.Diag(ND->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_decl)
2806 << ND->getDeclName();
Douglas Gregoraf2bd472009-12-31 07:42:17 +00002807 return false;
2808 } else {
2809 R.clear();
Douglas Gregorc048c522010-06-29 19:27:42 +00002810 R.setLookupName(Name);
Douglas Gregoraf2bd472009-12-31 07:42:17 +00002811 }
2812
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002813 return false;
2814}
2815
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00002816ExprResult
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00002817Sema::BuildMemberReferenceExpr(Expr *Base, QualType BaseType,
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002818 SourceLocation OpLoc, bool IsArrow,
Jeffrey Yasskinc76498d2010-04-08 16:38:48 +00002819 CXXScopeSpec &SS,
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002820 NamedDecl *FirstQualifierInScope,
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00002821 const DeclarationNameInfo &NameInfo,
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002822 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs) {
John McCallcd4b4772009-12-02 03:53:29 +00002823 if (BaseType->isDependentType() ||
2824 (SS.isSet() && isDependentScopeSpecifier(SS)))
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00002825 return ActOnDependentMemberExpr(Base, BaseType,
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002826 IsArrow, OpLoc,
2827 SS, FirstQualifierInScope,
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00002828 NameInfo, TemplateArgs);
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002829
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00002830 LookupResult R(*this, NameInfo, LookupMemberName);
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002831
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002832 // Implicit member accesses.
2833 if (!Base) {
2834 QualType RecordTy = BaseType;
2835 if (IsArrow) RecordTy = RecordTy->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
2836 if (LookupMemberExprInRecord(*this, R, SourceRange(),
2837 RecordTy->getAs<RecordType>(),
John McCalle9cccd82010-06-16 08:42:20 +00002838 OpLoc, SS, TemplateArgs != 0))
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002839 return ExprError();
2840
2841 // Explicit member accesses.
2842 } else {
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00002843 ExprResult Result =
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002844 LookupMemberExpr(R, Base, IsArrow, OpLoc,
John McCall48871652010-08-21 09:40:31 +00002845 SS, /*ObjCImpDecl*/ 0, TemplateArgs != 0);
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002846
2847 if (Result.isInvalid()) {
2848 Owned(Base);
2849 return ExprError();
2850 }
2851
2852 if (Result.get())
2853 return move(Result);
Sebastian Redlfa1f70f2010-05-07 09:25:11 +00002854
2855 // LookupMemberExpr can modify Base, and thus change BaseType
2856 BaseType = Base->getType();
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002857 }
2858
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00002859 return BuildMemberReferenceExpr(Base, BaseType,
John McCall38836f02010-01-15 08:34:02 +00002860 OpLoc, IsArrow, SS, FirstQualifierInScope,
2861 R, TemplateArgs);
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002862}
2863
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00002864ExprResult
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00002865Sema::BuildMemberReferenceExpr(Expr *BaseExpr, QualType BaseExprType,
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002866 SourceLocation OpLoc, bool IsArrow,
2867 const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
John McCall38836f02010-01-15 08:34:02 +00002868 NamedDecl *FirstQualifierInScope,
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002869 LookupResult &R,
Douglas Gregorb139cd52010-05-01 20:49:11 +00002870 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs,
2871 bool SuppressQualifierCheck) {
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002872 QualType BaseType = BaseExprType;
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002873 if (IsArrow) {
2874 assert(BaseType->isPointerType());
2875 BaseType = BaseType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
2876 }
John McCalla8ae2222010-04-06 21:38:20 +00002877 R.setBaseObjectType(BaseType);
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002878
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00002879 NestedNameSpecifier *Qualifier = SS.getScopeRep();
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00002880 const DeclarationNameInfo &MemberNameInfo = R.getLookupNameInfo();
2881 DeclarationName MemberName = MemberNameInfo.getName();
2882 SourceLocation MemberLoc = MemberNameInfo.getLoc();
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002883
2884 if (R.isAmbiguous())
Douglas Gregord8061562009-08-06 03:17:00 +00002885 return ExprError();
2886
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002887 if (R.empty()) {
2888 // Rederive where we looked up.
2889 DeclContext *DC = (SS.isSet()
2890 ? computeDeclContext(SS, false)
2891 : BaseType->getAs<RecordType>()->getDecl());
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00002892
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002893 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diag::err_no_member)
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002894 << MemberName << DC
2895 << (BaseExpr ? BaseExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange());
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002896 return ExprError();
2897 }
2898
John McCall38836f02010-01-15 08:34:02 +00002899 // Diagnose lookups that find only declarations from a non-base
2900 // type. This is possible for either qualified lookups (which may
2901 // have been qualified with an unrelated type) or implicit member
2902 // expressions (which were found with unqualified lookup and thus
2903 // may have come from an enclosing scope). Note that it's okay for
2904 // lookup to find declarations from a non-base type as long as those
2905 // aren't the ones picked by overload resolution.
2906 if ((SS.isSet() || !BaseExpr ||
2907 (isa<CXXThisExpr>(BaseExpr) &&
2908 cast<CXXThisExpr>(BaseExpr)->isImplicit())) &&
Douglas Gregorb139cd52010-05-01 20:49:11 +00002909 !SuppressQualifierCheck &&
John McCall38836f02010-01-15 08:34:02 +00002910 CheckQualifiedMemberReference(BaseExpr, BaseType, SS, R))
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002911 return ExprError();
2912
2913 // Construct an unresolved result if we in fact got an unresolved
2914 // result.
2915 if (R.isOverloadedResult() || R.isUnresolvableResult()) {
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002916 bool Dependent =
John McCall71739032009-12-19 02:05:44 +00002917 BaseExprType->isDependentType() ||
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002918 R.isUnresolvableResult() ||
John McCall1acbbb52010-02-02 06:20:04 +00002919 OverloadExpr::ComputeDependence(R.begin(), R.end(), TemplateArgs);
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002920
John McCall58cc69d2010-01-27 01:50:18 +00002921 // Suppress any lookup-related diagnostics; we'll do these when we
2922 // pick a member.
2923 R.suppressDiagnostics();
2924
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002925 UnresolvedMemberExpr *MemExpr
2926 = UnresolvedMemberExpr::Create(Context, Dependent,
2927 R.isUnresolvableResult(),
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002928 BaseExpr, BaseExprType,
2929 IsArrow, OpLoc,
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002930 Qualifier, SS.getRange(),
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00002931 MemberNameInfo,
Douglas Gregor30a4f4c2010-05-23 18:57:34 +00002932 TemplateArgs, R.begin(), R.end());
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002933
2934 return Owned(MemExpr);
2935 }
2936
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00002937 assert(R.isSingleResult());
John McCalla8ae2222010-04-06 21:38:20 +00002938 DeclAccessPair FoundDecl = R.begin().getPair();
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002939 NamedDecl *MemberDecl = R.getFoundDecl();
2940
2941 // FIXME: diagnose the presence of template arguments now.
2942
2943 // If the decl being referenced had an error, return an error for this
2944 // sub-expr without emitting another error, in order to avoid cascading
2945 // error cases.
2946 if (MemberDecl->isInvalidDecl())
2947 return ExprError();
2948
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002949 // Handle the implicit-member-access case.
2950 if (!BaseExpr) {
2951 // If this is not an instance member, convert to a non-member access.
John McCalla8ae2222010-04-06 21:38:20 +00002952 if (!MemberDecl->isCXXInstanceMember())
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00002953 return BuildDeclarationNameExpr(SS, R.getLookupNameInfo(), MemberDecl);
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002954
Douglas Gregorb15af892010-01-07 23:12:05 +00002955 SourceLocation Loc = R.getNameLoc();
2956 if (SS.getRange().isValid())
2957 Loc = SS.getRange().getBegin();
2958 BaseExpr = new (Context) CXXThisExpr(Loc, BaseExprType,/*isImplicit=*/true);
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002959 }
2960
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002961 bool ShouldCheckUse = true;
2962 if (CXXMethodDecl *MD = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(MemberDecl)) {
2963 // Don't diagnose the use of a virtual member function unless it's
2964 // explicitly qualified.
2965 if (MD->isVirtual() && !SS.isSet())
2966 ShouldCheckUse = false;
2967 }
2968
2969 // Check the use of this member.
2970 if (ShouldCheckUse && DiagnoseUseOfDecl(MemberDecl, MemberLoc)) {
2971 Owned(BaseExpr);
2972 return ExprError();
2973 }
2974
2975 if (FieldDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FieldDecl>(MemberDecl)) {
2976 // We may have found a field within an anonymous union or struct
2977 // (C++ [class.union]).
Eli Friedman78cde142009-12-04 07:18:51 +00002978 if (cast<RecordDecl>(FD->getDeclContext())->isAnonymousStructOrUnion() &&
2979 !BaseType->getAs<RecordType>()->getDecl()->isAnonymousStructOrUnion())
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002980 return BuildAnonymousStructUnionMemberReference(MemberLoc, FD,
2981 BaseExpr, OpLoc);
2982
2983 // Figure out the type of the member; see C99 6.5.2.3p3, C++ [expr.ref]
2984 QualType MemberType = FD->getType();
2985 if (const ReferenceType *Ref = MemberType->getAs<ReferenceType>())
2986 MemberType = Ref->getPointeeType();
2987 else {
2988 Qualifiers BaseQuals = BaseType.getQualifiers();
2989 BaseQuals.removeObjCGCAttr();
2990 if (FD->isMutable()) BaseQuals.removeConst();
2991
2992 Qualifiers MemberQuals
2993 = Context.getCanonicalType(MemberType).getQualifiers();
2994
2995 Qualifiers Combined = BaseQuals + MemberQuals;
2996 if (Combined != MemberQuals)
2997 MemberType = Context.getQualifiedType(MemberType, Combined);
2998 }
2999
3000 MarkDeclarationReferenced(MemberLoc, FD);
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00003001 if (PerformObjectMemberConversion(BaseExpr, Qualifier, FoundDecl, FD))
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003002 return ExprError();
3003 return Owned(BuildMemberExpr(Context, BaseExpr, IsArrow, SS,
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00003004 FD, FoundDecl, MemberNameInfo,
3005 MemberType));
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003006 }
3007
3008 if (VarDecl *Var = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(MemberDecl)) {
3009 MarkDeclarationReferenced(MemberLoc, Var);
3010 return Owned(BuildMemberExpr(Context, BaseExpr, IsArrow, SS,
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00003011 Var, FoundDecl, MemberNameInfo,
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003012 Var->getType().getNonReferenceType()));
3013 }
3014
3015 if (FunctionDecl *MemberFn = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(MemberDecl)) {
3016 MarkDeclarationReferenced(MemberLoc, MemberDecl);
3017 return Owned(BuildMemberExpr(Context, BaseExpr, IsArrow, SS,
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00003018 MemberFn, FoundDecl, MemberNameInfo,
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003019 MemberFn->getType()));
3020 }
3021
3022 if (EnumConstantDecl *Enum = dyn_cast<EnumConstantDecl>(MemberDecl)) {
3023 MarkDeclarationReferenced(MemberLoc, MemberDecl);
3024 return Owned(BuildMemberExpr(Context, BaseExpr, IsArrow, SS,
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00003025 Enum, FoundDecl, MemberNameInfo,
3026 Enum->getType()));
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003027 }
3028
3029 Owned(BaseExpr);
3030
Douglas Gregor861eb802010-04-25 20:55:08 +00003031 // We found something that we didn't expect. Complain.
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003032 if (isa<TypeDecl>(MemberDecl))
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00003033 Diag(MemberLoc, diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_type)
Douglas Gregor861eb802010-04-25 20:55:08 +00003034 << MemberName << BaseType << int(IsArrow);
3035 else
3036 Diag(MemberLoc, diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_unknown)
3037 << MemberName << BaseType << int(IsArrow);
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003038
Douglas Gregor861eb802010-04-25 20:55:08 +00003039 Diag(MemberDecl->getLocation(), diag::note_member_declared_here)
3040 << MemberName;
Douglas Gregor516d6722010-04-25 21:15:30 +00003041 R.suppressDiagnostics();
Douglas Gregor861eb802010-04-25 20:55:08 +00003042 return ExprError();
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003043}
3044
3045/// Look up the given member of the given non-type-dependent
3046/// expression. This can return in one of two ways:
3047/// * If it returns a sentinel null-but-valid result, the caller will
3048/// assume that lookup was performed and the results written into
3049/// the provided structure. It will take over from there.
3050/// * Otherwise, the returned expression will be produced in place of
3051/// an ordinary member expression.
3052///
3053/// The ObjCImpDecl bit is a gross hack that will need to be properly
3054/// fixed for ObjC++.
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00003055ExprResult
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003056Sema::LookupMemberExpr(LookupResult &R, Expr *&BaseExpr,
John McCalla928c652009-12-07 22:46:59 +00003057 bool &IsArrow, SourceLocation OpLoc,
Jeffrey Yasskinc76498d2010-04-08 16:38:48 +00003058 CXXScopeSpec &SS,
John McCall48871652010-08-21 09:40:31 +00003059 Decl *ObjCImpDecl, bool HasTemplateArgs) {
Douglas Gregorad8a3362009-09-04 17:36:40 +00003060 assert(BaseExpr && "no base expression");
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003061
Steve Naroffeaaae462007-12-16 21:42:28 +00003062 // Perform default conversions.
3063 DefaultFunctionArrayConversion(BaseExpr);
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003064
Steve Naroff185616f2007-07-26 03:11:44 +00003065 QualType BaseType = BaseExpr->getType();
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003066 assert(!BaseType->isDependentType());
3067
3068 DeclarationName MemberName = R.getLookupName();
3069 SourceLocation MemberLoc = R.getNameLoc();
Douglas Gregord82ae382009-11-06 06:30:47 +00003070
3071 // If the user is trying to apply -> or . to a function pointer
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003072 // type, it's probably because they forgot parentheses to call that
Douglas Gregord82ae382009-11-06 06:30:47 +00003073 // function. Suggest the addition of those parentheses, build the
3074 // call, and continue on.
3075 if (const PointerType *Ptr = BaseType->getAs<PointerType>()) {
3076 if (const FunctionProtoType *Fun
3077 = Ptr->getPointeeType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>()) {
3078 QualType ResultTy = Fun->getResultType();
3079 if (Fun->getNumArgs() == 0 &&
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003080 ((!IsArrow && ResultTy->isRecordType()) ||
3081 (IsArrow && ResultTy->isPointerType() &&
Douglas Gregord82ae382009-11-06 06:30:47 +00003082 ResultTy->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType()
3083 ->isRecordType()))) {
3084 SourceLocation Loc = PP.getLocForEndOfToken(BaseExpr->getLocEnd());
Nick Lewyckyc60d6e72010-10-15 21:43:24 +00003085 Diag(BaseExpr->getExprLoc(), diag::err_member_reference_needs_call)
Douglas Gregord82ae382009-11-06 06:30:47 +00003086 << QualType(Fun, 0)
Douglas Gregora771f462010-03-31 17:46:05 +00003087 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(Loc, "()");
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003088
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00003089 ExprResult NewBase
Douglas Gregorce5aa332010-09-09 16:33:13 +00003090 = ActOnCallExpr(0, BaseExpr, Loc, MultiExprArg(*this, 0, 0), Loc);
Douglas Gregor143d3672010-06-21 22:46:46 +00003091 BaseExpr = 0;
Douglas Gregord82ae382009-11-06 06:30:47 +00003092 if (NewBase.isInvalid())
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003093 return ExprError();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003094
Douglas Gregord82ae382009-11-06 06:30:47 +00003095 BaseExpr = NewBase.takeAs<Expr>();
3096 DefaultFunctionArrayConversion(BaseExpr);
3097 BaseType = BaseExpr->getType();
3098 }
3099 }
3100 }
3101
David Chisnall9f57c292009-08-17 16:35:33 +00003102 // If this is an Objective-C pseudo-builtin and a definition is provided then
3103 // use that.
3104 if (BaseType->isObjCIdType()) {
Fariborz Jahanianc2949f92009-12-07 20:09:25 +00003105 if (IsArrow) {
3106 // Handle the following exceptional case PObj->isa.
3107 if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *OPT =
3108 BaseType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()) {
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00003109 if (OPT->getObjectType()->isObjCId() &&
Fariborz Jahanianc2949f92009-12-07 20:09:25 +00003110 MemberName.getAsIdentifierInfo()->isStr("isa"))
Fariborz Jahaniana5fee262009-12-09 19:05:56 +00003111 return Owned(new (Context) ObjCIsaExpr(BaseExpr, true, MemberLoc,
3112 Context.getObjCClassType()));
Fariborz Jahanianc2949f92009-12-07 20:09:25 +00003113 }
3114 }
David Chisnall9f57c292009-08-17 16:35:33 +00003115 // We have an 'id' type. Rather than fall through, we check if this
3116 // is a reference to 'isa'.
3117 if (BaseType != Context.ObjCIdRedefinitionType) {
3118 BaseType = Context.ObjCIdRedefinitionType;
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00003119 ImpCastExprToType(BaseExpr, BaseType, CK_BitCast);
David Chisnall9f57c292009-08-17 16:35:33 +00003120 }
David Chisnall9f57c292009-08-17 16:35:33 +00003121 }
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003122
Fariborz Jahanian04b258c2009-11-25 23:07:42 +00003123 // If this is an Objective-C pseudo-builtin and a definition is provided then
3124 // use that.
3125 if (Context.isObjCSelType(BaseType)) {
3126 // We have an 'SEL' type. Rather than fall through, we check if this
3127 // is a reference to 'sel_id'.
3128 if (BaseType != Context.ObjCSelRedefinitionType) {
3129 BaseType = Context.ObjCSelRedefinitionType;
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00003130 ImpCastExprToType(BaseExpr, BaseType, CK_BitCast);
Fariborz Jahanian04b258c2009-11-25 23:07:42 +00003131 }
3132 }
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003133
Steve Naroff185616f2007-07-26 03:11:44 +00003134 assert(!BaseType.isNull() && "no type for member expression");
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003135
Fariborz Jahaniane983d172009-09-22 16:48:37 +00003136 // Handle properties on ObjC 'Class' types.
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003137 if (!IsArrow && BaseType->isObjCClassType()) {
Fariborz Jahaniane983d172009-09-22 16:48:37 +00003138 // Also must look for a getter name which uses property syntax.
3139 IdentifierInfo *Member = MemberName.getAsIdentifierInfo();
3140 Selector Sel = PP.getSelectorTable().getNullarySelector(Member);
3141 if (ObjCMethodDecl *MD = getCurMethodDecl()) {
3142 ObjCInterfaceDecl *IFace = MD->getClassInterface();
3143 ObjCMethodDecl *Getter;
3144 // FIXME: need to also look locally in the implementation.
3145 if ((Getter = IFace->lookupClassMethod(Sel))) {
3146 // Check the use of this method.
3147 if (DiagnoseUseOfDecl(Getter, MemberLoc))
3148 return ExprError();
3149 }
3150 // If we found a getter then this may be a valid dot-reference, we
3151 // will look for the matching setter, in case it is needed.
3152 Selector SetterSel =
3153 SelectorTable::constructSetterName(PP.getIdentifierTable(),
3154 PP.getSelectorTable(), Member);
3155 ObjCMethodDecl *Setter = IFace->lookupClassMethod(SetterSel);
3156 if (!Setter) {
3157 // If this reference is in an @implementation, also check for 'private'
3158 // methods.
Steve Naroffbb69c942009-10-01 23:46:04 +00003159 Setter = IFace->lookupPrivateInstanceMethod(SetterSel);
Fariborz Jahaniane983d172009-09-22 16:48:37 +00003160 }
3161 // Look through local category implementations associated with the class.
3162 if (!Setter)
3163 Setter = IFace->getCategoryClassMethod(SetterSel);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003164
Fariborz Jahaniane983d172009-09-22 16:48:37 +00003165 if (Setter && DiagnoseUseOfDecl(Setter, MemberLoc))
3166 return ExprError();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003167
Fariborz Jahaniane983d172009-09-22 16:48:37 +00003168 if (Getter || Setter) {
3169 QualType PType;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003170
Fariborz Jahaniane983d172009-09-22 16:48:37 +00003171 if (Getter)
Douglas Gregor603d81b2010-07-13 08:18:22 +00003172 PType = Getter->getSendResultType();
Fariborz Jahaniane983d172009-09-22 16:48:37 +00003173 else
3174 // Get the expression type from Setter's incoming parameter.
3175 PType = (*(Setter->param_end() -1))->getType();
3176 // FIXME: we must check that the setter has property type.
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003177 return Owned(new (Context) ObjCImplicitSetterGetterRefExpr(Getter,
Fariborz Jahaniane983d172009-09-22 16:48:37 +00003178 PType,
3179 Setter, MemberLoc, BaseExpr));
3180 }
3181 return ExprError(Diag(MemberLoc, diag::err_property_not_found)
3182 << MemberName << BaseType);
3183 }
3184 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003185
Fariborz Jahaniane983d172009-09-22 16:48:37 +00003186 if (BaseType->isObjCClassType() &&
3187 BaseType != Context.ObjCClassRedefinitionType) {
3188 BaseType = Context.ObjCClassRedefinitionType;
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00003189 ImpCastExprToType(BaseExpr, BaseType, CK_BitCast);
Fariborz Jahaniane983d172009-09-22 16:48:37 +00003190 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003191
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003192 if (IsArrow) {
3193 if (const PointerType *PT = BaseType->getAs<PointerType>())
Steve Naroff185616f2007-07-26 03:11:44 +00003194 BaseType = PT->getPointeeType();
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00003195 else if (BaseType->isObjCObjectPointerType())
3196 ;
John McCalla928c652009-12-07 22:46:59 +00003197 else if (BaseType->isRecordType()) {
3198 // Recover from arrow accesses to records, e.g.:
3199 // struct MyRecord foo;
3200 // foo->bar
3201 // This is actually well-formed in C++ if MyRecord has an
3202 // overloaded operator->, but that should have been dealt with
3203 // by now.
3204 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_suggestion)
3205 << BaseType << int(IsArrow) << BaseExpr->getSourceRange()
Douglas Gregora771f462010-03-31 17:46:05 +00003206 << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(OpLoc, ".");
John McCalla928c652009-12-07 22:46:59 +00003207 IsArrow = false;
3208 } else {
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003209 Diag(MemberLoc, diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_arrow)
3210 << BaseType << BaseExpr->getSourceRange();
3211 return ExprError();
Anders Carlsson524d5a42009-05-16 20:31:20 +00003212 }
John McCalla928c652009-12-07 22:46:59 +00003213 } else {
3214 // Recover from dot accesses to pointers, e.g.:
3215 // type *foo;
3216 // foo.bar
3217 // This is actually well-formed in two cases:
3218 // - 'type' is an Objective C type
3219 // - 'bar' is a pseudo-destructor name which happens to refer to
3220 // the appropriate pointer type
3221 if (MemberName.getNameKind() != DeclarationName::CXXDestructorName) {
3222 const PointerType *PT = BaseType->getAs<PointerType>();
3223 if (PT && PT->getPointeeType()->isRecordType()) {
3224 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_suggestion)
3225 << BaseType << int(IsArrow) << BaseExpr->getSourceRange()
Douglas Gregora771f462010-03-31 17:46:05 +00003226 << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(OpLoc, "->");
John McCalla928c652009-12-07 22:46:59 +00003227 BaseType = PT->getPointeeType();
3228 IsArrow = true;
3229 }
3230 }
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003231 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003232
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00003233 // Handle field access to simple records.
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00003234 if (const RecordType *RTy = BaseType->getAs<RecordType>()) {
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00003235 if (LookupMemberExprInRecord(*this, R, BaseExpr->getSourceRange(),
John McCalle9cccd82010-06-16 08:42:20 +00003236 RTy, OpLoc, SS, HasTemplateArgs))
Douglas Gregordd430f72009-01-19 19:26:10 +00003237 return ExprError();
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003238 return Owned((Expr*) 0);
Chris Lattnerb63a7452008-07-21 04:28:12 +00003239 }
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003240
Chris Lattnerdc420f42008-07-21 04:59:05 +00003241 // Handle access to Objective-C instance variables, such as "Obj->ivar" and
3242 // (*Obj).ivar.
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003243 if ((IsArrow && BaseType->isObjCObjectPointerType()) ||
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00003244 (!IsArrow && BaseType->isObjCObjectType())) {
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00003245 const ObjCObjectPointerType *OPT = BaseType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00003246 ObjCInterfaceDecl *IDecl =
3247 OPT ? OPT->getInterfaceDecl()
3248 : BaseType->getAs<ObjCObjectType>()->getInterface();
3249 if (IDecl) {
Anders Carlssonf571c112009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003250 IdentifierInfo *Member = MemberName.getAsIdentifierInfo();
3251
Steve Naroffa057ba92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003252 ObjCInterfaceDecl *ClassDeclared;
Anders Carlssonf571c112009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003253 ObjCIvarDecl *IV = IDecl->lookupInstanceVariable(Member, ClassDeclared);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003254
Douglas Gregor35b0bac2010-01-03 18:01:57 +00003255 if (!IV) {
3256 // Attempt to correct for typos in ivar names.
3257 LookupResult Res(*this, R.getLookupName(), R.getNameLoc(),
3258 LookupMemberName);
Douglas Gregord507d772010-10-20 03:06:34 +00003259 if (CorrectTypo(Res, 0, 0, IDecl, false,
3260 IsArrow? CTC_ObjCIvarLookup
3261 : CTC_ObjCPropertyLookup) &&
Douglas Gregor35b0bac2010-01-03 18:01:57 +00003262 (IV = Res.getAsSingle<ObjCIvarDecl>())) {
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003263 Diag(R.getNameLoc(),
Douglas Gregor35b0bac2010-01-03 18:01:57 +00003264 diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_ivar_suggest)
3265 << IDecl->getDeclName() << MemberName << IV->getDeclName()
Douglas Gregora771f462010-03-31 17:46:05 +00003266 << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(R.getNameLoc(),
3267 IV->getNameAsString());
Douglas Gregor6da83622010-01-07 00:17:44 +00003268 Diag(IV->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_decl)
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003269 << IV->getDeclName();
Douglas Gregorc048c522010-06-29 19:27:42 +00003270 } else {
3271 Res.clear();
3272 Res.setLookupName(Member);
Douglas Gregor35b0bac2010-01-03 18:01:57 +00003273 }
3274 }
3275
Steve Naroffa057ba92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003276 if (IV) {
3277 // If the decl being referenced had an error, return an error for this
3278 // sub-expr without emitting another error, in order to avoid cascading
3279 // error cases.
3280 if (IV->isInvalidDecl())
3281 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregor171c45a2009-02-18 21:56:37 +00003282
Steve Naroffa057ba92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003283 // Check whether we can reference this field.
3284 if (DiagnoseUseOfDecl(IV, MemberLoc))
3285 return ExprError();
3286 if (IV->getAccessControl() != ObjCIvarDecl::Public &&
3287 IV->getAccessControl() != ObjCIvarDecl::Package) {
3288 ObjCInterfaceDecl *ClassOfMethodDecl = 0;
3289 if (ObjCMethodDecl *MD = getCurMethodDecl())
3290 ClassOfMethodDecl = MD->getClassInterface();
3291 else if (ObjCImpDecl && getCurFunctionDecl()) {
3292 // Case of a c-function declared inside an objc implementation.
3293 // FIXME: For a c-style function nested inside an objc implementation
3294 // class, there is no implementation context available, so we pass
3295 // down the context as argument to this routine. Ideally, this context
3296 // need be passed down in the AST node and somehow calculated from the
3297 // AST for a function decl.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003298 if (ObjCImplementationDecl *IMPD =
John McCall48871652010-08-21 09:40:31 +00003299 dyn_cast<ObjCImplementationDecl>(ObjCImpDecl))
Steve Naroffa057ba92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003300 ClassOfMethodDecl = IMPD->getClassInterface();
3301 else if (ObjCCategoryImplDecl* CatImplClass =
John McCall48871652010-08-21 09:40:31 +00003302 dyn_cast<ObjCCategoryImplDecl>(ObjCImpDecl))
Steve Naroffa057ba92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003303 ClassOfMethodDecl = CatImplClass->getClassInterface();
3304 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003305
3306 if (IV->getAccessControl() == ObjCIvarDecl::Private) {
3307 if (ClassDeclared != IDecl ||
Steve Naroffa057ba92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003308 ClassOfMethodDecl != ClassDeclared)
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003309 Diag(MemberLoc, diag::error_private_ivar_access)
Steve Naroffa057ba92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003310 << IV->getDeclName();
Mike Stump12b8ce12009-08-04 21:02:39 +00003311 } else if (!IDecl->isSuperClassOf(ClassOfMethodDecl))
3312 // @protected
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003313 Diag(MemberLoc, diag::error_protected_ivar_access)
Steve Naroffa057ba92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003314 << IV->getDeclName();
Steve Naroffd1b64be2009-03-04 18:34:24 +00003315 }
Steve Naroffa057ba92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003316
3317 return Owned(new (Context) ObjCIvarRefExpr(IV, IV->getType(),
3318 MemberLoc, BaseExpr,
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003319 IsArrow));
Fariborz Jahaniana458c4f2009-03-03 01:21:12 +00003320 }
Steve Naroffa057ba92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003321 return ExprError(Diag(MemberLoc, diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_ivar)
Anders Carlssonf571c112009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003322 << IDecl->getDeclName() << MemberName
Steve Naroffa057ba92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003323 << BaseExpr->getSourceRange());
Fariborz Jahanianb1378f92008-12-13 22:20:28 +00003324 }
Chris Lattnerb63a7452008-07-21 04:28:12 +00003325 }
Steve Naroff1329fa02009-07-15 18:40:39 +00003326 // Handle properties on 'id' and qualified "id".
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003327 if (!IsArrow && (BaseType->isObjCIdType() ||
3328 BaseType->isObjCQualifiedIdType())) {
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00003329 const ObjCObjectPointerType *QIdTy = BaseType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
Anders Carlssonf571c112009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003330 IdentifierInfo *Member = MemberName.getAsIdentifierInfo();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003331
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00003332 // Check protocols on qualified interfaces.
Anders Carlssonf571c112009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003333 Selector Sel = PP.getSelectorTable().getNullarySelector(Member);
Fariborz Jahanianf3f903a2010-10-11 21:29:12 +00003334 if (Decl *PMDecl = FindGetterSetterNameDecl(QIdTy, Member, Sel,
3335 Context)) {
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00003336 if (ObjCPropertyDecl *PD = dyn_cast<ObjCPropertyDecl>(PMDecl)) {
3337 // Check the use of this declaration
3338 if (DiagnoseUseOfDecl(PD, MemberLoc))
3339 return ExprError();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003340
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00003341 return Owned(new (Context) ObjCPropertyRefExpr(PD, PD->getType(),
Fariborz Jahanian681c0752010-10-14 16:04:05 +00003342 MemberLoc,
3343 BaseExpr));
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00003344 }
3345 if (ObjCMethodDecl *OMD = dyn_cast<ObjCMethodDecl>(PMDecl)) {
3346 // Check the use of this method.
3347 if (DiagnoseUseOfDecl(OMD, MemberLoc))
3348 return ExprError();
Fariborz Jahanianf3f903a2010-10-11 21:29:12 +00003349 Selector SetterSel =
3350 SelectorTable::constructSetterName(PP.getIdentifierTable(),
3351 PP.getSelectorTable(), Member);
3352 ObjCMethodDecl *SMD = 0;
3353 if (Decl *SDecl = FindGetterSetterNameDecl(QIdTy, /*Property id*/0,
3354 SetterSel, Context))
3355 SMD = dyn_cast<ObjCMethodDecl>(SDecl);
3356 QualType PType = OMD->getSendResultType();
3357 return Owned(new (Context) ObjCImplicitSetterGetterRefExpr(OMD, PType,
3358 SMD,
3359 MemberLoc,
3360 BaseExpr));
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00003361 }
3362 }
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003363
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00003364 return ExprError(Diag(MemberLoc, diag::err_property_not_found)
Anders Carlssonf571c112009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003365 << MemberName << BaseType);
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00003366 }
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00003367
Chris Lattnerdc420f42008-07-21 04:59:05 +00003368 // Handle Objective-C property access, which is "Obj.property" where Obj is a
3369 // pointer to a (potentially qualified) interface type.
Chris Lattner2b1ca5f2010-04-11 07:45:24 +00003370 if (!IsArrow)
3371 if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *OPT =
3372 BaseType->getAsObjCInterfacePointerType())
Fariborz Jahanian681c0752010-10-14 16:04:05 +00003373 return HandleExprPropertyRefExpr(OPT, BaseExpr, MemberName, MemberLoc,
3374 SourceLocation(), QualType(), false);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003375
Steve Naroffe87026a2009-07-24 17:54:45 +00003376 // Handle the following exceptional case (*Obj).isa.
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003377 if (!IsArrow &&
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00003378 BaseType->isObjCObjectType() &&
3379 BaseType->getAs<ObjCObjectType>()->isObjCId() &&
Anders Carlssonf571c112009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003380 MemberName.getAsIdentifierInfo()->isStr("isa"))
Steve Naroffe87026a2009-07-24 17:54:45 +00003381 return Owned(new (Context) ObjCIsaExpr(BaseExpr, false, MemberLoc,
Fariborz Jahaniana5fee262009-12-09 19:05:56 +00003382 Context.getObjCClassType()));
Steve Naroffe87026a2009-07-24 17:54:45 +00003383
Chris Lattnerb63a7452008-07-21 04:28:12 +00003384 // Handle 'field access' to vectors, such as 'V.xx'.
Chris Lattner6c7ce102009-02-16 21:11:58 +00003385 if (BaseType->isExtVectorType()) {
Anders Carlssonf571c112009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003386 IdentifierInfo *Member = MemberName.getAsIdentifierInfo();
Chris Lattnerb63a7452008-07-21 04:28:12 +00003387 QualType ret = CheckExtVectorComponent(BaseType, OpLoc, Member, MemberLoc);
3388 if (ret.isNull())
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003389 return ExprError();
Anders Carlssonf571c112009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003390 return Owned(new (Context) ExtVectorElementExpr(ret, BaseExpr, *Member,
Steve Narofff6009ed2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00003391 MemberLoc));
Chris Lattnerb63a7452008-07-21 04:28:12 +00003392 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003393
Douglas Gregor0b08ba42009-03-27 06:00:30 +00003394 Diag(MemberLoc, diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_struct_union)
3395 << BaseType << BaseExpr->getSourceRange();
3396
Douglas Gregor0b08ba42009-03-27 06:00:30 +00003397 return ExprError();
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00003398}
3399
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003400/// The main callback when the parser finds something like
3401/// expression . [nested-name-specifier] identifier
3402/// expression -> [nested-name-specifier] identifier
3403/// where 'identifier' encompasses a fairly broad spectrum of
3404/// possibilities, including destructor and operator references.
3405///
3406/// \param OpKind either tok::arrow or tok::period
3407/// \param HasTrailingLParen whether the next token is '(', which
3408/// is used to diagnose mis-uses of special members that can
3409/// only be called
3410/// \param ObjCImpDecl the current ObjC @implementation decl;
3411/// this is an ugly hack around the fact that ObjC @implementations
3412/// aren't properly put in the context chain
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00003413ExprResult Sema::ActOnMemberAccessExpr(Scope *S, Expr *Base,
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003414 SourceLocation OpLoc,
3415 tok::TokenKind OpKind,
Jeffrey Yasskinc76498d2010-04-08 16:38:48 +00003416 CXXScopeSpec &SS,
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003417 UnqualifiedId &Id,
John McCall48871652010-08-21 09:40:31 +00003418 Decl *ObjCImpDecl,
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003419 bool HasTrailingLParen) {
3420 if (SS.isSet() && SS.isInvalid())
3421 return ExprError();
3422
3423 TemplateArgumentListInfo TemplateArgsBuffer;
3424
3425 // Decompose the name into its component parts.
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00003426 DeclarationNameInfo NameInfo;
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003427 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs;
3428 DecomposeUnqualifiedId(*this, Id, TemplateArgsBuffer,
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00003429 NameInfo, TemplateArgs);
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003430
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00003431 DeclarationName Name = NameInfo.getName();
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003432 bool IsArrow = (OpKind == tok::arrow);
3433
3434 NamedDecl *FirstQualifierInScope
3435 = (!SS.isSet() ? 0 : FindFirstQualifierInScope(S,
3436 static_cast<NestedNameSpecifier*>(SS.getScopeRep())));
3437
3438 // This is a postfix expression, so get rid of ParenListExprs.
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00003439 ExprResult Result = MaybeConvertParenListExprToParenExpr(S, Base);
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003440 if (Result.isInvalid()) return ExprError();
3441 Base = Result.take();
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003442
Douglas Gregor41f90302010-04-12 20:54:26 +00003443 if (Base->getType()->isDependentType() || Name.isDependentName() ||
3444 isDependentScopeSpecifier(SS)) {
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003445 Result = ActOnDependentMemberExpr(Base, Base->getType(),
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003446 IsArrow, OpLoc,
3447 SS, FirstQualifierInScope,
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00003448 NameInfo, TemplateArgs);
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003449 } else {
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00003450 LookupResult R(*this, NameInfo, LookupMemberName);
John McCalle9cccd82010-06-16 08:42:20 +00003451 Result = LookupMemberExpr(R, Base, IsArrow, OpLoc,
3452 SS, ObjCImpDecl, TemplateArgs != 0);
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00003453
John McCalle9cccd82010-06-16 08:42:20 +00003454 if (Result.isInvalid()) {
3455 Owned(Base);
3456 return ExprError();
3457 }
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003458
John McCalle9cccd82010-06-16 08:42:20 +00003459 if (Result.get()) {
3460 // The only way a reference to a destructor can be used is to
3461 // immediately call it, which falls into this case. If the
3462 // next token is not a '(', produce a diagnostic and build the
3463 // call now.
3464 if (!HasTrailingLParen &&
3465 Id.getKind() == UnqualifiedId::IK_DestructorName)
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003466 return DiagnoseDtorReference(NameInfo.getLoc(), Result.get());
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003467
John McCalle9cccd82010-06-16 08:42:20 +00003468 return move(Result);
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003469 }
3470
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003471 Result = BuildMemberReferenceExpr(Base, Base->getType(),
John McCall38836f02010-01-15 08:34:02 +00003472 OpLoc, IsArrow, SS, FirstQualifierInScope,
3473 R, TemplateArgs);
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003474 }
3475
3476 return move(Result);
Anders Carlssonf571c112009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003477}
3478
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00003479ExprResult Sema::BuildCXXDefaultArgExpr(SourceLocation CallLoc,
Anders Carlsson355933d2009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003480 FunctionDecl *FD,
3481 ParmVarDecl *Param) {
3482 if (Param->hasUnparsedDefaultArg()) {
Douglas Gregor8a01b2a2010-09-11 20:24:53 +00003483 Diag(CallLoc,
Anders Carlsson355933d2009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003484 diag::err_use_of_default_argument_to_function_declared_later) <<
3485 FD << cast<CXXRecordDecl>(FD->getDeclContext())->getDeclName();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003486 Diag(UnparsedDefaultArgLocs[Param],
Anders Carlsson355933d2009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003487 diag::note_default_argument_declared_here);
Douglas Gregor8a01b2a2010-09-11 20:24:53 +00003488 return ExprError();
3489 }
3490
3491 if (Param->hasUninstantiatedDefaultArg()) {
3492 Expr *UninstExpr = Param->getUninstantiatedDefaultArg();
Anders Carlsson355933d2009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003493
Douglas Gregor8a01b2a2010-09-11 20:24:53 +00003494 // Instantiate the expression.
3495 MultiLevelTemplateArgumentList ArgList
3496 = getTemplateInstantiationArgs(FD, 0, /*RelativeToPrimary=*/true);
Anders Carlsson657bad42009-09-05 05:14:19 +00003497
Douglas Gregor8a01b2a2010-09-11 20:24:53 +00003498 std::pair<const TemplateArgument *, unsigned> Innermost
3499 = ArgList.getInnermost();
3500 InstantiatingTemplate Inst(*this, CallLoc, Param, Innermost.first,
3501 Innermost.second);
Anders Carlsson355933d2009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003502
Douglas Gregor8a01b2a2010-09-11 20:24:53 +00003503 ExprResult Result = SubstExpr(UninstExpr, ArgList);
3504 if (Result.isInvalid())
3505 return ExprError();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003506
Douglas Gregor8a01b2a2010-09-11 20:24:53 +00003507 // Check the expression as an initializer for the parameter.
3508 InitializedEntity Entity
Fariborz Jahanian8fb87ae2010-09-24 17:30:16 +00003509 = InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(Context, Param);
Douglas Gregor8a01b2a2010-09-11 20:24:53 +00003510 InitializationKind Kind
3511 = InitializationKind::CreateCopy(Param->getLocation(),
3512 /*FIXME:EqualLoc*/UninstExpr->getSourceRange().getBegin());
3513 Expr *ResultE = Result.takeAs<Expr>();
Douglas Gregor25ab25f2009-12-23 18:19:08 +00003514
Douglas Gregor8a01b2a2010-09-11 20:24:53 +00003515 InitializationSequence InitSeq(*this, Entity, Kind, &ResultE, 1);
3516 Result = InitSeq.Perform(*this, Entity, Kind,
3517 MultiExprArg(*this, &ResultE, 1));
3518 if (Result.isInvalid())
3519 return ExprError();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003520
Douglas Gregor8a01b2a2010-09-11 20:24:53 +00003521 // Build the default argument expression.
3522 return Owned(CXXDefaultArgExpr::Create(Context, CallLoc, Param,
3523 Result.takeAs<Expr>()));
Anders Carlsson355933d2009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003524 }
3525
Douglas Gregor8a01b2a2010-09-11 20:24:53 +00003526 // If the default expression creates temporaries, we need to
3527 // push them to the current stack of expression temporaries so they'll
3528 // be properly destroyed.
3529 // FIXME: We should really be rebuilding the default argument with new
3530 // bound temporaries; see the comment in PR5810.
Douglas Gregor6ed2fee2010-09-14 22:55:20 +00003531 for (unsigned i = 0, e = Param->getNumDefaultArgTemporaries(); i != e; ++i) {
3532 CXXTemporary *Temporary = Param->getDefaultArgTemporary(i);
3533 MarkDeclarationReferenced(Param->getDefaultArg()->getLocStart(),
3534 const_cast<CXXDestructorDecl*>(Temporary->getDestructor()));
3535 ExprTemporaries.push_back(Temporary);
3536 }
Douglas Gregor8a01b2a2010-09-11 20:24:53 +00003537
3538 // We already type-checked the argument, so we know it works.
Douglas Gregor32b3de52010-09-11 23:32:50 +00003539 // Just mark all of the declarations in this potentially-evaluated expression
3540 // as being "referenced".
Douglas Gregor8a01b2a2010-09-11 20:24:53 +00003541 MarkDeclarationsReferencedInExpr(Param->getDefaultArg());
Douglas Gregor033f6752009-12-23 23:03:06 +00003542 return Owned(CXXDefaultArgExpr::Create(Context, CallLoc, Param));
Anders Carlsson355933d2009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003543}
3544
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003545/// ConvertArgumentsForCall - Converts the arguments specified in
3546/// Args/NumArgs to the parameter types of the function FDecl with
3547/// function prototype Proto. Call is the call expression itself, and
3548/// Fn is the function expression. For a C++ member function, this
3549/// routine does not attempt to convert the object argument. Returns
3550/// true if the call is ill-formed.
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00003551bool
3552Sema::ConvertArgumentsForCall(CallExpr *Call, Expr *Fn,
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003553 FunctionDecl *FDecl,
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00003554 const FunctionProtoType *Proto,
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003555 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs,
3556 SourceLocation RParenLoc) {
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00003557 // C99 6.5.2.2p7 - the arguments are implicitly converted, as if by
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003558 // assignment, to the types of the corresponding parameter, ...
3559 unsigned NumArgsInProto = Proto->getNumArgs();
Douglas Gregorb6b99612009-01-23 21:30:56 +00003560 bool Invalid = false;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003561
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003562 // If too few arguments are available (and we don't have default
3563 // arguments for the remaining parameters), don't make the call.
3564 if (NumArgs < NumArgsInProto) {
3565 if (!FDecl || NumArgs < FDecl->getMinRequiredArguments())
3566 return Diag(RParenLoc, diag::err_typecheck_call_too_few_args)
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00003567 << Fn->getType()->isBlockPointerType()
Eric Christopherabf1e182010-04-16 04:48:22 +00003568 << NumArgsInProto << NumArgs << Fn->getSourceRange();
Ted Kremenek5a201952009-02-07 01:47:29 +00003569 Call->setNumArgs(Context, NumArgsInProto);
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003570 }
3571
3572 // If too many are passed and not variadic, error on the extras and drop
3573 // them.
3574 if (NumArgs > NumArgsInProto) {
3575 if (!Proto->isVariadic()) {
3576 Diag(Args[NumArgsInProto]->getLocStart(),
3577 diag::err_typecheck_call_too_many_args)
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00003578 << Fn->getType()->isBlockPointerType()
Eric Christopher2a5aaff2010-04-16 04:56:46 +00003579 << NumArgsInProto << NumArgs << Fn->getSourceRange()
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003580 << SourceRange(Args[NumArgsInProto]->getLocStart(),
3581 Args[NumArgs-1]->getLocEnd());
3582 // This deletes the extra arguments.
Ted Kremenek5a201952009-02-07 01:47:29 +00003583 Call->setNumArgs(Context, NumArgsInProto);
Fariborz Jahanian835026e2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003584 return true;
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003585 }
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003586 }
Fariborz Jahanian835026e2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003587 llvm::SmallVector<Expr *, 8> AllArgs;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003588 VariadicCallType CallType =
Fariborz Jahanian6f2d25e2009-11-24 19:27:49 +00003589 Proto->isVariadic() ? VariadicFunction : VariadicDoesNotApply;
3590 if (Fn->getType()->isBlockPointerType())
3591 CallType = VariadicBlock; // Block
3592 else if (isa<MemberExpr>(Fn))
3593 CallType = VariadicMethod;
Fariborz Jahanian835026e2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003594 Invalid = GatherArgumentsForCall(Call->getSourceRange().getBegin(), FDecl,
Fariborz Jahanian4fa66ce2009-11-24 21:37:28 +00003595 Proto, 0, Args, NumArgs, AllArgs, CallType);
Fariborz Jahanian835026e2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003596 if (Invalid)
3597 return true;
3598 unsigned TotalNumArgs = AllArgs.size();
3599 for (unsigned i = 0; i < TotalNumArgs; ++i)
3600 Call->setArg(i, AllArgs[i]);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003601
Fariborz Jahanian835026e2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003602 return false;
3603}
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00003604
Fariborz Jahanian835026e2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003605bool Sema::GatherArgumentsForCall(SourceLocation CallLoc,
3606 FunctionDecl *FDecl,
3607 const FunctionProtoType *Proto,
3608 unsigned FirstProtoArg,
3609 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs,
3610 llvm::SmallVector<Expr *, 8> &AllArgs,
Fariborz Jahanian6f2d25e2009-11-24 19:27:49 +00003611 VariadicCallType CallType) {
Fariborz Jahanian835026e2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003612 unsigned NumArgsInProto = Proto->getNumArgs();
3613 unsigned NumArgsToCheck = NumArgs;
3614 bool Invalid = false;
3615 if (NumArgs != NumArgsInProto)
3616 // Use default arguments for missing arguments
3617 NumArgsToCheck = NumArgsInProto;
3618 unsigned ArgIx = 0;
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003619 // Continue to check argument types (even if we have too few/many args).
Fariborz Jahanian835026e2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003620 for (unsigned i = FirstProtoArg; i != NumArgsToCheck; i++) {
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003621 QualType ProtoArgType = Proto->getArgType(i);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003622
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003623 Expr *Arg;
Fariborz Jahanian835026e2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003624 if (ArgIx < NumArgs) {
3625 Arg = Args[ArgIx++];
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003626
Eli Friedman3164fb12009-03-22 22:00:50 +00003627 if (RequireCompleteType(Arg->getSourceRange().getBegin(),
3628 ProtoArgType,
Anders Carlssond624e162009-08-26 23:45:07 +00003629 PDiag(diag::err_call_incomplete_argument)
Fariborz Jahanian835026e2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003630 << Arg->getSourceRange()))
Eli Friedman3164fb12009-03-22 22:00:50 +00003631 return true;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003632
Douglas Gregorbbeb5c32009-12-22 16:09:06 +00003633 // Pass the argument
3634 ParmVarDecl *Param = 0;
3635 if (FDecl && i < FDecl->getNumParams())
3636 Param = FDecl->getParamDecl(i);
Douglas Gregor96596c92009-12-22 07:24:36 +00003637
Douglas Gregorbbeb5c32009-12-22 16:09:06 +00003638 InitializedEntity Entity =
Fariborz Jahanian8fb87ae2010-09-24 17:30:16 +00003639 Param? InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(Context, Param)
3640 : InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(Context, ProtoArgType);
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00003641 ExprResult ArgE = PerformCopyInitialization(Entity,
Douglas Gregorbbeb5c32009-12-22 16:09:06 +00003642 SourceLocation(),
3643 Owned(Arg));
3644 if (ArgE.isInvalid())
3645 return true;
3646
3647 Arg = ArgE.takeAs<Expr>();
Anders Carlsson84613c42009-06-12 16:51:40 +00003648 } else {
Anders Carlssonc80a1272009-08-25 02:29:20 +00003649 ParmVarDecl *Param = FDecl->getParamDecl(i);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003650
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00003651 ExprResult ArgExpr =
Fariborz Jahanian835026e2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003652 BuildCXXDefaultArgExpr(CallLoc, FDecl, Param);
Anders Carlsson355933d2009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003653 if (ArgExpr.isInvalid())
3654 return true;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003655
Anders Carlsson355933d2009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003656 Arg = ArgExpr.takeAs<Expr>();
Anders Carlsson84613c42009-06-12 16:51:40 +00003657 }
Fariborz Jahanian835026e2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003658 AllArgs.push_back(Arg);
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003659 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003660
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003661 // If this is a variadic call, handle args passed through "...".
Fariborz Jahanian6f2d25e2009-11-24 19:27:49 +00003662 if (CallType != VariadicDoesNotApply) {
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003663 // Promote the arguments (C99 6.5.2.2p7).
Chris Lattnerbb53efb2010-05-16 04:01:30 +00003664 for (unsigned i = ArgIx; i != NumArgs; ++i) {
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003665 Expr *Arg = Args[i];
Chris Lattnerbb53efb2010-05-16 04:01:30 +00003666 Invalid |= DefaultVariadicArgumentPromotion(Arg, CallType, FDecl);
Fariborz Jahanian835026e2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003667 AllArgs.push_back(Arg);
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003668 }
3669 }
Douglas Gregorb6b99612009-01-23 21:30:56 +00003670 return Invalid;
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003671}
3672
Steve Naroff83895f72007-09-16 03:34:24 +00003673/// ActOnCallExpr - Handle a call to Fn with the specified array of arguments.
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00003674/// This provides the location of the left/right parens and a list of comma
3675/// locations.
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00003676ExprResult
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003677Sema::ActOnCallExpr(Scope *S, Expr *Fn, SourceLocation LParenLoc,
Douglas Gregorce5aa332010-09-09 16:33:13 +00003678 MultiExprArg args, SourceLocation RParenLoc) {
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003679 unsigned NumArgs = args.size();
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00003680
3681 // Since this might be a postfix expression, get rid of ParenListExprs.
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00003682 ExprResult Result = MaybeConvertParenListExprToParenExpr(S, Fn);
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003683 if (Result.isInvalid()) return ExprError();
3684 Fn = Result.take();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003685
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003686 Expr **Args = args.release();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003687
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003688 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
Douglas Gregorad8a3362009-09-04 17:36:40 +00003689 // If this is a pseudo-destructor expression, build the call immediately.
3690 if (isa<CXXPseudoDestructorExpr>(Fn)) {
3691 if (NumArgs > 0) {
3692 // Pseudo-destructor calls should not have any arguments.
3693 Diag(Fn->getLocStart(), diag::err_pseudo_dtor_call_with_args)
Douglas Gregora771f462010-03-31 17:46:05 +00003694 << FixItHint::CreateRemoval(
Douglas Gregorad8a3362009-09-04 17:36:40 +00003695 SourceRange(Args[0]->getLocStart(),
3696 Args[NumArgs-1]->getLocEnd()));
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003697
Douglas Gregorad8a3362009-09-04 17:36:40 +00003698 NumArgs = 0;
3699 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003700
Douglas Gregorad8a3362009-09-04 17:36:40 +00003701 return Owned(new (Context) CallExpr(Context, Fn, 0, 0, Context.VoidTy,
3702 RParenLoc));
3703 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003704
Douglas Gregorb8a9a412009-02-04 15:01:18 +00003705 // Determine whether this is a dependent call inside a C++ template,
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00003706 // in which case we won't do any semantic analysis now.
Mike Stump87c57ac2009-05-16 07:39:55 +00003707 // FIXME: Will need to cache the results of name lookup (including ADL) in
3708 // Fn.
Douglas Gregorb8a9a412009-02-04 15:01:18 +00003709 bool Dependent = false;
3710 if (Fn->isTypeDependent())
3711 Dependent = true;
3712 else if (Expr::hasAnyTypeDependentArguments(Args, NumArgs))
3713 Dependent = true;
3714
3715 if (Dependent)
Ted Kremenekd7b4f402009-02-09 20:51:47 +00003716 return Owned(new (Context) CallExpr(Context, Fn, Args, NumArgs,
Douglas Gregorb8a9a412009-02-04 15:01:18 +00003717 Context.DependentTy, RParenLoc));
3718
3719 // Determine whether this is a call to an object (C++ [over.call.object]).
3720 if (Fn->getType()->isRecordType())
3721 return Owned(BuildCallToObjectOfClassType(S, Fn, LParenLoc, Args, NumArgs,
Douglas Gregorce5aa332010-09-09 16:33:13 +00003722 RParenLoc));
Douglas Gregorb8a9a412009-02-04 15:01:18 +00003723
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003724 Expr *NakedFn = Fn->IgnoreParens();
3725
3726 // Determine whether this is a call to an unresolved member function.
3727 if (UnresolvedMemberExpr *MemE = dyn_cast<UnresolvedMemberExpr>(NakedFn)) {
3728 // If lookup was unresolved but not dependent (i.e. didn't find
3729 // an unresolved using declaration), it has to be an overloaded
3730 // function set, which means it must contain either multiple
3731 // declarations (all methods or method templates) or a single
3732 // method template.
3733 assert((MemE->getNumDecls() > 1) ||
Douglas Gregor516d6722010-04-25 21:15:30 +00003734 isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(
3735 (*MemE->decls_begin())->getUnderlyingDecl()));
Douglas Gregor8f184a32009-12-01 03:34:29 +00003736 (void)MemE;
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003737
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00003738 return BuildCallToMemberFunction(S, Fn, LParenLoc, Args, NumArgs,
Douglas Gregorce5aa332010-09-09 16:33:13 +00003739 RParenLoc);
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003740 }
3741
Douglas Gregore254f902009-02-04 00:32:51 +00003742 // Determine whether this is a call to a member function.
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003743 if (MemberExpr *MemExpr = dyn_cast<MemberExpr>(NakedFn)) {
Douglas Gregorad3f2fc2009-06-25 22:08:12 +00003744 NamedDecl *MemDecl = MemExpr->getMemberDecl();
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003745 if (isa<CXXMethodDecl>(MemDecl))
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00003746 return BuildCallToMemberFunction(S, Fn, LParenLoc, Args, NumArgs,
Douglas Gregorce5aa332010-09-09 16:33:13 +00003747 RParenLoc);
Douglas Gregorad3f2fc2009-06-25 22:08:12 +00003748 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003749
Anders Carlsson61914b52009-10-03 17:40:22 +00003750 // Determine whether this is a call to a pointer-to-member function.
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003751 if (BinaryOperator *BO = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(NakedFn)) {
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00003752 if (BO->getOpcode() == BO_PtrMemD ||
3753 BO->getOpcode() == BO_PtrMemI) {
Douglas Gregorc8be9522010-05-04 18:18:31 +00003754 if (const FunctionProtoType *FPT
3755 = BO->getType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>()) {
Douglas Gregor603d81b2010-07-13 08:18:22 +00003756 QualType ResultTy = FPT->getCallResultType(Context);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003757
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003758 CXXMemberCallExpr *TheCall
3759 = new (Context) CXXMemberCallExpr(Context, BO, Args,
3760 NumArgs, ResultTy,
3761 RParenLoc);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003762
3763 if (CheckCallReturnType(FPT->getResultType(),
3764 BO->getRHS()->getSourceRange().getBegin(),
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003765 TheCall, 0))
Fariborz Jahanian42f66632009-10-28 16:49:46 +00003766 return ExprError();
Anders Carlsson63dce022009-10-15 00:41:48 +00003767
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003768 if (ConvertArgumentsForCall(TheCall, BO, 0, FPT, Args, NumArgs,
Fariborz Jahanian42f66632009-10-28 16:49:46 +00003769 RParenLoc))
3770 return ExprError();
Anders Carlsson61914b52009-10-03 17:40:22 +00003771
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003772 return MaybeBindToTemporary(TheCall);
Fariborz Jahanian42f66632009-10-28 16:49:46 +00003773 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003774 return ExprError(Diag(Fn->getLocStart(),
Fariborz Jahanian42f66632009-10-28 16:49:46 +00003775 diag::err_typecheck_call_not_function)
3776 << Fn->getType() << Fn->getSourceRange());
Anders Carlsson61914b52009-10-03 17:40:22 +00003777 }
3778 }
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003779 }
3780
Douglas Gregore254f902009-02-04 00:32:51 +00003781 // If we're directly calling a function, get the appropriate declaration.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003782 // Also, in C++, keep track of whether we should perform argument-dependent
Douglas Gregor89026b52009-06-30 23:57:56 +00003783 // lookup and whether there were any explicitly-specified template arguments.
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00003784
Eli Friedmane14b1992009-12-26 03:35:45 +00003785 Expr *NakedFn = Fn->IgnoreParens();
Douglas Gregor928479e2010-11-09 20:03:54 +00003786 if (isa<UnresolvedLookupExpr>(NakedFn)) {
3787 UnresolvedLookupExpr *ULE = cast<UnresolvedLookupExpr>(NakedFn);
3788 return BuildOverloadedCallExpr(S, Fn, ULE, LParenLoc, Args, NumArgs,
3789 RParenLoc);
3790 }
3791
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00003792 NamedDecl *NDecl = 0;
Douglas Gregor59f16ed2010-10-25 20:48:33 +00003793 if (UnaryOperator *UnOp = dyn_cast<UnaryOperator>(NakedFn))
3794 if (UnOp->getOpcode() == UO_AddrOf)
3795 NakedFn = UnOp->getSubExpr()->IgnoreParens();
3796
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00003797 if (isa<DeclRefExpr>(NakedFn))
3798 NDecl = cast<DeclRefExpr>(NakedFn)->getDecl();
3799
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00003800 return BuildResolvedCallExpr(Fn, NDecl, LParenLoc, Args, NumArgs, RParenLoc);
3801}
3802
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00003803/// BuildResolvedCallExpr - Build a call to a resolved expression,
3804/// i.e. an expression not of \p OverloadTy. The expression should
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00003805/// unary-convert to an expression of function-pointer or
3806/// block-pointer type.
3807///
3808/// \param NDecl the declaration being called, if available
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00003809ExprResult
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00003810Sema::BuildResolvedCallExpr(Expr *Fn, NamedDecl *NDecl,
3811 SourceLocation LParenLoc,
3812 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs,
3813 SourceLocation RParenLoc) {
3814 FunctionDecl *FDecl = dyn_cast_or_null<FunctionDecl>(NDecl);
3815
Chris Lattneraa9c7ae2008-04-08 04:40:51 +00003816 // Promote the function operand.
3817 UsualUnaryConversions(Fn);
3818
Chris Lattner08464942007-12-28 05:29:59 +00003819 // Make the call expr early, before semantic checks. This guarantees cleanup
3820 // of arguments and function on error.
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003821 CallExpr *TheCall = new (Context) CallExpr(Context, Fn,
3822 Args, NumArgs,
3823 Context.BoolTy,
3824 RParenLoc);
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003825
Steve Naroff8de9c3a2008-09-05 22:11:13 +00003826 const FunctionType *FuncT;
3827 if (!Fn->getType()->isBlockPointerType()) {
3828 // C99 6.5.2.2p1 - "The expression that denotes the called function shall
3829 // have type pointer to function".
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00003830 const PointerType *PT = Fn->getType()->getAs<PointerType>();
Steve Naroff8de9c3a2008-09-05 22:11:13 +00003831 if (PT == 0)
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003832 return ExprError(Diag(LParenLoc, diag::err_typecheck_call_not_function)
3833 << Fn->getType() << Fn->getSourceRange());
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00003834 FuncT = PT->getPointeeType()->getAs<FunctionType>();
Steve Naroff8de9c3a2008-09-05 22:11:13 +00003835 } else { // This is a block call.
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00003836 FuncT = Fn->getType()->getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType()->
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00003837 getAs<FunctionType>();
Steve Naroff8de9c3a2008-09-05 22:11:13 +00003838 }
Chris Lattner08464942007-12-28 05:29:59 +00003839 if (FuncT == 0)
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003840 return ExprError(Diag(LParenLoc, diag::err_typecheck_call_not_function)
3841 << Fn->getType() << Fn->getSourceRange());
3842
Eli Friedman3164fb12009-03-22 22:00:50 +00003843 // Check for a valid return type
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003844 if (CheckCallReturnType(FuncT->getResultType(),
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003845 Fn->getSourceRange().getBegin(), TheCall,
Anders Carlsson7f84ed92009-10-09 23:51:55 +00003846 FDecl))
Eli Friedman3164fb12009-03-22 22:00:50 +00003847 return ExprError();
3848
Chris Lattner08464942007-12-28 05:29:59 +00003849 // We know the result type of the call, set it.
Douglas Gregor603d81b2010-07-13 08:18:22 +00003850 TheCall->setType(FuncT->getCallResultType(Context));
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003851
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00003852 if (const FunctionProtoType *Proto = dyn_cast<FunctionProtoType>(FuncT)) {
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003853 if (ConvertArgumentsForCall(TheCall, Fn, FDecl, Proto, Args, NumArgs,
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003854 RParenLoc))
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003855 return ExprError();
Chris Lattner08464942007-12-28 05:29:59 +00003856 } else {
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00003857 assert(isa<FunctionNoProtoType>(FuncT) && "Unknown FunctionType!");
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003858
Douglas Gregord8e97de2009-04-02 15:37:10 +00003859 if (FDecl) {
3860 // Check if we have too few/too many template arguments, based
3861 // on our knowledge of the function definition.
3862 const FunctionDecl *Def = 0;
Argyrios Kyrtzidis36ea3222010-07-07 11:31:19 +00003863 if (FDecl->hasBody(Def) && NumArgs != Def->param_size()) {
Douglas Gregor8e09a722010-10-25 20:39:23 +00003864 const FunctionProtoType *Proto
3865 = Def->getType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>();
3866 if (!Proto || !(Proto->isVariadic() && NumArgs >= Def->param_size()))
Eli Friedmanfcbf7d22009-06-01 09:24:59 +00003867 Diag(RParenLoc, diag::warn_call_wrong_number_of_arguments)
3868 << (NumArgs > Def->param_size()) << FDecl << Fn->getSourceRange();
Eli Friedmanfcbf7d22009-06-01 09:24:59 +00003869 }
Douglas Gregor8e09a722010-10-25 20:39:23 +00003870
3871 // If the function we're calling isn't a function prototype, but we have
3872 // a function prototype from a prior declaratiom, use that prototype.
3873 if (!FDecl->hasPrototype())
3874 Proto = FDecl->getType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>();
Douglas Gregord8e97de2009-04-02 15:37:10 +00003875 }
3876
Steve Naroff0b661582007-08-28 23:30:39 +00003877 // Promote the arguments (C99 6.5.2.2p6).
Chris Lattner08464942007-12-28 05:29:59 +00003878 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumArgs; i++) {
3879 Expr *Arg = Args[i];
Douglas Gregor8e09a722010-10-25 20:39:23 +00003880
3881 if (Proto && i < Proto->getNumArgs()) {
Douglas Gregor8e09a722010-10-25 20:39:23 +00003882 InitializedEntity Entity
3883 = InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(Context,
3884 Proto->getArgType(i));
3885 ExprResult ArgE = PerformCopyInitialization(Entity,
3886 SourceLocation(),
3887 Owned(Arg));
3888 if (ArgE.isInvalid())
3889 return true;
3890
3891 Arg = ArgE.takeAs<Expr>();
3892
3893 } else {
3894 DefaultArgumentPromotion(Arg);
Douglas Gregor8e09a722010-10-25 20:39:23 +00003895 }
3896
Douglas Gregor83025412010-10-26 05:45:40 +00003897 if (RequireCompleteType(Arg->getSourceRange().getBegin(),
3898 Arg->getType(),
3899 PDiag(diag::err_call_incomplete_argument)
3900 << Arg->getSourceRange()))
3901 return ExprError();
3902
Chris Lattner08464942007-12-28 05:29:59 +00003903 TheCall->setArg(i, Arg);
Steve Naroff0b661582007-08-28 23:30:39 +00003904 }
Steve Naroffae4143e2007-04-26 20:39:23 +00003905 }
Chris Lattner08464942007-12-28 05:29:59 +00003906
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003907 if (CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast_or_null<CXXMethodDecl>(FDecl))
3908 if (!Method->isStatic())
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003909 return ExprError(Diag(LParenLoc, diag::err_member_call_without_object)
3910 << Fn->getSourceRange());
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003911
Fariborz Jahanian0aa5c452009-05-15 20:33:25 +00003912 // Check for sentinels
3913 if (NDecl)
3914 DiagnoseSentinelCalls(NDecl, LParenLoc, Args, NumArgs);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003915
Chris Lattnerb87b1b32007-08-10 20:18:51 +00003916 // Do special checking on direct calls to functions.
Anders Carlssonbc4c1072009-08-16 01:56:34 +00003917 if (FDecl) {
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003918 if (CheckFunctionCall(FDecl, TheCall))
Anders Carlssonbc4c1072009-08-16 01:56:34 +00003919 return ExprError();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003920
Douglas Gregor15fc9562009-09-12 00:22:50 +00003921 if (unsigned BuiltinID = FDecl->getBuiltinID())
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003922 return CheckBuiltinFunctionCall(BuiltinID, TheCall);
Anders Carlssonbc4c1072009-08-16 01:56:34 +00003923 } else if (NDecl) {
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003924 if (CheckBlockCall(NDecl, TheCall))
Anders Carlssonbc4c1072009-08-16 01:56:34 +00003925 return ExprError();
3926 }
Chris Lattnerb87b1b32007-08-10 20:18:51 +00003927
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003928 return MaybeBindToTemporary(TheCall);
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00003929}
3930
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00003931ExprResult
John McCallba7bf592010-08-24 05:47:05 +00003932Sema::ActOnCompoundLiteral(SourceLocation LParenLoc, ParsedType Ty,
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003933 SourceLocation RParenLoc, Expr *InitExpr) {
Steve Naroff83895f72007-09-16 03:34:24 +00003934 assert((Ty != 0) && "ActOnCompoundLiteral(): missing type");
Steve Naroff57eb2c52007-07-19 21:32:11 +00003935 // FIXME: put back this assert when initializers are worked out.
Steve Naroff83895f72007-09-16 03:34:24 +00003936 //assert((InitExpr != 0) && "ActOnCompoundLiteral(): missing expression");
John McCalle15bbff2010-01-18 19:35:47 +00003937
3938 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo;
3939 QualType literalType = GetTypeFromParser(Ty, &TInfo);
3940 if (!TInfo)
3941 TInfo = Context.getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(literalType);
3942
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003943 return BuildCompoundLiteralExpr(LParenLoc, TInfo, RParenLoc, InitExpr);
John McCalle15bbff2010-01-18 19:35:47 +00003944}
3945
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00003946ExprResult
John McCalle15bbff2010-01-18 19:35:47 +00003947Sema::BuildCompoundLiteralExpr(SourceLocation LParenLoc, TypeSourceInfo *TInfo,
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003948 SourceLocation RParenLoc, Expr *literalExpr) {
John McCalle15bbff2010-01-18 19:35:47 +00003949 QualType literalType = TInfo->getType();
Anders Carlsson2c1ec6d2007-12-05 07:24:19 +00003950
Eli Friedman37a186d2008-05-20 05:22:08 +00003951 if (literalType->isArrayType()) {
Argyrios Kyrtzidis85663562010-11-08 19:14:19 +00003952 if (RequireCompleteType(LParenLoc, Context.getBaseElementType(literalType),
3953 PDiag(diag::err_illegal_decl_array_incomplete_type)
3954 << SourceRange(LParenLoc,
3955 literalExpr->getSourceRange().getEnd())))
3956 return ExprError();
Chris Lattner7adf0762008-08-04 07:31:14 +00003957 if (literalType->isVariableArrayType())
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00003958 return ExprError(Diag(LParenLoc, diag::err_variable_object_no_init)
3959 << SourceRange(LParenLoc, literalExpr->getSourceRange().getEnd()));
Douglas Gregor1c37d9e2009-05-21 23:48:18 +00003960 } else if (!literalType->isDependentType() &&
3961 RequireCompleteType(LParenLoc, literalType,
Anders Carlssond624e162009-08-26 23:45:07 +00003962 PDiag(diag::err_typecheck_decl_incomplete_type)
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003963 << SourceRange(LParenLoc,
Anders Carlssond624e162009-08-26 23:45:07 +00003964 literalExpr->getSourceRange().getEnd())))
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00003965 return ExprError();
Eli Friedman37a186d2008-05-20 05:22:08 +00003966
Douglas Gregor85dabae2009-12-16 01:38:02 +00003967 InitializedEntity Entity
Douglas Gregor1b303932009-12-22 15:35:07 +00003968 = InitializedEntity::InitializeTemporary(literalType);
Douglas Gregor85dabae2009-12-16 01:38:02 +00003969 InitializationKind Kind
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003970 = InitializationKind::CreateCast(SourceRange(LParenLoc, RParenLoc),
Douglas Gregor85dabae2009-12-16 01:38:02 +00003971 /*IsCStyleCast=*/true);
Eli Friedmana553d4a2009-12-22 02:35:53 +00003972 InitializationSequence InitSeq(*this, Entity, Kind, &literalExpr, 1);
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00003973 ExprResult Result = InitSeq.Perform(*this, Entity, Kind,
John McCall37ad5512010-08-23 06:44:23 +00003974 MultiExprArg(*this, &literalExpr, 1),
Eli Friedmana553d4a2009-12-22 02:35:53 +00003975 &literalType);
3976 if (Result.isInvalid())
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00003977 return ExprError();
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003978 literalExpr = Result.get();
Steve Naroffd32419d2008-01-14 18:19:28 +00003979
Chris Lattner79413952008-12-04 23:50:19 +00003980 bool isFileScope = getCurFunctionOrMethodDecl() == 0;
Steve Naroffd32419d2008-01-14 18:19:28 +00003981 if (isFileScope) { // 6.5.2.5p3
Steve Naroff98f72032008-01-10 22:15:12 +00003982 if (CheckForConstantInitializer(literalExpr, literalType))
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00003983 return ExprError();
Steve Naroff98f72032008-01-10 22:15:12 +00003984 }
Eli Friedmana553d4a2009-12-22 02:35:53 +00003985
John McCall5d7aa7f2010-01-19 22:33:45 +00003986 return Owned(new (Context) CompoundLiteralExpr(LParenLoc, TInfo, literalType,
Steve Narofff6009ed2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00003987 literalExpr, isFileScope));
Steve Narofffbd09832007-07-19 01:06:55 +00003988}
3989
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00003990ExprResult
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00003991Sema::ActOnInitList(SourceLocation LBraceLoc, MultiExprArg initlist,
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00003992 SourceLocation RBraceLoc) {
3993 unsigned NumInit = initlist.size();
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003994 Expr **InitList = initlist.release();
Anders Carlsson4692db02007-08-31 04:56:16 +00003995
Steve Naroff30d242c2007-09-15 18:49:24 +00003996 // Semantic analysis for initializers is done by ActOnDeclarator() and
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00003997 // CheckInitializer() - it requires knowledge of the object being intialized.
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00003998
Ted Kremenekac034612010-04-13 23:39:13 +00003999 InitListExpr *E = new (Context) InitListExpr(Context, LBraceLoc, InitList,
4000 NumInit, RBraceLoc);
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00004001 E->setType(Context.VoidTy); // FIXME: just a place holder for now.
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00004002 return Owned(E);
Steve Narofffbd09832007-07-19 01:06:55 +00004003}
4004
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004005static CastKind getScalarCastKind(ASTContext &Context,
John McCalle84af4e2010-11-13 01:35:44 +00004006 Expr *Src, QualType DestTy) {
4007 QualType SrcTy = Src->getType();
Douglas Gregor1b8fe5b72009-11-16 21:35:15 +00004008 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(SrcTy, DestTy))
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004009 return CK_NoOp;
Anders Carlsson094c4592009-10-18 18:12:03 +00004010
4011 if (SrcTy->hasPointerRepresentation()) {
4012 if (DestTy->hasPointerRepresentation())
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004013 return DestTy->isObjCObjectPointerType() ?
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004014 CK_AnyPointerToObjCPointerCast :
4015 CK_BitCast;
Anders Carlsson094c4592009-10-18 18:12:03 +00004016 if (DestTy->isIntegerType())
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004017 return CK_PointerToIntegral;
Anders Carlsson094c4592009-10-18 18:12:03 +00004018 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004019
Anders Carlsson094c4592009-10-18 18:12:03 +00004020 if (SrcTy->isIntegerType()) {
4021 if (DestTy->isIntegerType())
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004022 return CK_IntegralCast;
John McCalle84af4e2010-11-13 01:35:44 +00004023 if (DestTy->hasPointerRepresentation()) {
4024 if (Src->isNullPointerConstant(Context, Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull))
4025 return CK_NullToPointer;
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004026 return CK_IntegralToPointer;
John McCalle84af4e2010-11-13 01:35:44 +00004027 }
Anders Carlsson094c4592009-10-18 18:12:03 +00004028 if (DestTy->isRealFloatingType())
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004029 return CK_IntegralToFloating;
Anders Carlsson094c4592009-10-18 18:12:03 +00004030 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004031
Anders Carlsson094c4592009-10-18 18:12:03 +00004032 if (SrcTy->isRealFloatingType()) {
4033 if (DestTy->isRealFloatingType())
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004034 return CK_FloatingCast;
Anders Carlsson094c4592009-10-18 18:12:03 +00004035 if (DestTy->isIntegerType())
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004036 return CK_FloatingToIntegral;
Anders Carlsson094c4592009-10-18 18:12:03 +00004037 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004038
Anders Carlsson094c4592009-10-18 18:12:03 +00004039 // FIXME: Assert here.
4040 // assert(false && "Unhandled cast combination!");
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004041 return CK_Unknown;
Anders Carlsson094c4592009-10-18 18:12:03 +00004042}
4043
Argyrios Kyrtzidis2ade3902008-08-16 20:27:34 +00004044/// CheckCastTypes - Check type constraints for casting between types.
Sebastian Redl955a0672009-07-29 13:50:23 +00004045bool Sema::CheckCastTypes(SourceRange TyR, QualType castType, Expr *&castExpr,
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004046 CastKind& Kind,
John McCallcf142162010-08-07 06:22:56 +00004047 CXXCastPath &BasePath,
Fariborz Jahanian1cec0c42009-08-26 18:55:36 +00004048 bool FunctionalStyle) {
Sebastian Redl9f831db2009-07-25 15:41:38 +00004049 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus)
Douglas Gregor15417cf2010-11-03 00:35:38 +00004050 return CXXCheckCStyleCast(SourceRange(TyR.getBegin(),
4051 castExpr->getLocEnd()),
4052 castType, castExpr, Kind, BasePath,
Anders Carlssona70cff62010-04-24 19:06:50 +00004053 FunctionalStyle);
Sebastian Redl9f831db2009-07-25 15:41:38 +00004054
Douglas Gregorb92a1562010-02-03 00:27:59 +00004055 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(castExpr);
Argyrios Kyrtzidis2ade3902008-08-16 20:27:34 +00004056
4057 // C99 6.5.4p2: the cast type needs to be void or scalar and the expression
4058 // type needs to be scalar.
4059 if (castType->isVoidType()) {
4060 // Cast to void allows any expr type.
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004061 Kind = CK_ToVoid;
Anders Carlssonef918ac2009-10-16 02:35:04 +00004062 return false;
4063 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004064
Eli Friedmane98194d2010-07-17 20:43:49 +00004065 if (RequireCompleteType(TyR.getBegin(), castType,
4066 diag::err_typecheck_cast_to_incomplete))
4067 return true;
4068
Anders Carlssonef918ac2009-10-16 02:35:04 +00004069 if (!castType->isScalarType() && !castType->isVectorType()) {
Douglas Gregor1b8fe5b72009-11-16 21:35:15 +00004070 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(castType, castExpr->getType()) &&
Seo Sanghyeon39a3ebf2009-01-15 04:51:39 +00004071 (castType->isStructureType() || castType->isUnionType())) {
4072 // GCC struct/union extension: allow cast to self.
Eli Friedmanba961a92009-03-23 00:24:07 +00004073 // FIXME: Check that the cast destination type is complete.
Seo Sanghyeon39a3ebf2009-01-15 04:51:39 +00004074 Diag(TyR.getBegin(), diag::ext_typecheck_cast_nonscalar)
4075 << castType << castExpr->getSourceRange();
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004076 Kind = CK_NoOp;
Anders Carlsson525b76b2009-10-16 02:48:28 +00004077 return false;
4078 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004079
Anders Carlsson525b76b2009-10-16 02:48:28 +00004080 if (castType->isUnionType()) {
Seo Sanghyeon39a3ebf2009-01-15 04:51:39 +00004081 // GCC cast to union extension
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004082 RecordDecl *RD = castType->getAs<RecordType>()->getDecl();
Seo Sanghyeon39a3ebf2009-01-15 04:51:39 +00004083 RecordDecl::field_iterator Field, FieldEnd;
Argyrios Kyrtzidiscfbfe782009-06-30 02:36:12 +00004084 for (Field = RD->field_begin(), FieldEnd = RD->field_end();
Seo Sanghyeon39a3ebf2009-01-15 04:51:39 +00004085 Field != FieldEnd; ++Field) {
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004086 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(Field->getType(),
Abramo Bagnara5d3e7242010-10-07 21:20:44 +00004087 castExpr->getType()) &&
4088 !Field->isUnnamedBitfield()) {
Seo Sanghyeon39a3ebf2009-01-15 04:51:39 +00004089 Diag(TyR.getBegin(), diag::ext_typecheck_cast_to_union)
4090 << castExpr->getSourceRange();
4091 break;
4092 }
4093 }
4094 if (Field == FieldEnd)
4095 return Diag(TyR.getBegin(), diag::err_typecheck_cast_to_union_no_type)
4096 << castExpr->getType() << castExpr->getSourceRange();
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004097 Kind = CK_ToUnion;
Anders Carlsson525b76b2009-10-16 02:48:28 +00004098 return false;
Argyrios Kyrtzidis2ade3902008-08-16 20:27:34 +00004099 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004100
Anders Carlsson525b76b2009-10-16 02:48:28 +00004101 // Reject any other conversions to non-scalar types.
4102 return Diag(TyR.getBegin(), diag::err_typecheck_cond_expect_scalar)
4103 << castType << castExpr->getSourceRange();
4104 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004105
4106 if (!castExpr->getType()->isScalarType() &&
Anders Carlsson525b76b2009-10-16 02:48:28 +00004107 !castExpr->getType()->isVectorType()) {
Chris Lattner3b054132008-11-19 05:08:23 +00004108 return Diag(castExpr->getLocStart(),
4109 diag::err_typecheck_expect_scalar_operand)
Chris Lattner1e5665e2008-11-24 06:25:27 +00004110 << castExpr->getType() << castExpr->getSourceRange();
Anders Carlsson525b76b2009-10-16 02:48:28 +00004111 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004112
4113 if (castType->isExtVectorType())
Anders Carlsson43d70f82009-10-16 05:23:41 +00004114 return CheckExtVectorCast(TyR, castType, castExpr, Kind);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004115
Anders Carlsson525b76b2009-10-16 02:48:28 +00004116 if (castType->isVectorType())
4117 return CheckVectorCast(TyR, castType, castExpr->getType(), Kind);
4118 if (castExpr->getType()->isVectorType())
4119 return CheckVectorCast(TyR, castExpr->getType(), castType, Kind);
4120
Anders Carlsson43d70f82009-10-16 05:23:41 +00004121 if (isa<ObjCSelectorExpr>(castExpr))
4122 return Diag(castExpr->getLocStart(), diag::err_cast_selector_expr);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004123
Anders Carlsson525b76b2009-10-16 02:48:28 +00004124 if (!castType->isArithmeticType()) {
Eli Friedmanf4e3ad62009-05-01 02:23:58 +00004125 QualType castExprType = castExpr->getType();
Douglas Gregor6972a622010-06-16 00:35:25 +00004126 if (!castExprType->isIntegralType(Context) &&
Douglas Gregorb90df602010-06-16 00:17:44 +00004127 castExprType->isArithmeticType())
Eli Friedmanf4e3ad62009-05-01 02:23:58 +00004128 return Diag(castExpr->getLocStart(),
4129 diag::err_cast_pointer_from_non_pointer_int)
4130 << castExprType << castExpr->getSourceRange();
4131 } else if (!castExpr->getType()->isArithmeticType()) {
Douglas Gregor6972a622010-06-16 00:35:25 +00004132 if (!castType->isIntegralType(Context) && castType->isArithmeticType())
Eli Friedmanf4e3ad62009-05-01 02:23:58 +00004133 return Diag(castExpr->getLocStart(),
4134 diag::err_cast_pointer_to_non_pointer_int)
4135 << castType << castExpr->getSourceRange();
Argyrios Kyrtzidis2ade3902008-08-16 20:27:34 +00004136 }
Anders Carlsson094c4592009-10-18 18:12:03 +00004137
John McCalle84af4e2010-11-13 01:35:44 +00004138 Kind = getScalarCastKind(Context, castExpr, castType);
John McCall2b5c1b22010-08-12 21:44:57 +00004139
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004140 if (Kind == CK_Unknown || Kind == CK_BitCast)
John McCall2b5c1b22010-08-12 21:44:57 +00004141 CheckCastAlign(castExpr, castType, TyR);
4142
Argyrios Kyrtzidis2ade3902008-08-16 20:27:34 +00004143 return false;
4144}
4145
Anders Carlsson525b76b2009-10-16 02:48:28 +00004146bool Sema::CheckVectorCast(SourceRange R, QualType VectorTy, QualType Ty,
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004147 CastKind &Kind) {
Anders Carlssonde71adf2007-11-27 05:51:55 +00004148 assert(VectorTy->isVectorType() && "Not a vector type!");
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004149
Anders Carlssonde71adf2007-11-27 05:51:55 +00004150 if (Ty->isVectorType() || Ty->isIntegerType()) {
Chris Lattner37e05872008-03-05 18:54:05 +00004151 if (Context.getTypeSize(VectorTy) != Context.getTypeSize(Ty))
Anders Carlssonde71adf2007-11-27 05:51:55 +00004152 return Diag(R.getBegin(),
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004153 Ty->isVectorType() ?
Anders Carlssonde71adf2007-11-27 05:51:55 +00004154 diag::err_invalid_conversion_between_vectors :
Chris Lattner3b054132008-11-19 05:08:23 +00004155 diag::err_invalid_conversion_between_vector_and_integer)
Chris Lattner1e5665e2008-11-24 06:25:27 +00004156 << VectorTy << Ty << R;
Anders Carlssonde71adf2007-11-27 05:51:55 +00004157 } else
4158 return Diag(R.getBegin(),
Chris Lattner3b054132008-11-19 05:08:23 +00004159 diag::err_invalid_conversion_between_vector_and_scalar)
Chris Lattner1e5665e2008-11-24 06:25:27 +00004160 << VectorTy << Ty << R;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004161
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004162 Kind = CK_BitCast;
Anders Carlssonde71adf2007-11-27 05:51:55 +00004163 return false;
4164}
4165
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004166bool Sema::CheckExtVectorCast(SourceRange R, QualType DestTy, Expr *&CastExpr,
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004167 CastKind &Kind) {
Nate Begemanc69b7402009-06-26 00:50:28 +00004168 assert(DestTy->isExtVectorType() && "Not an extended vector type!");
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004169
Anders Carlsson43d70f82009-10-16 05:23:41 +00004170 QualType SrcTy = CastExpr->getType();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004171
Nate Begemanc8961a42009-06-27 22:05:55 +00004172 // If SrcTy is a VectorType, the total size must match to explicitly cast to
4173 // an ExtVectorType.
Nate Begemanc69b7402009-06-26 00:50:28 +00004174 if (SrcTy->isVectorType()) {
4175 if (Context.getTypeSize(DestTy) != Context.getTypeSize(SrcTy))
4176 return Diag(R.getBegin(),diag::err_invalid_conversion_between_ext_vectors)
4177 << DestTy << SrcTy << R;
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004178 Kind = CK_BitCast;
Nate Begemanc69b7402009-06-26 00:50:28 +00004179 return false;
4180 }
4181
Nate Begemanbd956c42009-06-28 02:36:38 +00004182 // All non-pointer scalars can be cast to ExtVector type. The appropriate
Nate Begemanc69b7402009-06-26 00:50:28 +00004183 // conversion will take place first from scalar to elt type, and then
4184 // splat from elt type to vector.
Nate Begemanbd956c42009-06-28 02:36:38 +00004185 if (SrcTy->isPointerType())
4186 return Diag(R.getBegin(),
4187 diag::err_invalid_conversion_between_vector_and_scalar)
4188 << DestTy << SrcTy << R;
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004189
4190 QualType DestElemTy = DestTy->getAs<ExtVectorType>()->getElementType();
4191 ImpCastExprToType(CastExpr, DestElemTy,
John McCalle84af4e2010-11-13 01:35:44 +00004192 getScalarCastKind(Context, CastExpr, DestElemTy));
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004193
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004194 Kind = CK_VectorSplat;
Nate Begemanc69b7402009-06-26 00:50:28 +00004195 return false;
4196}
4197
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00004198ExprResult
John McCallba7bf592010-08-24 05:47:05 +00004199Sema::ActOnCastExpr(Scope *S, SourceLocation LParenLoc, ParsedType Ty,
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00004200 SourceLocation RParenLoc, Expr *castExpr) {
4201 assert((Ty != 0) && (castExpr != 0) &&
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00004202 "ActOnCastExpr(): missing type or expr");
Steve Naroff1a2cf6b2007-07-16 23:25:18 +00004203
John McCall97513962010-01-15 18:39:57 +00004204 TypeSourceInfo *castTInfo;
4205 QualType castType = GetTypeFromParser(Ty, &castTInfo);
4206 if (!castTInfo)
John McCalle15bbff2010-01-18 19:35:47 +00004207 castTInfo = Context.getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(castType);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004208
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004209 // If the Expr being casted is a ParenListExpr, handle it specially.
4210 if (isa<ParenListExpr>(castExpr))
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00004211 return ActOnCastOfParenListExpr(S, LParenLoc, RParenLoc, castExpr,
John McCalle15bbff2010-01-18 19:35:47 +00004212 castTInfo);
John McCallebe54742010-01-15 18:56:44 +00004213
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00004214 return BuildCStyleCastExpr(LParenLoc, castTInfo, RParenLoc, castExpr);
John McCallebe54742010-01-15 18:56:44 +00004215}
4216
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00004217ExprResult
John McCallebe54742010-01-15 18:56:44 +00004218Sema::BuildCStyleCastExpr(SourceLocation LParenLoc, TypeSourceInfo *Ty,
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00004219 SourceLocation RParenLoc, Expr *castExpr) {
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004220 CastKind Kind = CK_Unknown;
John McCallcf142162010-08-07 06:22:56 +00004221 CXXCastPath BasePath;
John McCallebe54742010-01-15 18:56:44 +00004222 if (CheckCastTypes(SourceRange(LParenLoc, RParenLoc), Ty->getType(), castExpr,
Anders Carlssona70cff62010-04-24 19:06:50 +00004223 Kind, BasePath))
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00004224 return ExprError();
Anders Carlssone9766d52009-09-09 21:33:21 +00004225
John McCallcf142162010-08-07 06:22:56 +00004226 return Owned(CStyleCastExpr::Create(Context,
Douglas Gregora8a089b2010-07-13 18:40:04 +00004227 Ty->getType().getNonLValueExprType(Context),
John McCallcf142162010-08-07 06:22:56 +00004228 Kind, castExpr, &BasePath, Ty,
4229 LParenLoc, RParenLoc));
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00004230}
4231
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004232/// This is not an AltiVec-style cast, so turn the ParenListExpr into a sequence
4233/// of comma binary operators.
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00004234ExprResult
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00004235Sema::MaybeConvertParenListExprToParenExpr(Scope *S, Expr *expr) {
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004236 ParenListExpr *E = dyn_cast<ParenListExpr>(expr);
4237 if (!E)
4238 return Owned(expr);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004239
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00004240 ExprResult Result(E->getExpr(0));
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004241
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004242 for (unsigned i = 1, e = E->getNumExprs(); i != e && !Result.isInvalid(); ++i)
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00004243 Result = ActOnBinOp(S, E->getExprLoc(), tok::comma, Result.get(),
4244 E->getExpr(i));
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004245
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00004246 if (Result.isInvalid()) return ExprError();
4247
4248 return ActOnParenExpr(E->getLParenLoc(), E->getRParenLoc(), Result.get());
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004249}
4250
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00004251ExprResult
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004252Sema::ActOnCastOfParenListExpr(Scope *S, SourceLocation LParenLoc,
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00004253 SourceLocation RParenLoc, Expr *Op,
John McCalle15bbff2010-01-18 19:35:47 +00004254 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo) {
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00004255 ParenListExpr *PE = cast<ParenListExpr>(Op);
John McCalle15bbff2010-01-18 19:35:47 +00004256 QualType Ty = TInfo->getType();
John Thompson781ad172010-06-30 22:55:51 +00004257 bool isAltiVecLiteral = false;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004258
John Thompson781ad172010-06-30 22:55:51 +00004259 // Check for an altivec literal,
4260 // i.e. all the elements are integer constants.
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004261 if (getLangOptions().AltiVec && Ty->isVectorType()) {
4262 if (PE->getNumExprs() == 0) {
4263 Diag(PE->getExprLoc(), diag::err_altivec_empty_initializer);
4264 return ExprError();
4265 }
John Thompson781ad172010-06-30 22:55:51 +00004266 if (PE->getNumExprs() == 1) {
4267 if (!PE->getExpr(0)->getType()->isVectorType())
4268 isAltiVecLiteral = true;
4269 }
4270 else
4271 isAltiVecLiteral = true;
4272 }
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004273
John Thompson781ad172010-06-30 22:55:51 +00004274 // If this is an altivec initializer, '(' type ')' '(' init, ..., init ')'
4275 // then handle it as such.
4276 if (isAltiVecLiteral) {
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004277 llvm::SmallVector<Expr *, 8> initExprs;
4278 for (unsigned i = 0, e = PE->getNumExprs(); i != e; ++i)
4279 initExprs.push_back(PE->getExpr(i));
4280
4281 // FIXME: This means that pretty-printing the final AST will produce curly
4282 // braces instead of the original commas.
Ted Kremenekac034612010-04-13 23:39:13 +00004283 InitListExpr *E = new (Context) InitListExpr(Context, LParenLoc,
4284 &initExprs[0],
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004285 initExprs.size(), RParenLoc);
4286 E->setType(Ty);
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00004287 return BuildCompoundLiteralExpr(LParenLoc, TInfo, RParenLoc, E);
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004288 } else {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004289 // This is not an AltiVec-style cast, so turn the ParenListExpr into a
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004290 // sequence of BinOp comma operators.
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00004291 ExprResult Result = MaybeConvertParenListExprToParenExpr(S, Op);
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00004292 if (Result.isInvalid()) return ExprError();
4293 return BuildCStyleCastExpr(LParenLoc, TInfo, RParenLoc, Result.take());
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004294 }
4295}
4296
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00004297ExprResult Sema::ActOnParenOrParenListExpr(SourceLocation L,
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004298 SourceLocation R,
Fariborz Jahanian906d8712009-11-25 01:26:41 +00004299 MultiExprArg Val,
John McCallba7bf592010-08-24 05:47:05 +00004300 ParsedType TypeOfCast) {
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004301 unsigned nexprs = Val.size();
4302 Expr **exprs = reinterpret_cast<Expr**>(Val.release());
Fariborz Jahanian906d8712009-11-25 01:26:41 +00004303 assert((exprs != 0) && "ActOnParenOrParenListExpr() missing expr list");
4304 Expr *expr;
4305 if (nexprs == 1 && TypeOfCast && !TypeIsVectorType(TypeOfCast))
4306 expr = new (Context) ParenExpr(L, R, exprs[0]);
4307 else
4308 expr = new (Context) ParenListExpr(Context, L, exprs, nexprs, R);
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004309 return Owned(expr);
4310}
4311
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00004312/// Note that lhs is not null here, even if this is the gnu "x ?: y" extension.
4313/// In that case, lhs = cond.
Chris Lattner2c486602009-02-18 04:38:20 +00004314/// C99 6.5.15
4315QualType Sema::CheckConditionalOperands(Expr *&Cond, Expr *&LHS, Expr *&RHS,
Fariborz Jahanian2b1d88a2010-09-18 19:38:38 +00004316 Expr *&SAVE,
Chris Lattner2c486602009-02-18 04:38:20 +00004317 SourceLocation QuestionLoc) {
Douglas Gregor0124e9b2010-11-09 21:07:58 +00004318 // If both LHS and RHS are overloaded functions, try to resolve them.
4319 if (Context.hasSameType(LHS->getType(), RHS->getType()) &&
4320 LHS->getType()->isSpecificBuiltinType(BuiltinType::Overload)) {
4321 ExprResult LHSResult = CheckPlaceholderExpr(LHS, QuestionLoc);
4322 if (LHSResult.isInvalid())
4323 return QualType();
4324
4325 ExprResult RHSResult = CheckPlaceholderExpr(RHS, QuestionLoc);
4326 if (RHSResult.isInvalid())
4327 return QualType();
4328
4329 LHS = LHSResult.take();
4330 RHS = RHSResult.take();
4331 }
4332
Sebastian Redl1a99f442009-04-16 17:51:27 +00004333 // C++ is sufficiently different to merit its own checker.
4334 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus)
Fariborz Jahanian2b1d88a2010-09-18 19:38:38 +00004335 return CXXCheckConditionalOperands(Cond, LHS, RHS, SAVE, QuestionLoc);
Sebastian Redl1a99f442009-04-16 17:51:27 +00004336
Chris Lattner432cff52009-02-18 04:28:32 +00004337 UsualUnaryConversions(Cond);
Fariborz Jahanian2b1d88a2010-09-18 19:38:38 +00004338 if (SAVE) {
4339 SAVE = LHS = Cond;
4340 }
4341 else
4342 UsualUnaryConversions(LHS);
Chris Lattner432cff52009-02-18 04:28:32 +00004343 UsualUnaryConversions(RHS);
4344 QualType CondTy = Cond->getType();
4345 QualType LHSTy = LHS->getType();
4346 QualType RHSTy = RHS->getType();
Steve Naroff31090012007-07-16 21:54:35 +00004347
Steve Naroffa78fe7e2007-05-16 19:47:19 +00004348 // first, check the condition.
Sebastian Redl1a99f442009-04-16 17:51:27 +00004349 if (!CondTy->isScalarType()) { // C99 6.5.15p2
Nate Begemanabb5a732010-09-20 22:41:17 +00004350 // OpenCL: Sec 6.3.i says the condition is allowed to be a vector or scalar.
4351 // Throw an error if its not either.
4352 if (getLangOptions().OpenCL) {
4353 if (!CondTy->isVectorType()) {
4354 Diag(Cond->getLocStart(),
4355 diag::err_typecheck_cond_expect_scalar_or_vector)
4356 << CondTy;
4357 return QualType();
4358 }
4359 }
4360 else {
4361 Diag(Cond->getLocStart(), diag::err_typecheck_cond_expect_scalar)
4362 << CondTy;
4363 return QualType();
4364 }
Steve Naroffa78fe7e2007-05-16 19:47:19 +00004365 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004366
Chris Lattnere2949f42008-01-06 22:42:25 +00004367 // Now check the two expressions.
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004368 if (LHSTy->isVectorType() || RHSTy->isVectorType())
4369 return CheckVectorOperands(QuestionLoc, LHS, RHS);
Douglas Gregor4619e432008-12-05 23:32:09 +00004370
Nate Begemanabb5a732010-09-20 22:41:17 +00004371 // OpenCL: If the condition is a vector, and both operands are scalar,
4372 // attempt to implicity convert them to the vector type to act like the
4373 // built in select.
4374 if (getLangOptions().OpenCL && CondTy->isVectorType()) {
4375 // Both operands should be of scalar type.
4376 if (!LHSTy->isScalarType()) {
4377 Diag(LHS->getLocStart(), diag::err_typecheck_cond_expect_scalar)
4378 << CondTy;
4379 return QualType();
4380 }
4381 if (!RHSTy->isScalarType()) {
4382 Diag(RHS->getLocStart(), diag::err_typecheck_cond_expect_scalar)
4383 << CondTy;
4384 return QualType();
4385 }
4386 // Implicity convert these scalars to the type of the condition.
4387 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, CondTy, CK_IntegralCast);
4388 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, CondTy, CK_IntegralCast);
4389 }
4390
Chris Lattnere2949f42008-01-06 22:42:25 +00004391 // If both operands have arithmetic type, do the usual arithmetic conversions
4392 // to find a common type: C99 6.5.15p3,5.
Chris Lattner432cff52009-02-18 04:28:32 +00004393 if (LHSTy->isArithmeticType() && RHSTy->isArithmeticType()) {
4394 UsualArithmeticConversions(LHS, RHS);
4395 return LHS->getType();
Steve Naroffdbd9e892007-07-17 00:58:39 +00004396 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004397
Chris Lattnere2949f42008-01-06 22:42:25 +00004398 // If both operands are the same structure or union type, the result is that
4399 // type.
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004400 if (const RecordType *LHSRT = LHSTy->getAs<RecordType>()) { // C99 6.5.15p3
4401 if (const RecordType *RHSRT = RHSTy->getAs<RecordType>())
Chris Lattner2ab40a62007-11-26 01:40:58 +00004402 if (LHSRT->getDecl() == RHSRT->getDecl())
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004403 // "If both the operands have structure or union type, the result has
Chris Lattnere2949f42008-01-06 22:42:25 +00004404 // that type." This implies that CV qualifiers are dropped.
Chris Lattner432cff52009-02-18 04:28:32 +00004405 return LHSTy.getUnqualifiedType();
Eli Friedmanba961a92009-03-23 00:24:07 +00004406 // FIXME: Type of conditional expression must be complete in C mode.
Steve Naroffa78fe7e2007-05-16 19:47:19 +00004407 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004408
Chris Lattnere2949f42008-01-06 22:42:25 +00004409 // C99 6.5.15p5: "If both operands have void type, the result has void type."
Steve Naroffbf1516c2008-05-12 21:44:38 +00004410 // The following || allows only one side to be void (a GCC-ism).
Chris Lattner432cff52009-02-18 04:28:32 +00004411 if (LHSTy->isVoidType() || RHSTy->isVoidType()) {
4412 if (!LHSTy->isVoidType())
4413 Diag(RHS->getLocStart(), diag::ext_typecheck_cond_one_void)
4414 << RHS->getSourceRange();
4415 if (!RHSTy->isVoidType())
4416 Diag(LHS->getLocStart(), diag::ext_typecheck_cond_one_void)
4417 << LHS->getSourceRange();
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004418 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, Context.VoidTy, CK_ToVoid);
4419 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, Context.VoidTy, CK_ToVoid);
Eli Friedman3e1852f2008-06-04 19:47:51 +00004420 return Context.VoidTy;
Steve Naroffbf1516c2008-05-12 21:44:38 +00004421 }
Steve Naroff039ad3c2008-01-08 01:11:38 +00004422 // C99 6.5.15p6 - "if one operand is a null pointer constant, the result has
4423 // the type of the other operand."
Steve Naroff6b712a72009-07-14 18:25:06 +00004424 if ((LHSTy->isAnyPointerType() || LHSTy->isBlockPointerType()) &&
Douglas Gregor56751b52009-09-25 04:25:58 +00004425 RHS->isNullPointerConstant(Context, Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull)) {
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004426 // promote the null to a pointer.
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004427 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, LHSTy, CK_Unknown);
Chris Lattner432cff52009-02-18 04:28:32 +00004428 return LHSTy;
Steve Naroff039ad3c2008-01-08 01:11:38 +00004429 }
Steve Naroff6b712a72009-07-14 18:25:06 +00004430 if ((RHSTy->isAnyPointerType() || RHSTy->isBlockPointerType()) &&
Douglas Gregor56751b52009-09-25 04:25:58 +00004431 LHS->isNullPointerConstant(Context, Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull)) {
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004432 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, RHSTy, CK_Unknown);
Chris Lattner432cff52009-02-18 04:28:32 +00004433 return RHSTy;
Steve Naroff039ad3c2008-01-08 01:11:38 +00004434 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004435
Fariborz Jahaniana430f712009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004436 // All objective-c pointer type analysis is done here.
4437 QualType compositeType = FindCompositeObjCPointerType(LHS, RHS,
4438 QuestionLoc);
4439 if (!compositeType.isNull())
4440 return compositeType;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004441
4442
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004443 // Handle block pointer types.
4444 if (LHSTy->isBlockPointerType() || RHSTy->isBlockPointerType()) {
4445 if (!LHSTy->isBlockPointerType() || !RHSTy->isBlockPointerType()) {
4446 if (LHSTy->isVoidPointerType() || RHSTy->isVoidPointerType()) {
4447 QualType destType = Context.getPointerType(Context.VoidTy);
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004448 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, destType, CK_BitCast);
4449 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, destType, CK_BitCast);
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004450 return destType;
4451 }
4452 Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::err_typecheck_cond_incompatible_operands)
Fariborz Jahaniana430f712009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004453 << LHSTy << RHSTy << LHS->getSourceRange() << RHS->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004454 return QualType();
Mike Stump1b821b42009-05-07 03:14:14 +00004455 }
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004456 // We have 2 block pointer types.
4457 if (Context.getCanonicalType(LHSTy) == Context.getCanonicalType(RHSTy)) {
4458 // Two identical block pointer types are always compatible.
Mike Stump1b821b42009-05-07 03:14:14 +00004459 return LHSTy;
4460 }
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004461 // The block pointer types aren't identical, continue checking.
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004462 QualType lhptee = LHSTy->getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4463 QualType rhptee = RHSTy->getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004464
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004465 if (!Context.typesAreCompatible(lhptee.getUnqualifiedType(),
4466 rhptee.getUnqualifiedType())) {
Mike Stump1b821b42009-05-07 03:14:14 +00004467 Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::warn_typecheck_cond_incompatible_pointers)
Fariborz Jahaniana430f712009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004468 << LHSTy << RHSTy << LHS->getSourceRange() << RHS->getSourceRange();
Mike Stump1b821b42009-05-07 03:14:14 +00004469 // In this situation, we assume void* type. No especially good
4470 // reason, but this is what gcc does, and we do have to pick
4471 // to get a consistent AST.
4472 QualType incompatTy = Context.getPointerType(Context.VoidTy);
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004473 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, incompatTy, CK_BitCast);
4474 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, incompatTy, CK_BitCast);
Mike Stump1b821b42009-05-07 03:14:14 +00004475 return incompatTy;
Steve Naroffa78fe7e2007-05-16 19:47:19 +00004476 }
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004477 // The block pointer types are compatible.
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004478 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, LHSTy, CK_BitCast);
4479 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, LHSTy, CK_BitCast);
Steve Naroffea4c7802009-04-08 17:05:15 +00004480 return LHSTy;
4481 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004482
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004483 // Check constraints for C object pointers types (C99 6.5.15p3,6).
4484 if (LHSTy->isPointerType() && RHSTy->isPointerType()) {
4485 // get the "pointed to" types
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004486 QualType lhptee = LHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4487 QualType rhptee = RHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004488
4489 // ignore qualifiers on void (C99 6.5.15p3, clause 6)
4490 if (lhptee->isVoidType() && rhptee->isIncompleteOrObjectType()) {
4491 // Figure out necessary qualifiers (C99 6.5.15p6)
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00004492 QualType destPointee
4493 = Context.getQualifiedType(lhptee, rhptee.getQualifiers());
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004494 QualType destType = Context.getPointerType(destPointee);
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004495 // Add qualifiers if necessary.
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004496 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, destType, CK_NoOp);
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004497 // Promote to void*.
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004498 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, destType, CK_BitCast);
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004499 return destType;
4500 }
4501 if (rhptee->isVoidType() && lhptee->isIncompleteOrObjectType()) {
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00004502 QualType destPointee
4503 = Context.getQualifiedType(rhptee, lhptee.getQualifiers());
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004504 QualType destType = Context.getPointerType(destPointee);
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004505 // Add qualifiers if necessary.
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004506 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, destType, CK_NoOp);
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004507 // Promote to void*.
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004508 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, destType, CK_BitCast);
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004509 return destType;
4510 }
4511
4512 if (Context.getCanonicalType(LHSTy) == Context.getCanonicalType(RHSTy)) {
4513 // Two identical pointer types are always compatible.
4514 return LHSTy;
4515 }
4516 if (!Context.typesAreCompatible(lhptee.getUnqualifiedType(),
4517 rhptee.getUnqualifiedType())) {
4518 Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::warn_typecheck_cond_incompatible_pointers)
4519 << LHSTy << RHSTy << LHS->getSourceRange() << RHS->getSourceRange();
4520 // In this situation, we assume void* type. No especially good
4521 // reason, but this is what gcc does, and we do have to pick
4522 // to get a consistent AST.
4523 QualType incompatTy = Context.getPointerType(Context.VoidTy);
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004524 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, incompatTy, CK_BitCast);
4525 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, incompatTy, CK_BitCast);
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004526 return incompatTy;
4527 }
4528 // The pointer types are compatible.
4529 // C99 6.5.15p6: If both operands are pointers to compatible types *or* to
4530 // differently qualified versions of compatible types, the result type is
4531 // a pointer to an appropriately qualified version of the *composite*
4532 // type.
4533 // FIXME: Need to calculate the composite type.
4534 // FIXME: Need to add qualifiers
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004535 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, LHSTy, CK_BitCast);
4536 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, LHSTy, CK_BitCast);
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004537 return LHSTy;
4538 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004539
John McCalle84af4e2010-11-13 01:35:44 +00004540 // GCC compatibility: soften pointer/integer mismatch. Note that
4541 // null pointers have been filtered out by this point.
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004542 if (RHSTy->isPointerType() && LHSTy->isIntegerType()) {
4543 Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::warn_typecheck_cond_pointer_integer_mismatch)
4544 << LHSTy << RHSTy << LHS->getSourceRange() << RHS->getSourceRange();
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004545 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, RHSTy, CK_IntegralToPointer);
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004546 return RHSTy;
4547 }
4548 if (LHSTy->isPointerType() && RHSTy->isIntegerType()) {
4549 Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::warn_typecheck_cond_pointer_integer_mismatch)
4550 << LHSTy << RHSTy << LHS->getSourceRange() << RHS->getSourceRange();
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004551 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, LHSTy, CK_IntegralToPointer);
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004552 return LHSTy;
4553 }
Daniel Dunbar484603b2008-09-11 23:12:46 +00004554
Chris Lattnere2949f42008-01-06 22:42:25 +00004555 // Otherwise, the operands are not compatible.
Chris Lattner432cff52009-02-18 04:28:32 +00004556 Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::err_typecheck_cond_incompatible_operands)
4557 << LHSTy << RHSTy << LHS->getSourceRange() << RHS->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroffa78fe7e2007-05-16 19:47:19 +00004558 return QualType();
Steve Narofff8a28c52007-05-15 20:29:32 +00004559}
4560
Fariborz Jahaniana430f712009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004561/// FindCompositeObjCPointerType - Helper method to find composite type of
4562/// two objective-c pointer types of the two input expressions.
4563QualType Sema::FindCompositeObjCPointerType(Expr *&LHS, Expr *&RHS,
4564 SourceLocation QuestionLoc) {
4565 QualType LHSTy = LHS->getType();
4566 QualType RHSTy = RHS->getType();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004567
Fariborz Jahaniana430f712009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004568 // Handle things like Class and struct objc_class*. Here we case the result
4569 // to the pseudo-builtin, because that will be implicitly cast back to the
4570 // redefinition type if an attempt is made to access its fields.
4571 if (LHSTy->isObjCClassType() &&
4572 (RHSTy.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCClassRedefinitionType)) {
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004573 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, LHSTy, CK_BitCast);
Fariborz Jahaniana430f712009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004574 return LHSTy;
4575 }
4576 if (RHSTy->isObjCClassType() &&
4577 (LHSTy.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCClassRedefinitionType)) {
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004578 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, RHSTy, CK_BitCast);
Fariborz Jahaniana430f712009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004579 return RHSTy;
4580 }
4581 // And the same for struct objc_object* / id
4582 if (LHSTy->isObjCIdType() &&
4583 (RHSTy.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCIdRedefinitionType)) {
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004584 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, LHSTy, CK_BitCast);
Fariborz Jahaniana430f712009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004585 return LHSTy;
4586 }
4587 if (RHSTy->isObjCIdType() &&
4588 (LHSTy.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCIdRedefinitionType)) {
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004589 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, RHSTy, CK_BitCast);
Fariborz Jahaniana430f712009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004590 return RHSTy;
4591 }
4592 // And the same for struct objc_selector* / SEL
4593 if (Context.isObjCSelType(LHSTy) &&
4594 (RHSTy.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCSelRedefinitionType)) {
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004595 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, LHSTy, CK_BitCast);
Fariborz Jahaniana430f712009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004596 return LHSTy;
4597 }
4598 if (Context.isObjCSelType(RHSTy) &&
4599 (LHSTy.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCSelRedefinitionType)) {
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004600 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, RHSTy, CK_BitCast);
Fariborz Jahaniana430f712009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004601 return RHSTy;
4602 }
4603 // Check constraints for Objective-C object pointers types.
4604 if (LHSTy->isObjCObjectPointerType() && RHSTy->isObjCObjectPointerType()) {
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004605
Fariborz Jahaniana430f712009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004606 if (Context.getCanonicalType(LHSTy) == Context.getCanonicalType(RHSTy)) {
4607 // Two identical object pointer types are always compatible.
4608 return LHSTy;
4609 }
4610 const ObjCObjectPointerType *LHSOPT = LHSTy->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
4611 const ObjCObjectPointerType *RHSOPT = RHSTy->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
4612 QualType compositeType = LHSTy;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004613
Fariborz Jahaniana430f712009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004614 // If both operands are interfaces and either operand can be
4615 // assigned to the other, use that type as the composite
4616 // type. This allows
4617 // xxx ? (A*) a : (B*) b
4618 // where B is a subclass of A.
4619 //
4620 // Additionally, as for assignment, if either type is 'id'
4621 // allow silent coercion. Finally, if the types are
4622 // incompatible then make sure to use 'id' as the composite
4623 // type so the result is acceptable for sending messages to.
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004624
Fariborz Jahaniana430f712009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004625 // FIXME: Consider unifying with 'areComparableObjCPointerTypes'.
4626 // It could return the composite type.
4627 if (Context.canAssignObjCInterfaces(LHSOPT, RHSOPT)) {
4628 compositeType = RHSOPT->isObjCBuiltinType() ? RHSTy : LHSTy;
4629 } else if (Context.canAssignObjCInterfaces(RHSOPT, LHSOPT)) {
4630 compositeType = LHSOPT->isObjCBuiltinType() ? LHSTy : RHSTy;
4631 } else if ((LHSTy->isObjCQualifiedIdType() ||
4632 RHSTy->isObjCQualifiedIdType()) &&
4633 Context.ObjCQualifiedIdTypesAreCompatible(LHSTy, RHSTy, true)) {
4634 // Need to handle "id<xx>" explicitly.
4635 // GCC allows qualified id and any Objective-C type to devolve to
4636 // id. Currently localizing to here until clear this should be
4637 // part of ObjCQualifiedIdTypesAreCompatible.
4638 compositeType = Context.getObjCIdType();
4639 } else if (LHSTy->isObjCIdType() || RHSTy->isObjCIdType()) {
4640 compositeType = Context.getObjCIdType();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004641 } else if (!(compositeType =
Fariborz Jahaniana430f712009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004642 Context.areCommonBaseCompatible(LHSOPT, RHSOPT)).isNull())
4643 ;
4644 else {
4645 Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::ext_typecheck_cond_incompatible_operands)
4646 << LHSTy << RHSTy
4647 << LHS->getSourceRange() << RHS->getSourceRange();
4648 QualType incompatTy = Context.getObjCIdType();
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004649 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, incompatTy, CK_BitCast);
4650 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, incompatTy, CK_BitCast);
Fariborz Jahaniana430f712009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004651 return incompatTy;
4652 }
4653 // The object pointer types are compatible.
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004654 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, compositeType, CK_BitCast);
4655 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, compositeType, CK_BitCast);
Fariborz Jahaniana430f712009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004656 return compositeType;
4657 }
4658 // Check Objective-C object pointer types and 'void *'
4659 if (LHSTy->isVoidPointerType() && RHSTy->isObjCObjectPointerType()) {
4660 QualType lhptee = LHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4661 QualType rhptee = RHSTy->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4662 QualType destPointee
4663 = Context.getQualifiedType(lhptee, rhptee.getQualifiers());
4664 QualType destType = Context.getPointerType(destPointee);
4665 // Add qualifiers if necessary.
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004666 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, destType, CK_NoOp);
Fariborz Jahaniana430f712009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004667 // Promote to void*.
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004668 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, destType, CK_BitCast);
Fariborz Jahaniana430f712009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004669 return destType;
4670 }
4671 if (LHSTy->isObjCObjectPointerType() && RHSTy->isVoidPointerType()) {
4672 QualType lhptee = LHSTy->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4673 QualType rhptee = RHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4674 QualType destPointee
4675 = Context.getQualifiedType(rhptee, lhptee.getQualifiers());
4676 QualType destType = Context.getPointerType(destPointee);
4677 // Add qualifiers if necessary.
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004678 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, destType, CK_NoOp);
Fariborz Jahaniana430f712009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004679 // Promote to void*.
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004680 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, destType, CK_BitCast);
Fariborz Jahaniana430f712009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004681 return destType;
4682 }
4683 return QualType();
4684}
4685
Steve Naroff83895f72007-09-16 03:34:24 +00004686/// ActOnConditionalOp - Parse a ?: operation. Note that 'LHS' may be null
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00004687/// in the case of a the GNU conditional expr extension.
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00004688ExprResult Sema::ActOnConditionalOp(SourceLocation QuestionLoc,
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00004689 SourceLocation ColonLoc,
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00004690 Expr *CondExpr, Expr *LHSExpr,
4691 Expr *RHSExpr) {
Chris Lattner2ab40a62007-11-26 01:40:58 +00004692 // If this is the gnu "x ?: y" extension, analyze the types as though the LHS
4693 // was the condition.
4694 bool isLHSNull = LHSExpr == 0;
Fariborz Jahanianc6bf0bd2010-08-31 18:02:20 +00004695 Expr *SAVEExpr = 0;
4696 if (isLHSNull) {
4697 LHSExpr = SAVEExpr = CondExpr;
4698 }
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00004699
Fariborz Jahanian2b1d88a2010-09-18 19:38:38 +00004700 QualType result = CheckConditionalOperands(CondExpr, LHSExpr, RHSExpr,
4701 SAVEExpr, QuestionLoc);
Steve Narofff8a28c52007-05-15 20:29:32 +00004702 if (result.isNull())
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00004703 return ExprError();
4704
Douglas Gregor7e112b02009-08-26 14:37:04 +00004705 return Owned(new (Context) ConditionalOperator(CondExpr, QuestionLoc,
Fariborz Jahanianc6bf0bd2010-08-31 18:02:20 +00004706 LHSExpr, ColonLoc,
4707 RHSExpr, SAVEExpr,
4708 result));
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00004709}
4710
Steve Naroff3f597292007-05-11 22:18:03 +00004711// CheckPointerTypesForAssignment - This is a very tricky routine (despite
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004712// being closely modeled after the C99 spec:-). The odd characteristic of this
Steve Naroff3f597292007-05-11 22:18:03 +00004713// routine is it effectively iqnores the qualifiers on the top level pointee.
4714// This circumvents the usual type rules specified in 6.2.7p1 & 6.7.5.[1-3].
4715// FIXME: add a couple examples in this comment.
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004716Sema::AssignConvertType
Steve Naroff98cf3e92007-06-06 18:38:38 +00004717Sema::CheckPointerTypesForAssignment(QualType lhsType, QualType rhsType) {
Steve Naroff3f597292007-05-11 22:18:03 +00004718 QualType lhptee, rhptee;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004719
David Chisnall9f57c292009-08-17 16:35:33 +00004720 if ((lhsType->isObjCClassType() &&
4721 (rhsType.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCClassRedefinitionType)) ||
4722 (rhsType->isObjCClassType() &&
4723 (lhsType.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCClassRedefinitionType))) {
4724 return Compatible;
4725 }
4726
Steve Naroff1f4d7272007-05-11 04:00:31 +00004727 // get the "pointed to" type (ignoring qualifiers at the top level)
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004728 lhptee = lhsType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4729 rhptee = rhsType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004730
Steve Naroff1f4d7272007-05-11 04:00:31 +00004731 // make sure we operate on the canonical type
Chris Lattner574dee62008-07-26 22:17:49 +00004732 lhptee = Context.getCanonicalType(lhptee);
4733 rhptee = Context.getCanonicalType(rhptee);
Steve Naroff1f4d7272007-05-11 04:00:31 +00004734
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00004735 AssignConvertType ConvTy = Compatible;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004736
4737 // C99 6.5.16.1p1: This following citation is common to constraints
4738 // 3 & 4 (below). ...and the type *pointed to* by the left has all the
4739 // qualifiers of the type *pointed to* by the right;
Fariborz Jahanianece85822009-02-17 18:27:45 +00004740 // FIXME: Handle ExtQualType
Douglas Gregor9a657932008-10-21 23:43:52 +00004741 if (!lhptee.isAtLeastAsQualifiedAs(rhptee))
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00004742 ConvTy = CompatiblePointerDiscardsQualifiers;
Steve Naroff3f597292007-05-11 22:18:03 +00004743
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004744 // C99 6.5.16.1p1 (constraint 4): If one operand is a pointer to an object or
4745 // incomplete type and the other is a pointer to a qualified or unqualified
Steve Naroff3f597292007-05-11 22:18:03 +00004746 // version of void...
Chris Lattner0a788432008-01-03 22:56:36 +00004747 if (lhptee->isVoidType()) {
Chris Lattnerb3a176d2008-04-02 06:59:01 +00004748 if (rhptee->isIncompleteOrObjectType())
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00004749 return ConvTy;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004750
Chris Lattner0a788432008-01-03 22:56:36 +00004751 // As an extension, we allow cast to/from void* to function pointer.
Chris Lattnerb3a176d2008-04-02 06:59:01 +00004752 assert(rhptee->isFunctionType());
4753 return FunctionVoidPointer;
Chris Lattner0a788432008-01-03 22:56:36 +00004754 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004755
Chris Lattner0a788432008-01-03 22:56:36 +00004756 if (rhptee->isVoidType()) {
Chris Lattnerb3a176d2008-04-02 06:59:01 +00004757 if (lhptee->isIncompleteOrObjectType())
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00004758 return ConvTy;
Chris Lattner0a788432008-01-03 22:56:36 +00004759
4760 // As an extension, we allow cast to/from void* to function pointer.
Chris Lattnerb3a176d2008-04-02 06:59:01 +00004761 assert(lhptee->isFunctionType());
4762 return FunctionVoidPointer;
Chris Lattner0a788432008-01-03 22:56:36 +00004763 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004764 // C99 6.5.16.1p1 (constraint 3): both operands are pointers to qualified or
Steve Naroff3f597292007-05-11 22:18:03 +00004765 // unqualified versions of compatible types, ...
Eli Friedman80160bd2009-03-22 23:59:44 +00004766 lhptee = lhptee.getUnqualifiedType();
4767 rhptee = rhptee.getUnqualifiedType();
4768 if (!Context.typesAreCompatible(lhptee, rhptee)) {
4769 // Check if the pointee types are compatible ignoring the sign.
4770 // We explicitly check for char so that we catch "char" vs
4771 // "unsigned char" on systems where "char" is unsigned.
Chris Lattnerec3a1562009-10-17 20:33:28 +00004772 if (lhptee->isCharType())
Eli Friedman80160bd2009-03-22 23:59:44 +00004773 lhptee = Context.UnsignedCharTy;
Douglas Gregor5cc2c8b2010-07-23 15:58:24 +00004774 else if (lhptee->hasSignedIntegerRepresentation())
Eli Friedman80160bd2009-03-22 23:59:44 +00004775 lhptee = Context.getCorrespondingUnsignedType(lhptee);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004776
Chris Lattnerec3a1562009-10-17 20:33:28 +00004777 if (rhptee->isCharType())
Eli Friedman80160bd2009-03-22 23:59:44 +00004778 rhptee = Context.UnsignedCharTy;
Douglas Gregor5cc2c8b2010-07-23 15:58:24 +00004779 else if (rhptee->hasSignedIntegerRepresentation())
Eli Friedman80160bd2009-03-22 23:59:44 +00004780 rhptee = Context.getCorrespondingUnsignedType(rhptee);
Chris Lattnerec3a1562009-10-17 20:33:28 +00004781
Eli Friedman80160bd2009-03-22 23:59:44 +00004782 if (lhptee == rhptee) {
4783 // Types are compatible ignoring the sign. Qualifier incompatibility
4784 // takes priority over sign incompatibility because the sign
4785 // warning can be disabled.
4786 if (ConvTy != Compatible)
4787 return ConvTy;
4788 return IncompatiblePointerSign;
4789 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004790
Fariborz Jahaniand7aa9d82009-11-07 20:20:40 +00004791 // If we are a multi-level pointer, it's possible that our issue is simply
4792 // one of qualification - e.g. char ** -> const char ** is not allowed. If
4793 // the eventual target type is the same and the pointers have the same
4794 // level of indirection, this must be the issue.
4795 if (lhptee->isPointerType() && rhptee->isPointerType()) {
4796 do {
4797 lhptee = lhptee->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4798 rhptee = rhptee->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004799
Fariborz Jahaniand7aa9d82009-11-07 20:20:40 +00004800 lhptee = Context.getCanonicalType(lhptee);
4801 rhptee = Context.getCanonicalType(rhptee);
4802 } while (lhptee->isPointerType() && rhptee->isPointerType());
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004803
Douglas Gregor1b8fe5b72009-11-16 21:35:15 +00004804 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(lhptee, rhptee))
Alexis Hunt6f3de502009-11-08 07:46:34 +00004805 return IncompatibleNestedPointerQualifiers;
Fariborz Jahaniand7aa9d82009-11-07 20:20:40 +00004806 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004807
Eli Friedman80160bd2009-03-22 23:59:44 +00004808 // General pointer incompatibility takes priority over qualifiers.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004809 return IncompatiblePointer;
Eli Friedman80160bd2009-03-22 23:59:44 +00004810 }
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00004811 return ConvTy;
Steve Naroff1f4d7272007-05-11 04:00:31 +00004812}
4813
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004814/// CheckBlockPointerTypesForAssignment - This routine determines whether two
4815/// block pointer types are compatible or whether a block and normal pointer
4816/// are compatible. It is more restrict than comparing two function pointer
4817// types.
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004818Sema::AssignConvertType
4819Sema::CheckBlockPointerTypesForAssignment(QualType lhsType,
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004820 QualType rhsType) {
4821 QualType lhptee, rhptee;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004822
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004823 // get the "pointed to" type (ignoring qualifiers at the top level)
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004824 lhptee = lhsType->getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4825 rhptee = rhsType->getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004826
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004827 // make sure we operate on the canonical type
4828 lhptee = Context.getCanonicalType(lhptee);
4829 rhptee = Context.getCanonicalType(rhptee);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004830
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004831 AssignConvertType ConvTy = Compatible;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004832
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004833 // For blocks we enforce that qualifiers are identical.
Douglas Gregor1b8fe5b72009-11-16 21:35:15 +00004834 if (lhptee.getLocalCVRQualifiers() != rhptee.getLocalCVRQualifiers())
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004835 ConvTy = CompatiblePointerDiscardsQualifiers;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004836
Fariborz Jahanianb8b0ea32010-03-17 00:20:01 +00004837 if (!getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
4838 if (!Context.typesAreBlockPointerCompatible(lhsType, rhsType))
4839 return IncompatibleBlockPointer;
4840 }
4841 else if (!Context.typesAreCompatible(lhptee, rhptee))
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004842 return IncompatibleBlockPointer;
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004843 return ConvTy;
4844}
4845
Fariborz Jahanian410f2eb2009-12-08 18:24:49 +00004846/// CheckObjCPointerTypesForAssignment - Compares two objective-c pointer types
4847/// for assignment compatibility.
4848Sema::AssignConvertType
4849Sema::CheckObjCPointerTypesForAssignment(QualType lhsType, QualType rhsType) {
Fariborz Jahaniand5bb8cb2010-03-19 18:06:10 +00004850 if (lhsType->isObjCBuiltinType()) {
4851 // Class is not compatible with ObjC object pointers.
Fariborz Jahanian9b37b1d2010-03-24 21:00:27 +00004852 if (lhsType->isObjCClassType() && !rhsType->isObjCBuiltinType() &&
4853 !rhsType->isObjCQualifiedClassType())
Fariborz Jahaniand5bb8cb2010-03-19 18:06:10 +00004854 return IncompatiblePointer;
Fariborz Jahanian410f2eb2009-12-08 18:24:49 +00004855 return Compatible;
Fariborz Jahaniand5bb8cb2010-03-19 18:06:10 +00004856 }
4857 if (rhsType->isObjCBuiltinType()) {
4858 // Class is not compatible with ObjC object pointers.
Fariborz Jahanian9b37b1d2010-03-24 21:00:27 +00004859 if (rhsType->isObjCClassType() && !lhsType->isObjCBuiltinType() &&
4860 !lhsType->isObjCQualifiedClassType())
Fariborz Jahaniand5bb8cb2010-03-19 18:06:10 +00004861 return IncompatiblePointer;
4862 return Compatible;
4863 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004864 QualType lhptee =
Fariborz Jahanian410f2eb2009-12-08 18:24:49 +00004865 lhsType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004866 QualType rhptee =
Fariborz Jahanian410f2eb2009-12-08 18:24:49 +00004867 rhsType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4868 // make sure we operate on the canonical type
4869 lhptee = Context.getCanonicalType(lhptee);
4870 rhptee = Context.getCanonicalType(rhptee);
4871 if (!lhptee.isAtLeastAsQualifiedAs(rhptee))
4872 return CompatiblePointerDiscardsQualifiers;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004873
Fariborz Jahanian410f2eb2009-12-08 18:24:49 +00004874 if (Context.typesAreCompatible(lhsType, rhsType))
4875 return Compatible;
4876 if (lhsType->isObjCQualifiedIdType() || rhsType->isObjCQualifiedIdType())
4877 return IncompatibleObjCQualifiedId;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004878 return IncompatiblePointer;
Fariborz Jahanian410f2eb2009-12-08 18:24:49 +00004879}
4880
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004881/// CheckAssignmentConstraints (C99 6.5.16) - This routine currently
4882/// has code to accommodate several GCC extensions when type checking
Steve Naroff17f76e02007-05-03 21:03:48 +00004883/// pointers. Here are some objectionable examples that GCC considers warnings:
4884///
4885/// int a, *pint;
4886/// short *pshort;
4887/// struct foo *pfoo;
4888///
4889/// pint = pshort; // warning: assignment from incompatible pointer type
4890/// a = pint; // warning: assignment makes integer from pointer without a cast
4891/// pint = a; // warning: assignment makes pointer from integer without a cast
4892/// pint = pfoo; // warning: assignment from incompatible pointer type
4893///
4894/// As a result, the code for dealing with pointers is more complex than the
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004895/// C99 spec dictates.
Steve Naroff17f76e02007-05-03 21:03:48 +00004896///
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00004897Sema::AssignConvertType
Steve Naroff98cf3e92007-06-06 18:38:38 +00004898Sema::CheckAssignmentConstraints(QualType lhsType, QualType rhsType) {
Chris Lattnera52c2f22008-01-04 23:18:45 +00004899 // Get canonical types. We're not formatting these types, just comparing
4900 // them.
Chris Lattner574dee62008-07-26 22:17:49 +00004901 lhsType = Context.getCanonicalType(lhsType).getUnqualifiedType();
4902 rhsType = Context.getCanonicalType(rhsType).getUnqualifiedType();
Eli Friedman3360d892008-05-30 18:07:22 +00004903
4904 if (lhsType == rhsType)
Chris Lattnerf5c973d2008-01-07 17:51:46 +00004905 return Compatible; // Common case: fast path an exact match.
Steve Naroff44fd8ff2007-07-24 21:46:40 +00004906
David Chisnall9f57c292009-08-17 16:35:33 +00004907 if ((lhsType->isObjCClassType() &&
4908 (rhsType.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCClassRedefinitionType)) ||
4909 (rhsType->isObjCClassType() &&
4910 (lhsType.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCClassRedefinitionType))) {
4911 return Compatible;
4912 }
4913
Douglas Gregor6b754842008-10-28 00:22:11 +00004914 // If the left-hand side is a reference type, then we are in a
4915 // (rare!) case where we've allowed the use of references in C,
4916 // e.g., as a parameter type in a built-in function. In this case,
4917 // just make sure that the type referenced is compatible with the
4918 // right-hand side type. The caller is responsible for adjusting
4919 // lhsType so that the resulting expression does not have reference
4920 // type.
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004921 if (const ReferenceType *lhsTypeRef = lhsType->getAs<ReferenceType>()) {
Douglas Gregor6b754842008-10-28 00:22:11 +00004922 if (Context.typesAreCompatible(lhsTypeRef->getPointeeType(), rhsType))
Anders Carlsson24ebce62007-10-12 23:56:29 +00004923 return Compatible;
Chris Lattnera52c2f22008-01-04 23:18:45 +00004924 return Incompatible;
Fariborz Jahaniana1e34202007-12-19 17:45:58 +00004925 }
Nate Begemanbd956c42009-06-28 02:36:38 +00004926 // Allow scalar to ExtVector assignments, and assignments of an ExtVector type
4927 // to the same ExtVector type.
4928 if (lhsType->isExtVectorType()) {
4929 if (rhsType->isExtVectorType())
4930 return lhsType == rhsType ? Compatible : Incompatible;
Douglas Gregora3208f92010-06-22 23:41:02 +00004931 if (rhsType->isArithmeticType())
Nate Begemanbd956c42009-06-28 02:36:38 +00004932 return Compatible;
4933 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004934
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00004935 if (lhsType->isVectorType() || rhsType->isVectorType()) {
Douglas Gregor59e8b3b2010-08-06 10:14:59 +00004936 if (lhsType->isVectorType() && rhsType->isVectorType()) {
4937 // If we are allowing lax vector conversions, and LHS and RHS are both
4938 // vectors, the total size only needs to be the same. This is a bitcast;
4939 // no bits are changed but the result type is different.
4940 if (getLangOptions().LaxVectorConversions &&
4941 (Context.getTypeSize(lhsType) == Context.getTypeSize(rhsType)))
Anders Carlssondb5a9b62009-01-30 23:17:46 +00004942 return IncompatibleVectors;
Douglas Gregor59e8b3b2010-08-06 10:14:59 +00004943
4944 // Allow assignments of an AltiVec vector type to an equivalent GCC
4945 // vector type and vice versa
4946 if (Context.areCompatibleVectorTypes(lhsType, rhsType))
4947 return Compatible;
Chris Lattner881a2122008-01-04 23:32:24 +00004948 }
4949 return Incompatible;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004950 }
Eli Friedman3360d892008-05-30 18:07:22 +00004951
Douglas Gregorbea453a2010-05-23 21:53:47 +00004952 if (lhsType->isArithmeticType() && rhsType->isArithmeticType() &&
4953 !(getLangOptions().CPlusPlus && lhsType->isEnumeralType()))
Steve Naroff98cf3e92007-06-06 18:38:38 +00004954 return Compatible;
Eli Friedman3360d892008-05-30 18:07:22 +00004955
Chris Lattnerec646832008-04-07 06:49:41 +00004956 if (isa<PointerType>(lhsType)) {
Steve Naroff98cf3e92007-06-06 18:38:38 +00004957 if (rhsType->isIntegerType())
Chris Lattner940cfeb2008-01-04 18:22:42 +00004958 return IntToPointer;
Eli Friedman3360d892008-05-30 18:07:22 +00004959
Chris Lattnerec646832008-04-07 06:49:41 +00004960 if (isa<PointerType>(rhsType))
Steve Naroff98cf3e92007-06-06 18:38:38 +00004961 return CheckPointerTypesForAssignment(lhsType, rhsType);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004962
Steve Naroffaccc4882009-07-20 17:56:53 +00004963 // In general, C pointers are not compatible with ObjC object pointers.
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004964 if (isa<ObjCObjectPointerType>(rhsType)) {
Steve Naroffaccc4882009-07-20 17:56:53 +00004965 if (lhsType->isVoidPointerType()) // an exception to the rule.
4966 return Compatible;
4967 return IncompatiblePointer;
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004968 }
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004969 if (rhsType->getAs<BlockPointerType>()) {
4970 if (lhsType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType()->isVoidType())
Douglas Gregore7dd1452008-11-27 00:44:28 +00004971 return Compatible;
Steve Naroff32d072c2008-09-29 18:10:17 +00004972
4973 // Treat block pointers as objects.
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004974 if (getLangOptions().ObjC1 && lhsType->isObjCIdType())
Steve Naroff32d072c2008-09-29 18:10:17 +00004975 return Compatible;
4976 }
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004977 return Incompatible;
4978 }
4979
4980 if (isa<BlockPointerType>(lhsType)) {
4981 if (rhsType->isIntegerType())
Eli Friedman8163b7a2009-02-25 04:20:42 +00004982 return IntToBlockPointer;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004983
Steve Naroff32d072c2008-09-29 18:10:17 +00004984 // Treat block pointers as objects.
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004985 if (getLangOptions().ObjC1 && rhsType->isObjCIdType())
Steve Naroff32d072c2008-09-29 18:10:17 +00004986 return Compatible;
4987
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004988 if (rhsType->isBlockPointerType())
4989 return CheckBlockPointerTypesForAssignment(lhsType, rhsType);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004990
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004991 if (const PointerType *RHSPT = rhsType->getAs<PointerType>()) {
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004992 if (RHSPT->getPointeeType()->isVoidType())
Douglas Gregore7dd1452008-11-27 00:44:28 +00004993 return Compatible;
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004994 }
Chris Lattnera52c2f22008-01-04 23:18:45 +00004995 return Incompatible;
4996 }
4997
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004998 if (isa<ObjCObjectPointerType>(lhsType)) {
4999 if (rhsType->isIntegerType())
5000 return IntToPointer;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005001
Steve Naroffaccc4882009-07-20 17:56:53 +00005002 // In general, C pointers are not compatible with ObjC object pointers.
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00005003 if (isa<PointerType>(rhsType)) {
Steve Naroffaccc4882009-07-20 17:56:53 +00005004 if (rhsType->isVoidPointerType()) // an exception to the rule.
5005 return Compatible;
5006 return IncompatiblePointer;
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00005007 }
5008 if (rhsType->isObjCObjectPointerType()) {
Fariborz Jahanian410f2eb2009-12-08 18:24:49 +00005009 return CheckObjCPointerTypesForAssignment(lhsType, rhsType);
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00005010 }
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00005011 if (const PointerType *RHSPT = rhsType->getAs<PointerType>()) {
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00005012 if (RHSPT->getPointeeType()->isVoidType())
5013 return Compatible;
5014 }
5015 // Treat block pointers as objects.
5016 if (rhsType->isBlockPointerType())
5017 return Compatible;
5018 return Incompatible;
5019 }
Chris Lattnerec646832008-04-07 06:49:41 +00005020 if (isa<PointerType>(rhsType)) {
Steve Naroff98cf3e92007-06-06 18:38:38 +00005021 // C99 6.5.16.1p1: the left operand is _Bool and the right is a pointer.
Eli Friedman3360d892008-05-30 18:07:22 +00005022 if (lhsType == Context.BoolTy)
5023 return Compatible;
5024
5025 if (lhsType->isIntegerType())
Chris Lattner940cfeb2008-01-04 18:22:42 +00005026 return PointerToInt;
Steve Naroff98cf3e92007-06-06 18:38:38 +00005027
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005028 if (isa<PointerType>(lhsType))
Steve Naroff98cf3e92007-06-06 18:38:38 +00005029 return CheckPointerTypesForAssignment(lhsType, rhsType);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005030
5031 if (isa<BlockPointerType>(lhsType) &&
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00005032 rhsType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType()->isVoidType())
Douglas Gregore7dd1452008-11-27 00:44:28 +00005033 return Compatible;
Chris Lattnera52c2f22008-01-04 23:18:45 +00005034 return Incompatible;
Chris Lattnera52c2f22008-01-04 23:18:45 +00005035 }
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00005036 if (isa<ObjCObjectPointerType>(rhsType)) {
5037 // C99 6.5.16.1p1: the left operand is _Bool and the right is a pointer.
5038 if (lhsType == Context.BoolTy)
5039 return Compatible;
5040
5041 if (lhsType->isIntegerType())
5042 return PointerToInt;
5043
Steve Naroffaccc4882009-07-20 17:56:53 +00005044 // In general, C pointers are not compatible with ObjC object pointers.
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00005045 if (isa<PointerType>(lhsType)) {
Steve Naroffaccc4882009-07-20 17:56:53 +00005046 if (lhsType->isVoidPointerType()) // an exception to the rule.
5047 return Compatible;
5048 return IncompatiblePointer;
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00005049 }
5050 if (isa<BlockPointerType>(lhsType) &&
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00005051 rhsType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType()->isVoidType())
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00005052 return Compatible;
5053 return Incompatible;
5054 }
Eli Friedman3360d892008-05-30 18:07:22 +00005055
Chris Lattnera52c2f22008-01-04 23:18:45 +00005056 if (isa<TagType>(lhsType) && isa<TagType>(rhsType)) {
Chris Lattnerec646832008-04-07 06:49:41 +00005057 if (Context.typesAreCompatible(lhsType, rhsType))
Steve Naroff98cf3e92007-06-06 18:38:38 +00005058 return Compatible;
Bill Wendling216423b2007-05-30 06:30:29 +00005059 }
Steve Naroff98cf3e92007-06-06 18:38:38 +00005060 return Incompatible;
Steve Naroff9eb24652007-05-02 21:58:15 +00005061}
5062
Douglas Gregor0cfbdab2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00005063/// \brief Constructs a transparent union from an expression that is
5064/// used to initialize the transparent union.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005065static void ConstructTransparentUnion(ASTContext &C, Expr *&E,
Douglas Gregor0cfbdab2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00005066 QualType UnionType, FieldDecl *Field) {
5067 // Build an initializer list that designates the appropriate member
5068 // of the transparent union.
Ted Kremenekac034612010-04-13 23:39:13 +00005069 InitListExpr *Initializer = new (C) InitListExpr(C, SourceLocation(),
Ted Kremenek013041e2010-02-19 01:50:18 +00005070 &E, 1,
Douglas Gregor0cfbdab2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00005071 SourceLocation());
5072 Initializer->setType(UnionType);
5073 Initializer->setInitializedFieldInUnion(Field);
5074
5075 // Build a compound literal constructing a value of the transparent
5076 // union type from this initializer list.
John McCalle15bbff2010-01-18 19:35:47 +00005077 TypeSourceInfo *unionTInfo = C.getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(UnionType);
John McCall5d7aa7f2010-01-19 22:33:45 +00005078 E = new (C) CompoundLiteralExpr(SourceLocation(), unionTInfo, UnionType,
John McCalle15bbff2010-01-18 19:35:47 +00005079 Initializer, false);
Douglas Gregor0cfbdab2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00005080}
5081
5082Sema::AssignConvertType
5083Sema::CheckTransparentUnionArgumentConstraints(QualType ArgType, Expr *&rExpr) {
5084 QualType FromType = rExpr->getType();
5085
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005086 // If the ArgType is a Union type, we want to handle a potential
Douglas Gregor0cfbdab2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00005087 // transparent_union GCC extension.
5088 const RecordType *UT = ArgType->getAsUnionType();
Argyrios Kyrtzidisb4b64ca2009-06-30 02:34:44 +00005089 if (!UT || !UT->getDecl()->hasAttr<TransparentUnionAttr>())
Douglas Gregor0cfbdab2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00005090 return Incompatible;
5091
5092 // The field to initialize within the transparent union.
5093 RecordDecl *UD = UT->getDecl();
5094 FieldDecl *InitField = 0;
5095 // It's compatible if the expression matches any of the fields.
Argyrios Kyrtzidiscfbfe782009-06-30 02:36:12 +00005096 for (RecordDecl::field_iterator it = UD->field_begin(),
5097 itend = UD->field_end();
Douglas Gregor0cfbdab2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00005098 it != itend; ++it) {
5099 if (it->getType()->isPointerType()) {
5100 // If the transparent union contains a pointer type, we allow:
5101 // 1) void pointer
5102 // 2) null pointer constant
5103 if (FromType->isPointerType())
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00005104 if (FromType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType()->isVoidType()) {
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005105 ImpCastExprToType(rExpr, it->getType(), CK_BitCast);
Douglas Gregor0cfbdab2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00005106 InitField = *it;
5107 break;
5108 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005109
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005110 if (rExpr->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
Douglas Gregor56751b52009-09-25 04:25:58 +00005111 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull)) {
John McCalle84af4e2010-11-13 01:35:44 +00005112 ImpCastExprToType(rExpr, it->getType(), CK_NullToPointer);
Douglas Gregor0cfbdab2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00005113 InitField = *it;
5114 break;
5115 }
5116 }
5117
5118 if (CheckAssignmentConstraints(it->getType(), rExpr->getType())
5119 == Compatible) {
Daniel Dunbar60785eb2010-09-17 23:21:43 +00005120 ImpCastExprToType(rExpr, it->getType(), CK_Unknown);
Douglas Gregor0cfbdab2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00005121 InitField = *it;
5122 break;
5123 }
5124 }
5125
5126 if (!InitField)
5127 return Incompatible;
5128
5129 ConstructTransparentUnion(Context, rExpr, ArgType, InitField);
5130 return Compatible;
5131}
5132
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00005133Sema::AssignConvertType
Steve Naroffb8ea4fb2007-07-13 23:32:42 +00005134Sema::CheckSingleAssignmentConstraints(QualType lhsType, Expr *&rExpr) {
Douglas Gregor9a657932008-10-21 23:43:52 +00005135 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
5136 if (!lhsType->isRecordType()) {
5137 // C++ 5.17p3: If the left operand is not of class type, the
5138 // expression is implicitly converted (C++ 4) to the
5139 // cv-unqualified type of the left operand.
Douglas Gregor47d3f272008-12-19 17:40:08 +00005140 if (PerformImplicitConversion(rExpr, lhsType.getUnqualifiedType(),
Douglas Gregor7c3bbdf2009-12-16 03:45:30 +00005141 AA_Assigning))
Douglas Gregor9a657932008-10-21 23:43:52 +00005142 return Incompatible;
Chris Lattner0d5640c2009-04-12 09:02:39 +00005143 return Compatible;
Douglas Gregor9a657932008-10-21 23:43:52 +00005144 }
5145
5146 // FIXME: Currently, we fall through and treat C++ classes like C
5147 // structures.
5148 }
5149
Steve Naroff0ee0b0a2007-11-27 17:58:44 +00005150 // C99 6.5.16.1p1: the left operand is a pointer and the right is
5151 // a null pointer constant.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005152 if ((lhsType->isPointerType() ||
5153 lhsType->isObjCObjectPointerType() ||
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005154 lhsType->isBlockPointerType())
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005155 && rExpr->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
Douglas Gregor56751b52009-09-25 04:25:58 +00005156 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull)) {
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005157 ImpCastExprToType(rExpr, lhsType, CK_Unknown);
Steve Naroff0ee0b0a2007-11-27 17:58:44 +00005158 return Compatible;
5159 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005160
Chris Lattnere6dcd502007-10-16 02:55:40 +00005161 // This check seems unnatural, however it is necessary to ensure the proper
Steve Naroffb8ea4fb2007-07-13 23:32:42 +00005162 // conversion of functions/arrays. If the conversion were done for all
Douglas Gregora121b752009-11-03 16:56:39 +00005163 // DeclExpr's (created by ActOnIdExpression), it would mess up the unary
Nick Lewyckyef7c0ff2010-08-05 06:27:49 +00005164 // expressions that suppress this implicit conversion (&, sizeof).
Chris Lattnere6dcd502007-10-16 02:55:40 +00005165 //
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005166 // Suppress this for references: C++ 8.5.3p5.
Chris Lattnere6dcd502007-10-16 02:55:40 +00005167 if (!lhsType->isReferenceType())
Douglas Gregorb92a1562010-02-03 00:27:59 +00005168 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(rExpr);
Steve Naroff0c1c7ed2007-08-24 22:33:52 +00005169
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00005170 Sema::AssignConvertType result =
5171 CheckAssignmentConstraints(lhsType, rExpr->getType());
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005172
Steve Naroff0c1c7ed2007-08-24 22:33:52 +00005173 // C99 6.5.16.1p2: The value of the right operand is converted to the
5174 // type of the assignment expression.
Douglas Gregor6b754842008-10-28 00:22:11 +00005175 // CheckAssignmentConstraints allows the left-hand side to be a reference,
5176 // so that we can use references in built-in functions even in C.
5177 // The getNonReferenceType() call makes sure that the resulting expression
5178 // does not have reference type.
Douglas Gregor0cfbdab2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00005179 if (result != Incompatible && rExpr->getType() != lhsType)
Douglas Gregora8a089b2010-07-13 18:40:04 +00005180 ImpCastExprToType(rExpr, lhsType.getNonLValueExprType(Context),
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005181 CK_Unknown);
Steve Naroff0c1c7ed2007-08-24 22:33:52 +00005182 return result;
Steve Naroffb8ea4fb2007-07-13 23:32:42 +00005183}
5184
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005185QualType Sema::InvalidOperands(SourceLocation Loc, Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex) {
Chris Lattner377d1f82008-11-18 22:52:51 +00005186 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_invalid_operands)
Chris Lattner6a2ed6f2008-11-23 09:13:29 +00005187 << lex->getType() << rex->getType()
Chris Lattner377d1f82008-11-18 22:52:51 +00005188 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Chris Lattner5c11c412007-12-12 05:47:28 +00005189 return QualType();
Steve Naroff6f49f5d2007-05-29 14:23:36 +00005190}
5191
Chris Lattnerfaa54172010-01-12 21:23:57 +00005192QualType Sema::CheckVectorOperands(SourceLocation Loc, Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex) {
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005193 // For conversion purposes, we ignore any qualifiers.
Nate Begeman002e4bd2008-04-04 01:30:25 +00005194 // For example, "const float" and "float" are equivalent.
Chris Lattner574dee62008-07-26 22:17:49 +00005195 QualType lhsType =
5196 Context.getCanonicalType(lex->getType()).getUnqualifiedType();
5197 QualType rhsType =
5198 Context.getCanonicalType(rex->getType()).getUnqualifiedType();
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005199
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005200 // If the vector types are identical, return.
Nate Begeman002e4bd2008-04-04 01:30:25 +00005201 if (lhsType == rhsType)
Steve Naroff84ff4b42007-07-09 21:31:10 +00005202 return lhsType;
Nate Begeman330aaa72007-12-30 02:59:45 +00005203
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005204 // Handle the case of a vector & extvector type of the same size and element
5205 // type. It would be nice if we only had one vector type someday.
Anders Carlssondb5a9b62009-01-30 23:17:46 +00005206 if (getLangOptions().LaxVectorConversions) {
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00005207 if (const VectorType *LV = lhsType->getAs<VectorType>()) {
Chandler Carruth9ed87ba2010-08-30 07:36:24 +00005208 if (const VectorType *RV = rhsType->getAs<VectorType>()) {
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005209 if (LV->getElementType() == RV->getElementType() &&
Anders Carlssondb5a9b62009-01-30 23:17:46 +00005210 LV->getNumElements() == RV->getNumElements()) {
Douglas Gregorcbfbca12010-05-19 03:21:00 +00005211 if (lhsType->isExtVectorType()) {
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005212 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lhsType, CK_BitCast);
Douglas Gregorcbfbca12010-05-19 03:21:00 +00005213 return lhsType;
5214 }
5215
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005216 ImpCastExprToType(lex, rhsType, CK_BitCast);
Douglas Gregorcbfbca12010-05-19 03:21:00 +00005217 return rhsType;
Eric Christophera613f562010-08-26 00:42:16 +00005218 } else if (Context.getTypeSize(lhsType) ==Context.getTypeSize(rhsType)){
5219 // If we are allowing lax vector conversions, and LHS and RHS are both
5220 // vectors, the total size only needs to be the same. This is a
5221 // bitcast; no bits are changed but the result type is different.
5222 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lhsType, CK_BitCast);
5223 return lhsType;
Anders Carlssondb5a9b62009-01-30 23:17:46 +00005224 }
Eric Christophera613f562010-08-26 00:42:16 +00005225 }
Chandler Carruth9ed87ba2010-08-30 07:36:24 +00005226 }
Anders Carlssondb5a9b62009-01-30 23:17:46 +00005227 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005228
Douglas Gregor59e8b3b2010-08-06 10:14:59 +00005229 // Handle the case of equivalent AltiVec and GCC vector types
5230 if (lhsType->isVectorType() && rhsType->isVectorType() &&
5231 Context.areCompatibleVectorTypes(lhsType, rhsType)) {
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005232 ImpCastExprToType(lex, rhsType, CK_BitCast);
Douglas Gregor59e8b3b2010-08-06 10:14:59 +00005233 return rhsType;
5234 }
5235
Nate Begemanbd956c42009-06-28 02:36:38 +00005236 // Canonicalize the ExtVector to the LHS, remember if we swapped so we can
5237 // swap back (so that we don't reverse the inputs to a subtract, for instance.
5238 bool swapped = false;
5239 if (rhsType->isExtVectorType()) {
5240 swapped = true;
5241 std::swap(rex, lex);
5242 std::swap(rhsType, lhsType);
5243 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005244
Nate Begeman886448d2009-06-28 19:12:57 +00005245 // Handle the case of an ext vector and scalar.
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00005246 if (const ExtVectorType *LV = lhsType->getAs<ExtVectorType>()) {
Nate Begemanbd956c42009-06-28 02:36:38 +00005247 QualType EltTy = LV->getElementType();
Douglas Gregor6972a622010-06-16 00:35:25 +00005248 if (EltTy->isIntegralType(Context) && rhsType->isIntegralType(Context)) {
Nate Begemanbd956c42009-06-28 02:36:38 +00005249 if (Context.getIntegerTypeOrder(EltTy, rhsType) >= 0) {
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005250 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lhsType, CK_IntegralCast);
Nate Begemanbd956c42009-06-28 02:36:38 +00005251 if (swapped) std::swap(rex, lex);
5252 return lhsType;
5253 }
5254 }
5255 if (EltTy->isRealFloatingType() && rhsType->isScalarType() &&
5256 rhsType->isRealFloatingType()) {
5257 if (Context.getFloatingTypeOrder(EltTy, rhsType) >= 0) {
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005258 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lhsType, CK_FloatingCast);
Nate Begemanbd956c42009-06-28 02:36:38 +00005259 if (swapped) std::swap(rex, lex);
5260 return lhsType;
5261 }
Nate Begeman330aaa72007-12-30 02:59:45 +00005262 }
5263 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005264
Nate Begeman886448d2009-06-28 19:12:57 +00005265 // Vectors of different size or scalar and non-ext-vector are errors.
Chris Lattner377d1f82008-11-18 22:52:51 +00005266 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_vector_not_convertable)
Chris Lattner1e5665e2008-11-24 06:25:27 +00005267 << lex->getType() << rex->getType()
Chris Lattner377d1f82008-11-18 22:52:51 +00005268 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroff84ff4b42007-07-09 21:31:10 +00005269 return QualType();
Sebastian Redl112a97662009-02-07 00:15:38 +00005270}
5271
Chris Lattnerfaa54172010-01-12 21:23:57 +00005272QualType Sema::CheckMultiplyDivideOperands(
5273 Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex, SourceLocation Loc, bool isCompAssign, bool isDiv) {
Daniel Dunbar060d5e22009-01-05 22:42:10 +00005274 if (lex->getType()->isVectorType() || rex->getType()->isVectorType())
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005275 return CheckVectorOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005276
Steve Naroffbe4c4d12007-08-24 19:07:16 +00005277 QualType compType = UsualArithmeticConversions(lex, rex, isCompAssign);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005278
Chris Lattnerfaa54172010-01-12 21:23:57 +00005279 if (!lex->getType()->isArithmeticType() ||
5280 !rex->getType()->isArithmeticType())
5281 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005282
Chris Lattnerfaa54172010-01-12 21:23:57 +00005283 // Check for division by zero.
5284 if (isDiv &&
5285 rex->isNullPointerConstant(Context, Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNotNull))
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005286 DiagRuntimeBehavior(Loc, PDiag(diag::warn_division_by_zero)
Chris Lattner70117952010-01-12 21:30:55 +00005287 << rex->getSourceRange());
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005288
Chris Lattnerfaa54172010-01-12 21:23:57 +00005289 return compType;
Steve Naroff26c8ea52007-03-21 21:08:52 +00005290}
5291
Chris Lattnerfaa54172010-01-12 21:23:57 +00005292QualType Sema::CheckRemainderOperands(
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005293 Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex, SourceLocation Loc, bool isCompAssign) {
Daniel Dunbar0d2bfec2009-01-05 22:55:36 +00005294 if (lex->getType()->isVectorType() || rex->getType()->isVectorType()) {
Douglas Gregor5cc2c8b2010-07-23 15:58:24 +00005295 if (lex->getType()->hasIntegerRepresentation() &&
5296 rex->getType()->hasIntegerRepresentation())
Daniel Dunbar0d2bfec2009-01-05 22:55:36 +00005297 return CheckVectorOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
5298 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
5299 }
Steve Naroffb8ea4fb2007-07-13 23:32:42 +00005300
Steve Naroffbe4c4d12007-08-24 19:07:16 +00005301 QualType compType = UsualArithmeticConversions(lex, rex, isCompAssign);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005302
Chris Lattnerfaa54172010-01-12 21:23:57 +00005303 if (!lex->getType()->isIntegerType() || !rex->getType()->isIntegerType())
5304 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005305
Chris Lattnerfaa54172010-01-12 21:23:57 +00005306 // Check for remainder by zero.
5307 if (rex->isNullPointerConstant(Context, Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNotNull))
Chris Lattner70117952010-01-12 21:30:55 +00005308 DiagRuntimeBehavior(Loc, PDiag(diag::warn_remainder_by_zero)
5309 << rex->getSourceRange());
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005310
Chris Lattnerfaa54172010-01-12 21:23:57 +00005311 return compType;
Steve Naroff218bc2b2007-05-04 21:54:46 +00005312}
5313
Chris Lattnerfaa54172010-01-12 21:23:57 +00005314QualType Sema::CheckAdditionOperands( // C99 6.5.6
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005315 Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex, SourceLocation Loc, QualType* CompLHSTy) {
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005316 if (lex->getType()->isVectorType() || rex->getType()->isVectorType()) {
5317 QualType compType = CheckVectorOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
5318 if (CompLHSTy) *CompLHSTy = compType;
5319 return compType;
5320 }
Steve Naroff7a5af782007-07-13 16:58:59 +00005321
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005322 QualType compType = UsualArithmeticConversions(lex, rex, CompLHSTy);
Eli Friedman8e122982008-05-18 18:08:51 +00005323
Steve Naroffe4718892007-04-27 18:30:00 +00005324 // handle the common case first (both operands are arithmetic).
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005325 if (lex->getType()->isArithmeticType() &&
5326 rex->getType()->isArithmeticType()) {
5327 if (CompLHSTy) *CompLHSTy = compType;
Steve Naroffbe4c4d12007-08-24 19:07:16 +00005328 return compType;
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005329 }
Steve Naroff218bc2b2007-05-04 21:54:46 +00005330
Eli Friedman8e122982008-05-18 18:08:51 +00005331 // Put any potential pointer into PExp
5332 Expr* PExp = lex, *IExp = rex;
Steve Naroff6b712a72009-07-14 18:25:06 +00005333 if (IExp->getType()->isAnyPointerType())
Eli Friedman8e122982008-05-18 18:08:51 +00005334 std::swap(PExp, IExp);
5335
Steve Naroff6b712a72009-07-14 18:25:06 +00005336 if (PExp->getType()->isAnyPointerType()) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005337
Eli Friedman8e122982008-05-18 18:08:51 +00005338 if (IExp->getType()->isIntegerType()) {
Steve Naroffaacd4cc2009-07-13 21:20:41 +00005339 QualType PointeeTy = PExp->getType()->getPointeeType();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005340
Chris Lattner12bdebb2009-04-24 23:50:08 +00005341 // Check for arithmetic on pointers to incomplete types.
5342 if (PointeeTy->isVoidType()) {
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005343 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
5344 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_pointer_arith_void_type)
Chris Lattner3b054132008-11-19 05:08:23 +00005345 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Douglas Gregordd430f72009-01-19 19:26:10 +00005346 return QualType();
Eli Friedman8e122982008-05-18 18:08:51 +00005347 }
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005348
5349 // GNU extension: arithmetic on pointer to void
5350 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_gnu_void_ptr)
5351 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Chris Lattner12bdebb2009-04-24 23:50:08 +00005352 } else if (PointeeTy->isFunctionType()) {
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005353 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
5354 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_pointer_arith_function_type)
5355 << lex->getType() << lex->getSourceRange();
5356 return QualType();
5357 }
5358
5359 // GNU extension: arithmetic on pointer to function
5360 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_gnu_ptr_func_arith)
5361 << lex->getType() << lex->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroffa63372d2009-07-13 21:32:29 +00005362 } else {
Steve Naroffaacd4cc2009-07-13 21:20:41 +00005363 // Check if we require a complete type.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005364 if (((PExp->getType()->isPointerType() &&
Steve Naroffa63372d2009-07-13 21:32:29 +00005365 !PExp->getType()->isDependentType()) ||
Steve Naroffaacd4cc2009-07-13 21:20:41 +00005366 PExp->getType()->isObjCObjectPointerType()) &&
5367 RequireCompleteType(Loc, PointeeTy,
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005368 PDiag(diag::err_typecheck_arithmetic_incomplete_type)
5369 << PExp->getSourceRange()
Anders Carlsson029fc692009-08-26 22:59:12 +00005370 << PExp->getType()))
Steve Naroffaacd4cc2009-07-13 21:20:41 +00005371 return QualType();
5372 }
Chris Lattner12bdebb2009-04-24 23:50:08 +00005373 // Diagnose bad cases where we step over interface counts.
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00005374 if (PointeeTy->isObjCObjectType() && LangOpts.ObjCNonFragileABI) {
Chris Lattner12bdebb2009-04-24 23:50:08 +00005375 Diag(Loc, diag::err_arithmetic_nonfragile_interface)
5376 << PointeeTy << PExp->getSourceRange();
5377 return QualType();
5378 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005379
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005380 if (CompLHSTy) {
Eli Friedman629ffb92009-08-20 04:21:42 +00005381 QualType LHSTy = Context.isPromotableBitField(lex);
5382 if (LHSTy.isNull()) {
5383 LHSTy = lex->getType();
5384 if (LHSTy->isPromotableIntegerType())
5385 LHSTy = Context.getPromotedIntegerType(LHSTy);
Douglas Gregord2c2d172009-05-02 00:36:19 +00005386 }
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005387 *CompLHSTy = LHSTy;
5388 }
Eli Friedman8e122982008-05-18 18:08:51 +00005389 return PExp->getType();
5390 }
5391 }
5392
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005393 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Steve Naroff26c8ea52007-03-21 21:08:52 +00005394}
5395
Chris Lattner2a3569b2008-04-07 05:30:13 +00005396// C99 6.5.6
5397QualType Sema::CheckSubtractionOperands(Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex,
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005398 SourceLocation Loc, QualType* CompLHSTy) {
5399 if (lex->getType()->isVectorType() || rex->getType()->isVectorType()) {
5400 QualType compType = CheckVectorOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
5401 if (CompLHSTy) *CompLHSTy = compType;
5402 return compType;
5403 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005404
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005405 QualType compType = UsualArithmeticConversions(lex, rex, CompLHSTy);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005406
Chris Lattner4d62f422007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005407 // Enforce type constraints: C99 6.5.6p3.
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005408
Chris Lattner4d62f422007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005409 // Handle the common case first (both operands are arithmetic).
Mike Stumpf70bcf72009-05-07 18:43:07 +00005410 if (lex->getType()->isArithmeticType()
5411 && rex->getType()->isArithmeticType()) {
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005412 if (CompLHSTy) *CompLHSTy = compType;
Steve Naroffbe4c4d12007-08-24 19:07:16 +00005413 return compType;
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005414 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005415
Chris Lattner4d62f422007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005416 // Either ptr - int or ptr - ptr.
Steve Naroff6b712a72009-07-14 18:25:06 +00005417 if (lex->getType()->isAnyPointerType()) {
Steve Naroff4eed7a12009-07-13 17:19:15 +00005418 QualType lpointee = lex->getType()->getPointeeType();
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005419
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005420 // The LHS must be an completely-defined object type.
Douglas Gregorf6cd9282009-01-23 00:36:41 +00005421
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005422 bool ComplainAboutVoid = false;
5423 Expr *ComplainAboutFunc = 0;
5424 if (lpointee->isVoidType()) {
5425 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
5426 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_pointer_arith_void_type)
5427 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
5428 return QualType();
5429 }
5430
5431 // GNU C extension: arithmetic on pointer to void
5432 ComplainAboutVoid = true;
5433 } else if (lpointee->isFunctionType()) {
5434 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
5435 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_pointer_arith_function_type)
Chris Lattner1e5665e2008-11-24 06:25:27 +00005436 << lex->getType() << lex->getSourceRange();
Chris Lattner4d62f422007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005437 return QualType();
5438 }
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005439
5440 // GNU C extension: arithmetic on pointer to function
5441 ComplainAboutFunc = lex;
5442 } else if (!lpointee->isDependentType() &&
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005443 RequireCompleteType(Loc, lpointee,
Anders Carlsson029fc692009-08-26 22:59:12 +00005444 PDiag(diag::err_typecheck_sub_ptr_object)
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005445 << lex->getSourceRange()
Anders Carlsson029fc692009-08-26 22:59:12 +00005446 << lex->getType()))
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005447 return QualType();
Chris Lattner4d62f422007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005448
Chris Lattner12bdebb2009-04-24 23:50:08 +00005449 // Diagnose bad cases where we step over interface counts.
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00005450 if (lpointee->isObjCObjectType() && LangOpts.ObjCNonFragileABI) {
Chris Lattner12bdebb2009-04-24 23:50:08 +00005451 Diag(Loc, diag::err_arithmetic_nonfragile_interface)
5452 << lpointee << lex->getSourceRange();
5453 return QualType();
5454 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005455
Chris Lattner4d62f422007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005456 // The result type of a pointer-int computation is the pointer type.
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005457 if (rex->getType()->isIntegerType()) {
5458 if (ComplainAboutVoid)
5459 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_gnu_void_ptr)
5460 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
5461 if (ComplainAboutFunc)
5462 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_gnu_ptr_func_arith)
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005463 << ComplainAboutFunc->getType()
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005464 << ComplainAboutFunc->getSourceRange();
5465
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005466 if (CompLHSTy) *CompLHSTy = lex->getType();
Chris Lattner4d62f422007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005467 return lex->getType();
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005468 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005469
Chris Lattner4d62f422007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005470 // Handle pointer-pointer subtractions.
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00005471 if (const PointerType *RHSPTy = rex->getType()->getAs<PointerType>()) {
Eli Friedman1974e532008-02-08 01:19:44 +00005472 QualType rpointee = RHSPTy->getPointeeType();
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005473
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005474 // RHS must be a completely-type object type.
5475 // Handle the GNU void* extension.
5476 if (rpointee->isVoidType()) {
5477 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
5478 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_pointer_arith_void_type)
5479 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
5480 return QualType();
5481 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005482
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005483 ComplainAboutVoid = true;
5484 } else if (rpointee->isFunctionType()) {
5485 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
5486 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_pointer_arith_function_type)
Chris Lattner1e5665e2008-11-24 06:25:27 +00005487 << rex->getType() << rex->getSourceRange();
Chris Lattner4d62f422007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005488 return QualType();
5489 }
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005490
5491 // GNU extension: arithmetic on pointer to function
5492 if (!ComplainAboutFunc)
5493 ComplainAboutFunc = rex;
5494 } else if (!rpointee->isDependentType() &&
5495 RequireCompleteType(Loc, rpointee,
Anders Carlsson029fc692009-08-26 22:59:12 +00005496 PDiag(diag::err_typecheck_sub_ptr_object)
5497 << rex->getSourceRange()
5498 << rex->getType()))
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005499 return QualType();
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005500
Eli Friedman168fe152009-05-16 13:54:38 +00005501 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
5502 // Pointee types must be the same: C++ [expr.add]
5503 if (!Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(lpointee, rpointee)) {
5504 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_sub_ptr_compatible)
5505 << lex->getType() << rex->getType()
5506 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
5507 return QualType();
5508 }
5509 } else {
5510 // Pointee types must be compatible C99 6.5.6p3
5511 if (!Context.typesAreCompatible(
5512 Context.getCanonicalType(lpointee).getUnqualifiedType(),
5513 Context.getCanonicalType(rpointee).getUnqualifiedType())) {
5514 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_sub_ptr_compatible)
5515 << lex->getType() << rex->getType()
5516 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
5517 return QualType();
5518 }
Chris Lattner4d62f422007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005519 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005520
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005521 if (ComplainAboutVoid)
5522 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_gnu_void_ptr)
5523 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
5524 if (ComplainAboutFunc)
5525 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_gnu_ptr_func_arith)
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005526 << ComplainAboutFunc->getType()
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005527 << ComplainAboutFunc->getSourceRange();
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005528
5529 if (CompLHSTy) *CompLHSTy = lex->getType();
Chris Lattner4d62f422007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005530 return Context.getPointerDiffType();
5531 }
5532 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005533
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005534 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Steve Naroff218bc2b2007-05-04 21:54:46 +00005535}
5536
Douglas Gregor0bf31402010-10-08 23:50:27 +00005537static bool isScopedEnumerationType(QualType T) {
5538 if (const EnumType *ET = dyn_cast<EnumType>(T))
5539 return ET->getDecl()->isScoped();
5540 return false;
5541}
5542
Chris Lattner2a3569b2008-04-07 05:30:13 +00005543// C99 6.5.7
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005544QualType Sema::CheckShiftOperands(Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex, SourceLocation Loc,
Chris Lattner2a3569b2008-04-07 05:30:13 +00005545 bool isCompAssign) {
Chris Lattner5c11c412007-12-12 05:47:28 +00005546 // C99 6.5.7p2: Each of the operands shall have integer type.
Douglas Gregor5cc2c8b2010-07-23 15:58:24 +00005547 if (!lex->getType()->hasIntegerRepresentation() ||
5548 !rex->getType()->hasIntegerRepresentation())
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005549 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005550
Douglas Gregor0bf31402010-10-08 23:50:27 +00005551 // C++0x: Don't allow scoped enums. FIXME: Use something better than
5552 // hasIntegerRepresentation() above instead of this.
5553 if (isScopedEnumerationType(lex->getType()) ||
5554 isScopedEnumerationType(rex->getType())) {
5555 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
5556 }
5557
Nate Begemane46ee9a2009-10-25 02:26:48 +00005558 // Vector shifts promote their scalar inputs to vector type.
5559 if (lex->getType()->isVectorType() || rex->getType()->isVectorType())
5560 return CheckVectorOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
5561
Chris Lattner5c11c412007-12-12 05:47:28 +00005562 // Shifts don't perform usual arithmetic conversions, they just do integer
5563 // promotions on each operand. C99 6.5.7p3
Eli Friedman629ffb92009-08-20 04:21:42 +00005564 QualType LHSTy = Context.isPromotableBitField(lex);
5565 if (LHSTy.isNull()) {
5566 LHSTy = lex->getType();
5567 if (LHSTy->isPromotableIntegerType())
5568 LHSTy = Context.getPromotedIntegerType(LHSTy);
Douglas Gregord2c2d172009-05-02 00:36:19 +00005569 }
Chris Lattner3c133402007-12-13 07:28:16 +00005570 if (!isCompAssign)
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005571 ImpCastExprToType(lex, LHSTy, CK_IntegralCast);
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005572
Chris Lattner5c11c412007-12-12 05:47:28 +00005573 UsualUnaryConversions(rex);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005574
Ryan Flynnf53fab82009-08-07 16:20:20 +00005575 // Sanity-check shift operands
5576 llvm::APSInt Right;
5577 // Check right/shifter operand
Daniel Dunbar687fa862009-09-17 06:31:27 +00005578 if (!rex->isValueDependent() &&
5579 rex->isIntegerConstantExpr(Right, Context)) {
Ryan Flynn2f085712009-08-08 19:18:23 +00005580 if (Right.isNegative())
Ryan Flynnf53fab82009-08-07 16:20:20 +00005581 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_shift_negative) << rex->getSourceRange();
5582 else {
5583 llvm::APInt LeftBits(Right.getBitWidth(),
5584 Context.getTypeSize(lex->getType()));
5585 if (Right.uge(LeftBits))
5586 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_shift_gt_typewidth) << rex->getSourceRange();
5587 }
5588 }
5589
Chris Lattner5c11c412007-12-12 05:47:28 +00005590 // "The type of the result is that of the promoted left operand."
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005591 return LHSTy;
Steve Naroff26c8ea52007-03-21 21:08:52 +00005592}
5593
Chandler Carruth17773fc2010-07-10 12:30:03 +00005594static bool IsWithinTemplateSpecialization(Decl *D) {
5595 if (DeclContext *DC = D->getDeclContext()) {
5596 if (isa<ClassTemplateSpecializationDecl>(DC))
5597 return true;
5598 if (FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(DC))
5599 return FD->isFunctionTemplateSpecialization();
5600 }
5601 return false;
5602}
5603
Douglas Gregor5b07c7e2009-05-04 06:07:12 +00005604// C99 6.5.8, C++ [expr.rel]
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005605QualType Sema::CheckCompareOperands(Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex, SourceLocation Loc,
Douglas Gregor7a5bc762009-04-06 18:45:53 +00005606 unsigned OpaqueOpc, bool isRelational) {
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005607 BinaryOperatorKind Opc = (BinaryOperatorKind) OpaqueOpc;
Douglas Gregor7a5bc762009-04-06 18:45:53 +00005608
Chris Lattner9a152e22009-12-05 05:40:13 +00005609 // Handle vector comparisons separately.
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005610 if (lex->getType()->isVectorType() || rex->getType()->isVectorType())
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005611 return CheckVectorCompareOperands(lex, rex, Loc, isRelational);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005612
Steve Naroff31090012007-07-16 21:54:35 +00005613 QualType lType = lex->getType();
5614 QualType rType = rex->getType();
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005615
Douglas Gregor4ffbad12010-06-22 22:12:46 +00005616 if (!lType->hasFloatingRepresentation() &&
Ted Kremenek853734e2010-09-16 00:03:01 +00005617 !(lType->isBlockPointerType() && isRelational) &&
5618 !lex->getLocStart().isMacroID() &&
5619 !rex->getLocStart().isMacroID()) {
Chris Lattner222b8bd2009-03-08 19:39:53 +00005620 // For non-floating point types, check for self-comparisons of the form
5621 // x == x, x != x, x < x, etc. These always evaluate to a constant, and
5622 // often indicate logic errors in the program.
Chandler Carruth65a38182010-07-12 06:23:38 +00005623 //
5624 // NOTE: Don't warn about comparison expressions resulting from macro
5625 // expansion. Also don't warn about comparisons which are only self
5626 // comparisons within a template specialization. The warnings should catch
5627 // obvious cases in the definition of the template anyways. The idea is to
5628 // warn when the typed comparison operator will always evaluate to the same
5629 // result.
Chris Lattner222b8bd2009-03-08 19:39:53 +00005630 Expr *LHSStripped = lex->IgnoreParens();
5631 Expr *RHSStripped = rex->IgnoreParens();
Chandler Carruth17773fc2010-07-10 12:30:03 +00005632 if (DeclRefExpr* DRL = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(LHSStripped)) {
Douglas Gregorec170db2010-06-08 19:50:34 +00005633 if (DeclRefExpr* DRR = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(RHSStripped)) {
Ted Kremenek853734e2010-09-16 00:03:01 +00005634 if (DRL->getDecl() == DRR->getDecl() &&
Chandler Carruth17773fc2010-07-10 12:30:03 +00005635 !IsWithinTemplateSpecialization(DRL->getDecl())) {
Douglas Gregorec170db2010-06-08 19:50:34 +00005636 DiagRuntimeBehavior(Loc, PDiag(diag::warn_comparison_always)
5637 << 0 // self-
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005638 << (Opc == BO_EQ
5639 || Opc == BO_LE
5640 || Opc == BO_GE));
Douglas Gregorec170db2010-06-08 19:50:34 +00005641 } else if (lType->isArrayType() && rType->isArrayType() &&
5642 !DRL->getDecl()->getType()->isReferenceType() &&
5643 !DRR->getDecl()->getType()->isReferenceType()) {
5644 // what is it always going to eval to?
5645 char always_evals_to;
5646 switch(Opc) {
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005647 case BO_EQ: // e.g. array1 == array2
Douglas Gregorec170db2010-06-08 19:50:34 +00005648 always_evals_to = 0; // false
5649 break;
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005650 case BO_NE: // e.g. array1 != array2
Douglas Gregorec170db2010-06-08 19:50:34 +00005651 always_evals_to = 1; // true
5652 break;
5653 default:
5654 // best we can say is 'a constant'
5655 always_evals_to = 2; // e.g. array1 <= array2
5656 break;
5657 }
5658 DiagRuntimeBehavior(Loc, PDiag(diag::warn_comparison_always)
5659 << 1 // array
5660 << always_evals_to);
5661 }
5662 }
Chandler Carruth17773fc2010-07-10 12:30:03 +00005663 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005664
Chris Lattner222b8bd2009-03-08 19:39:53 +00005665 if (isa<CastExpr>(LHSStripped))
5666 LHSStripped = LHSStripped->IgnoreParenCasts();
5667 if (isa<CastExpr>(RHSStripped))
5668 RHSStripped = RHSStripped->IgnoreParenCasts();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005669
Chris Lattner222b8bd2009-03-08 19:39:53 +00005670 // Warn about comparisons against a string constant (unless the other
5671 // operand is null), the user probably wants strcmp.
Douglas Gregor7a5bc762009-04-06 18:45:53 +00005672 Expr *literalString = 0;
5673 Expr *literalStringStripped = 0;
Chris Lattner222b8bd2009-03-08 19:39:53 +00005674 if ((isa<StringLiteral>(LHSStripped) || isa<ObjCEncodeExpr>(LHSStripped)) &&
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005675 !RHSStripped->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
Douglas Gregor56751b52009-09-25 04:25:58 +00005676 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull)) {
Douglas Gregor7a5bc762009-04-06 18:45:53 +00005677 literalString = lex;
5678 literalStringStripped = LHSStripped;
Mike Stump12b8ce12009-08-04 21:02:39 +00005679 } else if ((isa<StringLiteral>(RHSStripped) ||
5680 isa<ObjCEncodeExpr>(RHSStripped)) &&
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005681 !LHSStripped->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
Douglas Gregor56751b52009-09-25 04:25:58 +00005682 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull)) {
Douglas Gregor7a5bc762009-04-06 18:45:53 +00005683 literalString = rex;
5684 literalStringStripped = RHSStripped;
5685 }
5686
5687 if (literalString) {
5688 std::string resultComparison;
5689 switch (Opc) {
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005690 case BO_LT: resultComparison = ") < 0"; break;
5691 case BO_GT: resultComparison = ") > 0"; break;
5692 case BO_LE: resultComparison = ") <= 0"; break;
5693 case BO_GE: resultComparison = ") >= 0"; break;
5694 case BO_EQ: resultComparison = ") == 0"; break;
5695 case BO_NE: resultComparison = ") != 0"; break;
Douglas Gregor7a5bc762009-04-06 18:45:53 +00005696 default: assert(false && "Invalid comparison operator");
5697 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005698
Douglas Gregor49862b82010-01-12 23:18:54 +00005699 DiagRuntimeBehavior(Loc,
5700 PDiag(diag::warn_stringcompare)
5701 << isa<ObjCEncodeExpr>(literalStringStripped)
Ted Kremenek800b66b2010-04-09 20:26:53 +00005702 << literalString->getSourceRange());
Douglas Gregor7a5bc762009-04-06 18:45:53 +00005703 }
Ted Kremeneke451eae2007-10-29 16:58:49 +00005704 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005705
Douglas Gregorec170db2010-06-08 19:50:34 +00005706 // C99 6.5.8p3 / C99 6.5.9p4
5707 if (lex->getType()->isArithmeticType() && rex->getType()->isArithmeticType())
5708 UsualArithmeticConversions(lex, rex);
5709 else {
5710 UsualUnaryConversions(lex);
5711 UsualUnaryConversions(rex);
5712 }
5713
5714 lType = lex->getType();
5715 rType = rex->getType();
5716
Douglas Gregorca63811b2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005717 // The result of comparisons is 'bool' in C++, 'int' in C.
Chris Lattner9a152e22009-12-05 05:40:13 +00005718 QualType ResultTy = getLangOptions().CPlusPlus ? Context.BoolTy:Context.IntTy;
Douglas Gregorca63811b2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005719
Chris Lattnerb620c342007-08-26 01:18:55 +00005720 if (isRelational) {
5721 if (lType->isRealType() && rType->isRealType())
Douglas Gregorca63811b2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005722 return ResultTy;
Chris Lattnerb620c342007-08-26 01:18:55 +00005723 } else {
Ted Kremeneke2763b02007-10-29 17:13:39 +00005724 // Check for comparisons of floating point operands using != and ==.
Douglas Gregor4ffbad12010-06-22 22:12:46 +00005725 if (lType->hasFloatingRepresentation())
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005726 CheckFloatComparison(Loc,lex,rex);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005727
Chris Lattnerb620c342007-08-26 01:18:55 +00005728 if (lType->isArithmeticType() && rType->isArithmeticType())
Douglas Gregorca63811b2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005729 return ResultTy;
Chris Lattnerb620c342007-08-26 01:18:55 +00005730 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005731
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005732 bool LHSIsNull = lex->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
Douglas Gregor56751b52009-09-25 04:25:58 +00005733 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005734 bool RHSIsNull = rex->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
Douglas Gregor56751b52009-09-25 04:25:58 +00005735 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005736
Douglas Gregorf267edd2010-06-15 21:38:40 +00005737 // All of the following pointer-related warnings are GCC extensions, except
5738 // when handling null pointer constants.
Steve Naroff808eb8f2007-08-27 04:08:11 +00005739 if (lType->isPointerType() && rType->isPointerType()) { // C99 6.5.8p2
Chris Lattner3a0702e2008-04-03 05:07:25 +00005740 QualType LCanPointeeTy =
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00005741 Context.getCanonicalType(lType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType());
Chris Lattner3a0702e2008-04-03 05:07:25 +00005742 QualType RCanPointeeTy =
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00005743 Context.getCanonicalType(rType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType());
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005744
Douglas Gregor5b07c7e2009-05-04 06:07:12 +00005745 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
Eli Friedman16c209612009-08-23 00:27:47 +00005746 if (LCanPointeeTy == RCanPointeeTy)
5747 return ResultTy;
Fariborz Jahanianffc420c2009-12-21 18:19:17 +00005748 if (!isRelational &&
5749 (LCanPointeeTy->isVoidType() || RCanPointeeTy->isVoidType())) {
5750 // Valid unless comparison between non-null pointer and function pointer
5751 // This is a gcc extension compatibility comparison.
Douglas Gregorf267edd2010-06-15 21:38:40 +00005752 // In a SFINAE context, we treat this as a hard error to maintain
5753 // conformance with the C++ standard.
Fariborz Jahanianffc420c2009-12-21 18:19:17 +00005754 if ((LCanPointeeTy->isFunctionType() || RCanPointeeTy->isFunctionType())
5755 && !LHSIsNull && !RHSIsNull) {
Douglas Gregorf267edd2010-06-15 21:38:40 +00005756 Diag(Loc,
5757 isSFINAEContext()?
5758 diag::err_typecheck_comparison_of_fptr_to_void
5759 : diag::ext_typecheck_comparison_of_fptr_to_void)
Fariborz Jahanianffc420c2009-12-21 18:19:17 +00005760 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Douglas Gregorf267edd2010-06-15 21:38:40 +00005761
5762 if (isSFINAEContext())
5763 return QualType();
5764
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005765 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lType, CK_BitCast);
Fariborz Jahanianffc420c2009-12-21 18:19:17 +00005766 return ResultTy;
5767 }
5768 }
Anders Carlssona95069c2010-11-04 03:17:43 +00005769
Douglas Gregor5b07c7e2009-05-04 06:07:12 +00005770 // C++ [expr.rel]p2:
5771 // [...] Pointer conversions (4.10) and qualification
5772 // conversions (4.4) are performed on pointer operands (or on
5773 // a pointer operand and a null pointer constant) to bring
5774 // them to their composite pointer type. [...]
5775 //
Douglas Gregorb00b10e2009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005776 // C++ [expr.eq]p1 uses the same notion for (in)equality
Douglas Gregor5b07c7e2009-05-04 06:07:12 +00005777 // comparisons of pointers.
Douglas Gregor6f5f6422010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005778 bool NonStandardCompositeType = false;
Douglas Gregor19175ff2010-04-16 23:20:25 +00005779 QualType T = FindCompositePointerType(Loc, lex, rex,
Douglas Gregor6f5f6422010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005780 isSFINAEContext()? 0 : &NonStandardCompositeType);
Douglas Gregor5b07c7e2009-05-04 06:07:12 +00005781 if (T.isNull()) {
5782 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_pointers)
5783 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
5784 return QualType();
Douglas Gregor6f5f6422010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005785 } else if (NonStandardCompositeType) {
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005786 Diag(Loc,
Douglas Gregor6f5f6422010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005787 diag::ext_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_pointers_nonstandard)
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005788 << lType << rType << T
Douglas Gregor6f5f6422010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005789 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Douglas Gregor5b07c7e2009-05-04 06:07:12 +00005790 }
5791
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005792 ImpCastExprToType(lex, T, CK_BitCast);
5793 ImpCastExprToType(rex, T, CK_BitCast);
Douglas Gregor5b07c7e2009-05-04 06:07:12 +00005794 return ResultTy;
5795 }
Eli Friedman16c209612009-08-23 00:27:47 +00005796 // C99 6.5.9p2 and C99 6.5.8p2
5797 if (Context.typesAreCompatible(LCanPointeeTy.getUnqualifiedType(),
5798 RCanPointeeTy.getUnqualifiedType())) {
5799 // Valid unless a relational comparison of function pointers
5800 if (isRelational && LCanPointeeTy->isFunctionType()) {
5801 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_typecheck_ordered_comparison_of_function_pointers)
5802 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
5803 }
5804 } else if (!isRelational &&
5805 (LCanPointeeTy->isVoidType() || RCanPointeeTy->isVoidType())) {
5806 // Valid unless comparison between non-null pointer and function pointer
5807 if ((LCanPointeeTy->isFunctionType() || RCanPointeeTy->isFunctionType())
5808 && !LHSIsNull && !RHSIsNull) {
5809 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_typecheck_comparison_of_fptr_to_void)
5810 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
5811 }
5812 } else {
5813 // Invalid
Chris Lattner377d1f82008-11-18 22:52:51 +00005814 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_pointers)
Chris Lattner1e5665e2008-11-24 06:25:27 +00005815 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroff75c17232007-06-13 21:41:08 +00005816 }
Eli Friedman16c209612009-08-23 00:27:47 +00005817 if (LCanPointeeTy != RCanPointeeTy)
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005818 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lType, CK_BitCast);
Douglas Gregorca63811b2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005819 return ResultTy;
Steve Naroffcdee44c2007-08-16 21:48:38 +00005820 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005821
Sebastian Redl576fd422009-05-10 18:38:11 +00005822 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
Anders Carlssona95069c2010-11-04 03:17:43 +00005823 // Comparison of nullptr_t with itself.
5824 if (lType->isNullPtrType() && rType->isNullPtrType())
5825 return ResultTy;
5826
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005827 // Comparison of pointers with null pointer constants and equality
Douglas Gregorb00b10e2009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005828 // comparisons of member pointers to null pointer constants.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005829 if (RHSIsNull &&
Anders Carlssona95069c2010-11-04 03:17:43 +00005830 ((lType->isPointerType() || lType->isNullPtrType()) ||
Douglas Gregorb00b10e2009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005831 (!isRelational && lType->isMemberPointerType()))) {
Douglas Gregorf58ff322010-08-07 13:36:37 +00005832 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lType,
5833 lType->isMemberPointerType()
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005834 ? CK_NullToMemberPointer
John McCalle84af4e2010-11-13 01:35:44 +00005835 : CK_NullToPointer);
Sebastian Redl576fd422009-05-10 18:38:11 +00005836 return ResultTy;
5837 }
Douglas Gregorb00b10e2009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005838 if (LHSIsNull &&
Anders Carlssona95069c2010-11-04 03:17:43 +00005839 ((rType->isPointerType() || rType->isNullPtrType()) ||
Douglas Gregorb00b10e2009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005840 (!isRelational && rType->isMemberPointerType()))) {
Douglas Gregorf58ff322010-08-07 13:36:37 +00005841 ImpCastExprToType(lex, rType,
5842 rType->isMemberPointerType()
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005843 ? CK_NullToMemberPointer
John McCalle84af4e2010-11-13 01:35:44 +00005844 : CK_NullToPointer);
Sebastian Redl576fd422009-05-10 18:38:11 +00005845 return ResultTy;
5846 }
Douglas Gregorb00b10e2009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005847
5848 // Comparison of member pointers.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005849 if (!isRelational &&
Douglas Gregorb00b10e2009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005850 lType->isMemberPointerType() && rType->isMemberPointerType()) {
5851 // C++ [expr.eq]p2:
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005852 // In addition, pointers to members can be compared, or a pointer to
5853 // member and a null pointer constant. Pointer to member conversions
5854 // (4.11) and qualification conversions (4.4) are performed to bring
5855 // them to a common type. If one operand is a null pointer constant,
5856 // the common type is the type of the other operand. Otherwise, the
5857 // common type is a pointer to member type similar (4.4) to the type
5858 // of one of the operands, with a cv-qualification signature (4.4)
5859 // that is the union of the cv-qualification signatures of the operand
Douglas Gregorb00b10e2009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005860 // types.
Douglas Gregor6f5f6422010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005861 bool NonStandardCompositeType = false;
Douglas Gregor19175ff2010-04-16 23:20:25 +00005862 QualType T = FindCompositePointerType(Loc, lex, rex,
Douglas Gregor6f5f6422010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005863 isSFINAEContext()? 0 : &NonStandardCompositeType);
Douglas Gregorb00b10e2009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005864 if (T.isNull()) {
5865 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_pointers)
Douglas Gregor6f5f6422010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005866 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Douglas Gregorb00b10e2009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005867 return QualType();
Douglas Gregor6f5f6422010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005868 } else if (NonStandardCompositeType) {
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005869 Diag(Loc,
Douglas Gregor6f5f6422010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005870 diag::ext_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_pointers_nonstandard)
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005871 << lType << rType << T
Douglas Gregor6f5f6422010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005872 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Douglas Gregorb00b10e2009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005873 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005874
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005875 ImpCastExprToType(lex, T, CK_BitCast);
5876 ImpCastExprToType(rex, T, CK_BitCast);
Douglas Gregorb00b10e2009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005877 return ResultTy;
5878 }
Sebastian Redl576fd422009-05-10 18:38:11 +00005879 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005880
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00005881 // Handle block pointer types.
Mike Stump1b821b42009-05-07 03:14:14 +00005882 if (!isRelational && lType->isBlockPointerType() && rType->isBlockPointerType()) {
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00005883 QualType lpointee = lType->getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
5884 QualType rpointee = rType->getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005885
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00005886 if (!LHSIsNull && !RHSIsNull &&
Eli Friedmana6638ca2009-06-08 05:08:54 +00005887 !Context.typesAreCompatible(lpointee, rpointee)) {
Chris Lattner377d1f82008-11-18 22:52:51 +00005888 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_blocks)
Chris Lattner1e5665e2008-11-24 06:25:27 +00005889 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00005890 }
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005891 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lType, CK_BitCast);
Douglas Gregorca63811b2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005892 return ResultTy;
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00005893 }
Steve Naroffe18f94c2008-09-28 01:11:11 +00005894 // Allow block pointers to be compared with null pointer constants.
Mike Stump1b821b42009-05-07 03:14:14 +00005895 if (!isRelational
5896 && ((lType->isBlockPointerType() && rType->isPointerType())
5897 || (lType->isPointerType() && rType->isBlockPointerType()))) {
Steve Naroffe18f94c2008-09-28 01:11:11 +00005898 if (!LHSIsNull && !RHSIsNull) {
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00005899 if (!((rType->isPointerType() && rType->getAs<PointerType>()
Mike Stump1b821b42009-05-07 03:14:14 +00005900 ->getPointeeType()->isVoidType())
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00005901 || (lType->isPointerType() && lType->getAs<PointerType>()
Mike Stump1b821b42009-05-07 03:14:14 +00005902 ->getPointeeType()->isVoidType())))
5903 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_blocks)
5904 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroffe18f94c2008-09-28 01:11:11 +00005905 }
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005906 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lType, CK_BitCast);
Douglas Gregorca63811b2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005907 return ResultTy;
Steve Naroffe18f94c2008-09-28 01:11:11 +00005908 }
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00005909
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00005910 if ((lType->isObjCObjectPointerType() || rType->isObjCObjectPointerType())) {
Steve Naroff1d4a9a32008-10-27 10:33:19 +00005911 if (lType->isPointerType() || rType->isPointerType()) {
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00005912 const PointerType *LPT = lType->getAs<PointerType>();
5913 const PointerType *RPT = rType->getAs<PointerType>();
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005914 bool LPtrToVoid = LPT ?
Steve Naroff753567f2008-11-17 19:49:16 +00005915 Context.getCanonicalType(LPT->getPointeeType())->isVoidType() : false;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005916 bool RPtrToVoid = RPT ?
Steve Naroff753567f2008-11-17 19:49:16 +00005917 Context.getCanonicalType(RPT->getPointeeType())->isVoidType() : false;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005918
Steve Naroff753567f2008-11-17 19:49:16 +00005919 if (!LPtrToVoid && !RPtrToVoid &&
5920 !Context.typesAreCompatible(lType, rType)) {
Chris Lattner377d1f82008-11-18 22:52:51 +00005921 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_pointers)
Chris Lattner1e5665e2008-11-24 06:25:27 +00005922 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroff1d4a9a32008-10-27 10:33:19 +00005923 }
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005924 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lType, CK_BitCast);
Douglas Gregorca63811b2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005925 return ResultTy;
Steve Naroffea54d9e2008-10-20 18:19:10 +00005926 }
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00005927 if (lType->isObjCObjectPointerType() && rType->isObjCObjectPointerType()) {
Chris Lattnerf8344db2009-08-22 18:58:31 +00005928 if (!Context.areComparableObjCPointerTypes(lType, rType))
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00005929 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_pointers)
5930 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005931 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lType, CK_BitCast);
Douglas Gregorca63811b2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005932 return ResultTy;
Steve Naroffb788d9b2008-06-03 14:04:54 +00005933 }
Fariborz Jahanian134cbef2007-12-20 01:06:58 +00005934 }
Douglas Gregorf267edd2010-06-15 21:38:40 +00005935 if ((lType->isAnyPointerType() && rType->isIntegerType()) ||
5936 (lType->isIntegerType() && rType->isAnyPointerType())) {
Chris Lattnerd99bd522009-08-23 00:03:44 +00005937 unsigned DiagID = 0;
Douglas Gregorf267edd2010-06-15 21:38:40 +00005938 bool isError = false;
5939 if ((LHSIsNull && lType->isIntegerType()) ||
5940 (RHSIsNull && rType->isIntegerType())) {
5941 if (isRelational && !getLangOptions().CPlusPlus)
Chris Lattnerd99bd522009-08-23 00:03:44 +00005942 DiagID = diag::ext_typecheck_ordered_comparison_of_pointer_and_zero;
Douglas Gregorf267edd2010-06-15 21:38:40 +00005943 } else if (isRelational && !getLangOptions().CPlusPlus)
Chris Lattnerd99bd522009-08-23 00:03:44 +00005944 DiagID = diag::ext_typecheck_ordered_comparison_of_pointer_integer;
Douglas Gregorf267edd2010-06-15 21:38:40 +00005945 else if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
5946 DiagID = diag::err_typecheck_comparison_of_pointer_integer;
5947 isError = true;
5948 } else
Chris Lattnerd99bd522009-08-23 00:03:44 +00005949 DiagID = diag::ext_typecheck_comparison_of_pointer_integer;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005950
Chris Lattnerd99bd522009-08-23 00:03:44 +00005951 if (DiagID) {
Chris Lattnerf8344db2009-08-22 18:58:31 +00005952 Diag(Loc, DiagID)
Chris Lattnerd466ea12009-06-30 06:24:05 +00005953 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Douglas Gregorf267edd2010-06-15 21:38:40 +00005954 if (isError)
5955 return QualType();
Chris Lattnerf8344db2009-08-22 18:58:31 +00005956 }
Douglas Gregorf267edd2010-06-15 21:38:40 +00005957
5958 if (lType->isIntegerType())
John McCalle84af4e2010-11-13 01:35:44 +00005959 ImpCastExprToType(lex, rType,
5960 LHSIsNull ? CK_NullToPointer : CK_IntegralToPointer);
Chris Lattnerd99bd522009-08-23 00:03:44 +00005961 else
John McCalle84af4e2010-11-13 01:35:44 +00005962 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lType,
5963 RHSIsNull ? CK_NullToPointer : CK_IntegralToPointer);
Douglas Gregorca63811b2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005964 return ResultTy;
Steve Naroff043d45d2007-05-15 02:32:35 +00005965 }
Douglas Gregorf267edd2010-06-15 21:38:40 +00005966
Steve Naroff4b191572008-09-04 16:56:14 +00005967 // Handle block pointers.
Mike Stumpf70bcf72009-05-07 18:43:07 +00005968 if (!isRelational && RHSIsNull
5969 && lType->isBlockPointerType() && rType->isIntegerType()) {
John McCalle84af4e2010-11-13 01:35:44 +00005970 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lType, CK_NullToPointer);
Douglas Gregorca63811b2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005971 return ResultTy;
Steve Naroff4b191572008-09-04 16:56:14 +00005972 }
Mike Stumpf70bcf72009-05-07 18:43:07 +00005973 if (!isRelational && LHSIsNull
5974 && lType->isIntegerType() && rType->isBlockPointerType()) {
John McCalle84af4e2010-11-13 01:35:44 +00005975 ImpCastExprToType(lex, rType, CK_NullToPointer);
Douglas Gregorca63811b2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005976 return ResultTy;
Steve Naroff4b191572008-09-04 16:56:14 +00005977 }
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005978 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Steve Naroff26c8ea52007-03-21 21:08:52 +00005979}
5980
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005981/// CheckVectorCompareOperands - vector comparisons are a clang extension that
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005982/// operates on extended vector types. Instead of producing an IntTy result,
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005983/// like a scalar comparison, a vector comparison produces a vector of integer
5984/// types.
5985QualType Sema::CheckVectorCompareOperands(Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex,
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005986 SourceLocation Loc,
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005987 bool isRelational) {
5988 // Check to make sure we're operating on vectors of the same type and width,
5989 // Allowing one side to be a scalar of element type.
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005990 QualType vType = CheckVectorOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005991 if (vType.isNull())
5992 return vType;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005993
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005994 QualType lType = lex->getType();
5995 QualType rType = rex->getType();
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005996
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005997 // For non-floating point types, check for self-comparisons of the form
5998 // x == x, x != x, x < x, etc. These always evaluate to a constant, and
5999 // often indicate logic errors in the program.
Douglas Gregor4ffbad12010-06-22 22:12:46 +00006000 if (!lType->hasFloatingRepresentation()) {
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00006001 if (DeclRefExpr* DRL = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(lex->IgnoreParens()))
6002 if (DeclRefExpr* DRR = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(rex->IgnoreParens()))
6003 if (DRL->getDecl() == DRR->getDecl())
Douglas Gregorec170db2010-06-08 19:50:34 +00006004 DiagRuntimeBehavior(Loc,
6005 PDiag(diag::warn_comparison_always)
6006 << 0 // self-
6007 << 2 // "a constant"
6008 );
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00006009 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006010
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00006011 // Check for comparisons of floating point operands using != and ==.
Douglas Gregor4ffbad12010-06-22 22:12:46 +00006012 if (!isRelational && lType->hasFloatingRepresentation()) {
6013 assert (rType->hasFloatingRepresentation());
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00006014 CheckFloatComparison(Loc,lex,rex);
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00006015 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006016
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00006017 // Return the type for the comparison, which is the same as vector type for
6018 // integer vectors, or an integer type of identical size and number of
6019 // elements for floating point vectors.
Douglas Gregor5cc2c8b2010-07-23 15:58:24 +00006020 if (lType->hasIntegerRepresentation())
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00006021 return lType;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006022
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00006023 const VectorType *VTy = lType->getAs<VectorType>();
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00006024 unsigned TypeSize = Context.getTypeSize(VTy->getElementType());
Nate Begeman2f2bdeb2009-01-18 03:20:47 +00006025 if (TypeSize == Context.getTypeSize(Context.IntTy))
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00006026 return Context.getExtVectorType(Context.IntTy, VTy->getNumElements());
Chris Lattner5d688962009-03-31 07:46:52 +00006027 if (TypeSize == Context.getTypeSize(Context.LongTy))
Nate Begeman2f2bdeb2009-01-18 03:20:47 +00006028 return Context.getExtVectorType(Context.LongTy, VTy->getNumElements());
6029
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006030 assert(TypeSize == Context.getTypeSize(Context.LongLongTy) &&
Nate Begeman2f2bdeb2009-01-18 03:20:47 +00006031 "Unhandled vector element size in vector compare");
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00006032 return Context.getExtVectorType(Context.LongLongTy, VTy->getNumElements());
6033}
6034
Steve Naroff218bc2b2007-05-04 21:54:46 +00006035inline QualType Sema::CheckBitwiseOperands(
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006036 Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex, SourceLocation Loc, bool isCompAssign) {
Douglas Gregor5cc2c8b2010-07-23 15:58:24 +00006037 if (lex->getType()->isVectorType() || rex->getType()->isVectorType()) {
6038 if (lex->getType()->hasIntegerRepresentation() &&
6039 rex->getType()->hasIntegerRepresentation())
6040 return CheckVectorOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
6041
6042 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
6043 }
Steve Naroffb8ea4fb2007-07-13 23:32:42 +00006044
Steve Naroffbe4c4d12007-08-24 19:07:16 +00006045 QualType compType = UsualArithmeticConversions(lex, rex, isCompAssign);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006046
Douglas Gregor0bf31402010-10-08 23:50:27 +00006047 if (lex->getType()->isIntegralOrUnscopedEnumerationType() &&
6048 rex->getType()->isIntegralOrUnscopedEnumerationType())
Steve Naroffbe4c4d12007-08-24 19:07:16 +00006049 return compType;
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00006050 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Steve Naroff26c8ea52007-03-21 21:08:52 +00006051}
6052
Steve Naroff218bc2b2007-05-04 21:54:46 +00006053inline QualType Sema::CheckLogicalOperands( // C99 6.5.[13,14]
Chris Lattner8406c512010-07-13 19:41:32 +00006054 Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex, SourceLocation Loc, unsigned Opc) {
6055
6056 // Diagnose cases where the user write a logical and/or but probably meant a
6057 // bitwise one. We do this when the LHS is a non-bool integer and the RHS
6058 // is a constant.
6059 if (lex->getType()->isIntegerType() && !lex->getType()->isBooleanType() &&
Eli Friedman6b197e02010-07-27 19:14:53 +00006060 rex->getType()->isIntegerType() && !rex->isValueDependent() &&
Chris Lattnerdeee7a32010-07-15 00:26:43 +00006061 // Don't warn in macros.
Chris Lattner938533d2010-07-24 01:10:11 +00006062 !Loc.isMacroID()) {
6063 // If the RHS can be constant folded, and if it constant folds to something
6064 // that isn't 0 or 1 (which indicate a potential logical operation that
6065 // happened to fold to true/false) then warn.
6066 Expr::EvalResult Result;
6067 if (rex->Evaluate(Result, Context) && !Result.HasSideEffects &&
6068 Result.Val.getInt() != 0 && Result.Val.getInt() != 1) {
6069 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_logical_instead_of_bitwise)
6070 << rex->getSourceRange()
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006071 << (Opc == BO_LAnd ? "&&" : "||")
6072 << (Opc == BO_LAnd ? "&" : "|");
Chris Lattner938533d2010-07-24 01:10:11 +00006073 }
6074 }
Chris Lattner8406c512010-07-13 19:41:32 +00006075
Anders Carlsson2e7bc112009-11-23 21:47:44 +00006076 if (!Context.getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
6077 UsualUnaryConversions(lex);
6078 UsualUnaryConversions(rex);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006079
Anders Carlsson2e7bc112009-11-23 21:47:44 +00006080 if (!lex->getType()->isScalarType() || !rex->getType()->isScalarType())
6081 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00006082
Anders Carlsson2e7bc112009-11-23 21:47:44 +00006083 return Context.IntTy;
Anders Carlsson35a99d92009-10-16 01:44:21 +00006084 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00006085
John McCall4a2429a2010-06-04 00:29:51 +00006086 // The following is safe because we only use this method for
6087 // non-overloadable operands.
6088
Anders Carlsson2e7bc112009-11-23 21:47:44 +00006089 // C++ [expr.log.and]p1
6090 // C++ [expr.log.or]p1
John McCall4a2429a2010-06-04 00:29:51 +00006091 // The operands are both contextually converted to type bool.
6092 if (PerformContextuallyConvertToBool(lex) ||
6093 PerformContextuallyConvertToBool(rex))
Anders Carlsson2e7bc112009-11-23 21:47:44 +00006094 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00006095
Anders Carlsson2e7bc112009-11-23 21:47:44 +00006096 // C++ [expr.log.and]p2
6097 // C++ [expr.log.or]p2
6098 // The result is a bool.
6099 return Context.BoolTy;
Steve Naroffae4143e2007-04-26 20:39:23 +00006100}
6101
Fariborz Jahanian8e1555c2009-01-12 19:55:42 +00006102/// IsReadonlyProperty - Verify that otherwise a valid l-value expression
6103/// is a read-only property; return true if so. A readonly property expression
6104/// depends on various declarations and thus must be treated specially.
6105///
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006106static bool IsReadonlyProperty(Expr *E, Sema &S) {
Fariborz Jahanian8e1555c2009-01-12 19:55:42 +00006107 if (E->getStmtClass() == Expr::ObjCPropertyRefExprClass) {
6108 const ObjCPropertyRefExpr* PropExpr = cast<ObjCPropertyRefExpr>(E);
6109 if (ObjCPropertyDecl *PDecl = PropExpr->getProperty()) {
Fariborz Jahanian681c0752010-10-14 16:04:05 +00006110 QualType BaseType = PropExpr->isSuperReceiver() ?
6111 PropExpr->getSuperType() :
6112 PropExpr->getBase()->getType();
6113
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006114 if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *OPT =
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00006115 BaseType->getAsObjCInterfacePointerType())
6116 if (ObjCInterfaceDecl *IFace = OPT->getInterfaceDecl())
6117 if (S.isPropertyReadonly(PDecl, IFace))
6118 return true;
Fariborz Jahanian8e1555c2009-01-12 19:55:42 +00006119 }
6120 }
6121 return false;
6122}
6123
Chris Lattner30bd3272008-11-18 01:22:49 +00006124/// CheckForModifiableLvalue - Verify that E is a modifiable lvalue. If not,
6125/// emit an error and return true. If so, return false.
6126static bool CheckForModifiableLvalue(Expr *E, SourceLocation Loc, Sema &S) {
Daniel Dunbarc2223ab2009-04-15 00:08:05 +00006127 SourceLocation OrigLoc = Loc;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006128 Expr::isModifiableLvalueResult IsLV = E->isModifiableLvalue(S.Context,
Daniel Dunbarc2223ab2009-04-15 00:08:05 +00006129 &Loc);
Fariborz Jahanian8e1555c2009-01-12 19:55:42 +00006130 if (IsLV == Expr::MLV_Valid && IsReadonlyProperty(E, S))
6131 IsLV = Expr::MLV_ReadonlyProperty;
Chris Lattner30bd3272008-11-18 01:22:49 +00006132 if (IsLV == Expr::MLV_Valid)
6133 return false;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006134
Chris Lattner30bd3272008-11-18 01:22:49 +00006135 unsigned Diag = 0;
6136 bool NeedType = false;
6137 switch (IsLV) { // C99 6.5.16p2
Chris Lattner30bd3272008-11-18 01:22:49 +00006138 case Expr::MLV_ConstQualified: Diag = diag::err_typecheck_assign_const; break;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006139 case Expr::MLV_ArrayType:
Chris Lattner30bd3272008-11-18 01:22:49 +00006140 Diag = diag::err_typecheck_array_not_modifiable_lvalue;
6141 NeedType = true;
6142 break;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006143 case Expr::MLV_NotObjectType:
Chris Lattner30bd3272008-11-18 01:22:49 +00006144 Diag = diag::err_typecheck_non_object_not_modifiable_lvalue;
6145 NeedType = true;
6146 break;
Chris Lattner9b3bbe92008-11-17 19:51:54 +00006147 case Expr::MLV_LValueCast:
Chris Lattner30bd3272008-11-18 01:22:49 +00006148 Diag = diag::err_typecheck_lvalue_casts_not_supported;
6149 break;
Douglas Gregorb154fdc2010-02-16 21:39:57 +00006150 case Expr::MLV_Valid:
6151 llvm_unreachable("did not take early return for MLV_Valid");
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00006152 case Expr::MLV_InvalidExpression:
Douglas Gregorb154fdc2010-02-16 21:39:57 +00006153 case Expr::MLV_MemberFunction:
6154 case Expr::MLV_ClassTemporary:
Chris Lattner30bd3272008-11-18 01:22:49 +00006155 Diag = diag::err_typecheck_expression_not_modifiable_lvalue;
6156 break;
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00006157 case Expr::MLV_IncompleteType:
6158 case Expr::MLV_IncompleteVoidType:
Douglas Gregored0cfbd2009-03-09 16:13:40 +00006159 return S.RequireCompleteType(Loc, E->getType(),
Douglas Gregor89336232010-03-29 23:34:08 +00006160 S.PDiag(diag::err_typecheck_incomplete_type_not_modifiable_lvalue)
Anders Carlssond624e162009-08-26 23:45:07 +00006161 << E->getSourceRange());
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00006162 case Expr::MLV_DuplicateVectorComponents:
Chris Lattner30bd3272008-11-18 01:22:49 +00006163 Diag = diag::err_typecheck_duplicate_vector_components_not_mlvalue;
6164 break;
Steve Naroffba756cb2008-09-26 14:41:28 +00006165 case Expr::MLV_NotBlockQualified:
Chris Lattner30bd3272008-11-18 01:22:49 +00006166 Diag = diag::err_block_decl_ref_not_modifiable_lvalue;
6167 break;
Fariborz Jahanian8a1810f2008-11-22 18:39:36 +00006168 case Expr::MLV_ReadonlyProperty:
6169 Diag = diag::error_readonly_property_assignment;
6170 break;
Fariborz Jahanian5118c412008-11-22 20:25:50 +00006171 case Expr::MLV_NoSetterProperty:
6172 Diag = diag::error_nosetter_property_assignment;
6173 break;
Fariborz Jahaniane8d28902009-12-15 23:59:41 +00006174 case Expr::MLV_SubObjCPropertySetting:
6175 Diag = diag::error_no_subobject_property_setting;
6176 break;
Steve Naroff218bc2b2007-05-04 21:54:46 +00006177 }
Steve Naroffad373bd2007-07-31 12:34:36 +00006178
Daniel Dunbarc2223ab2009-04-15 00:08:05 +00006179 SourceRange Assign;
6180 if (Loc != OrigLoc)
6181 Assign = SourceRange(OrigLoc, OrigLoc);
Chris Lattner30bd3272008-11-18 01:22:49 +00006182 if (NeedType)
Daniel Dunbarc2223ab2009-04-15 00:08:05 +00006183 S.Diag(Loc, Diag) << E->getType() << E->getSourceRange() << Assign;
Chris Lattner30bd3272008-11-18 01:22:49 +00006184 else
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006185 S.Diag(Loc, Diag) << E->getSourceRange() << Assign;
Chris Lattner30bd3272008-11-18 01:22:49 +00006186 return true;
6187}
6188
6189
6190
6191// C99 6.5.16.1
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00006192QualType Sema::CheckAssignmentOperands(Expr *LHS, Expr *&RHS,
6193 SourceLocation Loc,
6194 QualType CompoundType) {
6195 // Verify that LHS is a modifiable lvalue, and emit error if not.
6196 if (CheckForModifiableLvalue(LHS, Loc, *this))
Chris Lattner30bd3272008-11-18 01:22:49 +00006197 return QualType();
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00006198
6199 QualType LHSType = LHS->getType();
6200 QualType RHSType = CompoundType.isNull() ? RHS->getType() : CompoundType;
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00006201 AssignConvertType ConvTy;
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00006202 if (CompoundType.isNull()) {
Fariborz Jahanianbe21aa32010-06-07 22:02:01 +00006203 QualType LHSTy(LHSType);
Chris Lattnerea714382008-08-21 18:04:13 +00006204 // Simple assignment "x = y".
Fariborz Jahanian805b74e2010-09-14 23:02:38 +00006205 ConvertPropertyAssignment(LHS, RHS, LHSTy);
Fariborz Jahanianbe21aa32010-06-07 22:02:01 +00006206 ConvTy = CheckSingleAssignmentConstraints(LHSTy, RHS);
Fariborz Jahanian255c0952009-01-13 23:34:40 +00006207 // Special case of NSObject attributes on c-style pointer types.
6208 if (ConvTy == IncompatiblePointer &&
6209 ((Context.isObjCNSObjectType(LHSType) &&
Steve Naroff79d12152009-07-16 15:41:00 +00006210 RHSType->isObjCObjectPointerType()) ||
Fariborz Jahanian255c0952009-01-13 23:34:40 +00006211 (Context.isObjCNSObjectType(RHSType) &&
Steve Naroff79d12152009-07-16 15:41:00 +00006212 LHSType->isObjCObjectPointerType())))
Fariborz Jahanian255c0952009-01-13 23:34:40 +00006213 ConvTy = Compatible;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006214
Chris Lattnerea714382008-08-21 18:04:13 +00006215 // If the RHS is a unary plus or minus, check to see if they = and + are
6216 // right next to each other. If so, the user may have typo'd "x =+ 4"
6217 // instead of "x += 4".
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00006218 Expr *RHSCheck = RHS;
Chris Lattnerea714382008-08-21 18:04:13 +00006219 if (ImplicitCastExpr *ICE = dyn_cast<ImplicitCastExpr>(RHSCheck))
6220 RHSCheck = ICE->getSubExpr();
6221 if (UnaryOperator *UO = dyn_cast<UnaryOperator>(RHSCheck)) {
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006222 if ((UO->getOpcode() == UO_Plus ||
6223 UO->getOpcode() == UO_Minus) &&
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00006224 Loc.isFileID() && UO->getOperatorLoc().isFileID() &&
Chris Lattnerea714382008-08-21 18:04:13 +00006225 // Only if the two operators are exactly adjacent.
Chris Lattner36c39c92009-03-08 06:51:10 +00006226 Loc.getFileLocWithOffset(1) == UO->getOperatorLoc() &&
6227 // And there is a space or other character before the subexpr of the
6228 // unary +/-. We don't want to warn on "x=-1".
Chris Lattnered9f14c2009-03-09 07:11:10 +00006229 Loc.getFileLocWithOffset(2) != UO->getSubExpr()->getLocStart() &&
6230 UO->getSubExpr()->getLocStart().isFileID()) {
Chris Lattner29e812b2008-11-20 06:06:08 +00006231 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_not_compound_assign)
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006232 << (UO->getOpcode() == UO_Plus ? "+" : "-")
Chris Lattner29e812b2008-11-20 06:06:08 +00006233 << SourceRange(UO->getOperatorLoc(), UO->getOperatorLoc());
Chris Lattner36c39c92009-03-08 06:51:10 +00006234 }
Chris Lattnerea714382008-08-21 18:04:13 +00006235 }
6236 } else {
6237 // Compound assignment "x += y"
Eli Friedmanb05c41e2009-05-16 05:56:02 +00006238 ConvTy = CheckAssignmentConstraints(LHSType, RHSType);
Chris Lattnerea714382008-08-21 18:04:13 +00006239 }
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00006240
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00006241 if (DiagnoseAssignmentResult(ConvTy, Loc, LHSType, RHSType,
Douglas Gregor7c3bbdf2009-12-16 03:45:30 +00006242 RHS, AA_Assigning))
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00006243 return QualType();
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006244
Chris Lattner39561062010-07-07 06:14:23 +00006245
6246 // Check to see if the destination operand is a dereferenced null pointer. If
6247 // so, and if not volatile-qualified, this is undefined behavior that the
6248 // optimizer will delete, so warn about it. People sometimes try to use this
6249 // to get a deterministic trap and are surprised by clang's behavior. This
6250 // only handles the pattern "*null = whatever", which is a very syntactic
6251 // check.
6252 if (UnaryOperator *UO = dyn_cast<UnaryOperator>(LHS->IgnoreParenCasts()))
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006253 if (UO->getOpcode() == UO_Deref &&
Chris Lattner39561062010-07-07 06:14:23 +00006254 UO->getSubExpr()->IgnoreParenCasts()->
6255 isNullPointerConstant(Context, Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNotNull) &&
6256 !UO->getType().isVolatileQualified()) {
6257 Diag(UO->getOperatorLoc(), diag::warn_indirection_through_null)
6258 << UO->getSubExpr()->getSourceRange();
6259 Diag(UO->getOperatorLoc(), diag::note_indirection_through_null);
6260 }
6261
Steve Naroff98cf3e92007-06-06 18:38:38 +00006262 // C99 6.5.16p3: The type of an assignment expression is the type of the
6263 // left operand unless the left operand has qualified type, in which case
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006264 // it is the unqualified version of the type of the left operand.
Steve Naroff98cf3e92007-06-06 18:38:38 +00006265 // C99 6.5.16.1p2: In simple assignment, the value of the right operand
6266 // is converted to the type of the assignment expression (above).
Chris Lattnerf17bd422007-08-30 17:45:32 +00006267 // C++ 5.17p1: the type of the assignment expression is that of its left
Douglas Gregord2c2d172009-05-02 00:36:19 +00006268 // operand.
John McCall01cbf2d2010-10-12 02:19:57 +00006269 return (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus
6270 ? LHSType : LHSType.getUnqualifiedType());
Steve Naroffae4143e2007-04-26 20:39:23 +00006271}
6272
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00006273// C99 6.5.17
6274QualType Sema::CheckCommaOperands(Expr *LHS, Expr *&RHS, SourceLocation Loc) {
Argyrios Kyrtzidis639ffb02010-06-30 10:53:14 +00006275 DiagnoseUnusedExprResult(LHS);
6276
Douglas Gregor0124e9b2010-11-09 21:07:58 +00006277 ExprResult LHSResult = CheckPlaceholderExpr(LHS, Loc);
6278 if (LHSResult.isInvalid())
6279 return QualType();
6280
6281 ExprResult RHSResult = CheckPlaceholderExpr(RHS, Loc);
6282 if (RHSResult.isInvalid())
6283 return QualType();
6284 RHS = RHSResult.take();
6285
John McCall73d36182010-10-12 07:14:40 +00006286 // C's comma performs lvalue conversion (C99 6.3.2.1) on both its
6287 // operands, but not unary promotions.
6288 // C++'s comma does not do any conversions at all (C++ [expr.comma]p1).
6289 if (!getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
6290 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(LHS);
6291 if (!LHS->getType()->isVoidType())
6292 RequireCompleteType(Loc, LHS->getType(), diag::err_incomplete_type);
Eli Friedmanba961a92009-03-23 00:24:07 +00006293
John McCall73d36182010-10-12 07:14:40 +00006294 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(RHS);
6295 if (!RHS->getType()->isVoidType())
6296 RequireCompleteType(Loc, RHS->getType(), diag::err_incomplete_type);
6297 }
Eli Friedmanba961a92009-03-23 00:24:07 +00006298
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00006299 return RHS->getType();
Steve Naroff95af0132007-03-30 23:47:58 +00006300}
6301
Steve Naroff7a5af782007-07-13 16:58:59 +00006302/// CheckIncrementDecrementOperand - unlike most "Check" methods, this routine
6303/// doesn't need to call UsualUnaryConversions or UsualArithmeticConversions.
Sebastian Redle10c2c32008-12-20 09:35:34 +00006304QualType Sema::CheckIncrementDecrementOperand(Expr *Op, SourceLocation OpLoc,
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00006305 bool isInc, bool isPrefix) {
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006306 if (Op->isTypeDependent())
6307 return Context.DependentTy;
6308
Chris Lattner6b0cf142008-11-21 07:05:48 +00006309 QualType ResType = Op->getType();
6310 assert(!ResType.isNull() && "no type for increment/decrement expression");
Steve Naroffd50c88e2007-04-05 21:15:20 +00006311
Sebastian Redle10c2c32008-12-20 09:35:34 +00006312 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus && ResType->isBooleanType()) {
6313 // Decrement of bool is not allowed.
6314 if (!isInc) {
6315 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_decrement_bool) << Op->getSourceRange();
6316 return QualType();
6317 }
6318 // Increment of bool sets it to true, but is deprecated.
6319 Diag(OpLoc, diag::warn_increment_bool) << Op->getSourceRange();
6320 } else if (ResType->isRealType()) {
Chris Lattner6b0cf142008-11-21 07:05:48 +00006321 // OK!
Steve Naroff6b712a72009-07-14 18:25:06 +00006322 } else if (ResType->isAnyPointerType()) {
6323 QualType PointeeTy = ResType->getPointeeType();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006324
Chris Lattner6b0cf142008-11-21 07:05:48 +00006325 // C99 6.5.2.4p2, 6.5.6p2
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00006326 if (PointeeTy->isVoidType()) {
Douglas Gregorf6cd9282009-01-23 00:36:41 +00006327 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
6328 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_pointer_arith_void_type)
6329 << Op->getSourceRange();
6330 return QualType();
6331 }
6332
6333 // Pointer to void is a GNU extension in C.
Chris Lattner6b0cf142008-11-21 07:05:48 +00006334 Diag(OpLoc, diag::ext_gnu_void_ptr) << Op->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00006335 } else if (PointeeTy->isFunctionType()) {
Douglas Gregorf6cd9282009-01-23 00:36:41 +00006336 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
6337 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_pointer_arith_function_type)
6338 << Op->getType() << Op->getSourceRange();
6339 return QualType();
6340 }
6341
6342 Diag(OpLoc, diag::ext_gnu_ptr_func_arith)
Chris Lattner1e5665e2008-11-24 06:25:27 +00006343 << ResType << Op->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00006344 } else if (RequireCompleteType(OpLoc, PointeeTy,
Anders Carlsson029fc692009-08-26 22:59:12 +00006345 PDiag(diag::err_typecheck_arithmetic_incomplete_type)
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006346 << Op->getSourceRange()
Anders Carlsson029fc692009-08-26 22:59:12 +00006347 << ResType))
Douglas Gregordd430f72009-01-19 19:26:10 +00006348 return QualType();
Fariborz Jahanianca75db72009-07-16 17:59:14 +00006349 // Diagnose bad cases where we step over interface counts.
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00006350 else if (PointeeTy->isObjCObjectType() && LangOpts.ObjCNonFragileABI) {
Fariborz Jahanianca75db72009-07-16 17:59:14 +00006351 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_arithmetic_nonfragile_interface)
6352 << PointeeTy << Op->getSourceRange();
6353 return QualType();
6354 }
Eli Friedman090addd2010-01-03 00:20:48 +00006355 } else if (ResType->isAnyComplexType()) {
Chris Lattner6b0cf142008-11-21 07:05:48 +00006356 // C99 does not support ++/-- on complex types, we allow as an extension.
6357 Diag(OpLoc, diag::ext_integer_increment_complex)
Chris Lattner1e5665e2008-11-24 06:25:27 +00006358 << ResType << Op->getSourceRange();
John McCall36226622010-10-12 02:09:17 +00006359 } else if (ResType->isPlaceholderType()) {
6360 ExprResult PR = CheckPlaceholderExpr(Op, OpLoc);
6361 if (PR.isInvalid()) return QualType();
6362 return CheckIncrementDecrementOperand(PR.take(), OpLoc, isInc, isPrefix);
Chris Lattner6b0cf142008-11-21 07:05:48 +00006363 } else {
6364 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_illegal_increment_decrement)
Douglas Gregor906db8a2009-12-15 16:44:32 +00006365 << ResType << int(isInc) << Op->getSourceRange();
Chris Lattner6b0cf142008-11-21 07:05:48 +00006366 return QualType();
Steve Naroff46ba1eb2007-04-03 23:13:13 +00006367 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006368 // At this point, we know we have a real, complex or pointer type.
Steve Naroff9e1e5512007-08-23 21:37:33 +00006369 // Now make sure the operand is a modifiable lvalue.
Chris Lattner6b0cf142008-11-21 07:05:48 +00006370 if (CheckForModifiableLvalue(Op, OpLoc, *this))
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006371 return QualType();
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00006372 // In C++, a prefix increment is the same type as the operand. Otherwise
6373 // (in C or with postfix), the increment is the unqualified type of the
6374 // operand.
6375 return isPrefix && getLangOptions().CPlusPlus
6376 ? ResType : ResType.getUnqualifiedType();
Steve Naroff26c8ea52007-03-21 21:08:52 +00006377}
6378
Fariborz Jahanian805b74e2010-09-14 23:02:38 +00006379void Sema::ConvertPropertyAssignment(Expr *LHS, Expr *&RHS, QualType& LHSTy) {
6380 bool copyInit = false;
6381 if (const ObjCImplicitSetterGetterRefExpr *OISGE =
6382 dyn_cast<ObjCImplicitSetterGetterRefExpr>(LHS)) {
6383 // If using property-dot syntax notation for assignment, and there is a
6384 // setter, RHS expression is being passed to the setter argument. So,
6385 // type conversion (and comparison) is RHS to setter's argument type.
6386 if (const ObjCMethodDecl *SetterMD = OISGE->getSetterMethod()) {
6387 ObjCMethodDecl::param_iterator P = SetterMD->param_begin();
6388 LHSTy = (*P)->getType();
6389 }
6390 copyInit = (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus && LHSTy->isRecordType());
6391 }
6392 else
6393 copyInit = (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus && isa<ObjCPropertyRefExpr>(LHS) &&
6394 LHSTy->isRecordType());
6395 if (copyInit) {
6396 InitializedEntity Entity =
Fariborz Jahanian8fb87ae2010-09-24 17:30:16 +00006397 InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(Context, LHSTy);
Fariborz Jahanian805b74e2010-09-14 23:02:38 +00006398 Expr *Arg = RHS;
6399 ExprResult ArgE = PerformCopyInitialization(Entity, SourceLocation(),
6400 Owned(Arg));
6401 if (!ArgE.isInvalid())
Fariborz Jahanian8fb87ae2010-09-24 17:30:16 +00006402 RHS = ArgE.takeAs<Expr>();
Fariborz Jahanian805b74e2010-09-14 23:02:38 +00006403 }
6404}
6405
6406
Anders Carlsson806700f2008-02-01 07:15:58 +00006407/// getPrimaryDecl - Helper function for CheckAddressOfOperand().
Steve Naroff47500512007-04-19 23:00:49 +00006408/// This routine allows us to typecheck complex/recursive expressions
Daniel Dunbarb692ef42008-08-04 20:02:37 +00006409/// where the declaration is needed for type checking. We only need to
6410/// handle cases when the expression references a function designator
6411/// or is an lvalue. Here are some examples:
6412/// - &(x) => x
6413/// - &*****f => f for f a function designator.
6414/// - &s.xx => s
6415/// - &s.zz[1].yy -> s, if zz is an array
6416/// - *(x + 1) -> x, if x is an array
6417/// - &"123"[2] -> 0
6418/// - & __real__ x -> x
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00006419static NamedDecl *getPrimaryDecl(Expr *E) {
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00006420 switch (E->getStmtClass()) {
Steve Naroff47500512007-04-19 23:00:49 +00006421 case Stmt::DeclRefExprClass:
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00006422 return cast<DeclRefExpr>(E)->getDecl();
Steve Naroff47500512007-04-19 23:00:49 +00006423 case Stmt::MemberExprClass:
Eli Friedman3a1e6922009-04-20 08:23:18 +00006424 // If this is an arrow operator, the address is an offset from
6425 // the base's value, so the object the base refers to is
6426 // irrelevant.
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00006427 if (cast<MemberExpr>(E)->isArrow())
Chris Lattner48d52842007-11-16 17:46:48 +00006428 return 0;
Eli Friedman3a1e6922009-04-20 08:23:18 +00006429 // Otherwise, the expression refers to a part of the base
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00006430 return getPrimaryDecl(cast<MemberExpr>(E)->getBase());
Anders Carlsson806700f2008-02-01 07:15:58 +00006431 case Stmt::ArraySubscriptExprClass: {
Mike Stump87c57ac2009-05-16 07:39:55 +00006432 // FIXME: This code shouldn't be necessary! We should catch the implicit
6433 // promotion of register arrays earlier.
Eli Friedman3a1e6922009-04-20 08:23:18 +00006434 Expr* Base = cast<ArraySubscriptExpr>(E)->getBase();
6435 if (ImplicitCastExpr* ICE = dyn_cast<ImplicitCastExpr>(Base)) {
6436 if (ICE->getSubExpr()->getType()->isArrayType())
6437 return getPrimaryDecl(ICE->getSubExpr());
6438 }
6439 return 0;
Anders Carlsson806700f2008-02-01 07:15:58 +00006440 }
Daniel Dunbarb692ef42008-08-04 20:02:37 +00006441 case Stmt::UnaryOperatorClass: {
6442 UnaryOperator *UO = cast<UnaryOperator>(E);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006443
Daniel Dunbarb692ef42008-08-04 20:02:37 +00006444 switch(UO->getOpcode()) {
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006445 case UO_Real:
6446 case UO_Imag:
6447 case UO_Extension:
Daniel Dunbarb692ef42008-08-04 20:02:37 +00006448 return getPrimaryDecl(UO->getSubExpr());
6449 default:
6450 return 0;
6451 }
6452 }
Steve Naroff47500512007-04-19 23:00:49 +00006453 case Stmt::ParenExprClass:
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00006454 return getPrimaryDecl(cast<ParenExpr>(E)->getSubExpr());
Chris Lattner48d52842007-11-16 17:46:48 +00006455 case Stmt::ImplicitCastExprClass:
Eli Friedman3a1e6922009-04-20 08:23:18 +00006456 // If the result of an implicit cast is an l-value, we care about
6457 // the sub-expression; otherwise, the result here doesn't matter.
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00006458 return getPrimaryDecl(cast<ImplicitCastExpr>(E)->getSubExpr());
Steve Naroff47500512007-04-19 23:00:49 +00006459 default:
6460 return 0;
6461 }
6462}
6463
6464/// CheckAddressOfOperand - The operand of & must be either a function
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006465/// designator or an lvalue designating an object. If it is an lvalue, the
Steve Naroff47500512007-04-19 23:00:49 +00006466/// object cannot be declared with storage class register or be a bit field.
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006467/// Note: The usual conversions are *not* applied to the operand of the &
Steve Naroffa78fe7e2007-05-16 19:47:19 +00006468/// operator (C99 6.3.2.1p[2-4]), and its result is never an lvalue.
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006469/// In C++, the operand might be an overloaded function name, in which case
Douglas Gregorcd695e52008-11-10 20:40:00 +00006470/// we allow the '&' but retain the overloaded-function type.
John McCall8d08b9b2010-08-27 09:08:28 +00006471QualType Sema::CheckAddressOfOperand(Expr *OrigOp, SourceLocation OpLoc) {
6472 if (OrigOp->isTypeDependent())
Douglas Gregor19b8c4f2008-12-17 22:52:20 +00006473 return Context.DependentTy;
John McCall8d08b9b2010-08-27 09:08:28 +00006474 if (OrigOp->getType() == Context.OverloadTy)
6475 return Context.OverloadTy;
6476
John McCall36226622010-10-12 02:09:17 +00006477 ExprResult PR = CheckPlaceholderExpr(OrigOp, OpLoc);
6478 if (PR.isInvalid()) return QualType();
6479 OrigOp = PR.take();
6480
John McCall8d08b9b2010-08-27 09:08:28 +00006481 // Make sure to ignore parentheses in subsequent checks
6482 Expr *op = OrigOp->IgnoreParens();
Douglas Gregor19b8c4f2008-12-17 22:52:20 +00006483
Steve Naroff826e91a2008-01-13 17:10:08 +00006484 if (getLangOptions().C99) {
6485 // Implement C99-only parts of addressof rules.
6486 if (UnaryOperator* uOp = dyn_cast<UnaryOperator>(op)) {
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006487 if (uOp->getOpcode() == UO_Deref)
Steve Naroff826e91a2008-01-13 17:10:08 +00006488 // Per C99 6.5.3.2, the address of a deref always returns a valid result
6489 // (assuming the deref expression is valid).
6490 return uOp->getSubExpr()->getType();
6491 }
6492 // Technically, there should be a check for array subscript
6493 // expressions here, but the result of one is always an lvalue anyway.
6494 }
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00006495 NamedDecl *dcl = getPrimaryDecl(op);
Chris Lattner67315442008-07-26 21:30:36 +00006496 Expr::isLvalueResult lval = op->isLvalue(Context);
Nuno Lopes17f345f2008-12-16 22:59:47 +00006497
Chris Lattner9156f1b2010-07-05 19:17:26 +00006498 if (lval == Expr::LV_ClassTemporary) {
Douglas Gregorb154fdc2010-02-16 21:39:57 +00006499 Diag(OpLoc, isSFINAEContext()? diag::err_typecheck_addrof_class_temporary
6500 : diag::ext_typecheck_addrof_class_temporary)
6501 << op->getType() << op->getSourceRange();
6502 if (isSFINAEContext())
6503 return QualType();
John McCall8d08b9b2010-08-27 09:08:28 +00006504 } else if (isa<ObjCSelectorExpr>(op)) {
Chris Lattner9156f1b2010-07-05 19:17:26 +00006505 return Context.getPointerType(op->getType());
John McCall8d08b9b2010-08-27 09:08:28 +00006506 } else if (lval == Expr::LV_MemberFunction) {
6507 // If it's an instance method, make a member pointer.
6508 // The expression must have exactly the form &A::foo.
6509
6510 // If the underlying expression isn't a decl ref, give up.
6511 if (!isa<DeclRefExpr>(op)) {
6512 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_invalid_form_pointer_member_function)
6513 << OrigOp->getSourceRange();
6514 return QualType();
6515 }
6516 DeclRefExpr *DRE = cast<DeclRefExpr>(op);
6517 CXXMethodDecl *MD = cast<CXXMethodDecl>(DRE->getDecl());
6518
6519 // The id-expression was parenthesized.
6520 if (OrigOp != DRE) {
6521 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_parens_pointer_member_function)
6522 << OrigOp->getSourceRange();
6523
6524 // The method was named without a qualifier.
6525 } else if (!DRE->getQualifier()) {
6526 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_unqualified_pointer_member_function)
6527 << op->getSourceRange();
6528 }
6529
6530 return Context.getMemberPointerType(op->getType(),
6531 Context.getTypeDeclType(MD->getParent()).getTypePtr());
6532 } else if (lval != Expr::LV_Valid && lval != Expr::LV_IncompleteVoidType) {
Eli Friedmance7f9002009-05-16 23:27:50 +00006533 // C99 6.5.3.2p1
Eli Friedman3a1e6922009-04-20 08:23:18 +00006534 // The operand must be either an l-value or a function designator
Eli Friedmance7f9002009-05-16 23:27:50 +00006535 if (!op->getType()->isFunctionType()) {
Chris Lattner48d52842007-11-16 17:46:48 +00006536 // FIXME: emit more specific diag...
Chris Lattnerf490e152008-11-19 05:27:50 +00006537 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_invalid_lvalue_addrof)
6538 << op->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006539 return QualType();
6540 }
Douglas Gregor71235ec2009-05-02 02:18:30 +00006541 } else if (op->getBitField()) { // C99 6.5.3.2p1
Eli Friedman3a1e6922009-04-20 08:23:18 +00006542 // The operand cannot be a bit-field
6543 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_address_of)
6544 << "bit-field" << op->getSourceRange();
Douglas Gregor2eedc3a2008-12-20 23:49:58 +00006545 return QualType();
Anders Carlsson8abde4b2010-01-31 17:18:49 +00006546 } else if (op->refersToVectorElement()) {
Eli Friedman3a1e6922009-04-20 08:23:18 +00006547 // The operand cannot be an element of a vector
Chris Lattner29e812b2008-11-20 06:06:08 +00006548 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_address_of)
Nate Begemana6b47a42009-02-15 22:45:20 +00006549 << "vector element" << op->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroffb96e4ab62008-02-29 23:30:25 +00006550 return QualType();
Fariborz Jahanian385db802009-07-07 18:50:52 +00006551 } else if (isa<ObjCPropertyRefExpr>(op)) {
6552 // cannot take address of a property expression.
6553 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_address_of)
6554 << "property expression" << op->getSourceRange();
6555 return QualType();
Anders Carlsson3fa58d12009-09-14 23:15:26 +00006556 } else if (ConditionalOperator *CO = dyn_cast<ConditionalOperator>(op)) {
6557 // FIXME: Can LHS ever be null here?
Anders Carlsson01ccf992009-09-15 16:03:44 +00006558 if (!CheckAddressOfOperand(CO->getTrueExpr(), OpLoc).isNull())
6559 return CheckAddressOfOperand(CO->getFalseExpr(), OpLoc);
Steve Naroffb96e4ab62008-02-29 23:30:25 +00006560 } else if (dcl) { // C99 6.5.3.2p1
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006561 // We have an lvalue with a decl. Make sure the decl is not declared
Steve Naroff47500512007-04-19 23:00:49 +00006562 // with the register storage-class specifier.
6563 if (const VarDecl *vd = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(dcl)) {
Fariborz Jahaniane0fd5a92010-08-24 22:21:48 +00006564 // in C++ it is not error to take address of a register
6565 // variable (c++03 7.1.1P3)
John McCall8e7d6562010-08-26 03:08:43 +00006566 if (vd->getStorageClass() == SC_Register &&
Fariborz Jahaniane0fd5a92010-08-24 22:21:48 +00006567 !getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
Chris Lattner29e812b2008-11-20 06:06:08 +00006568 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_address_of)
6569 << "register variable" << op->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006570 return QualType();
6571 }
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00006572 } else if (isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(dcl)) {
Douglas Gregorcd695e52008-11-10 20:40:00 +00006573 return Context.OverloadTy;
Anders Carlsson0b675f52009-07-08 21:45:58 +00006574 } else if (FieldDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FieldDecl>(dcl)) {
Douglas Gregor9aa8b552008-12-10 21:26:49 +00006575 // Okay: we can take the address of a field.
Sebastian Redl3d3f75a2009-02-03 20:19:35 +00006576 // Could be a pointer to member, though, if there is an explicit
6577 // scope qualifier for the class.
Douglas Gregor4bd90e52009-10-23 18:54:35 +00006578 if (isa<DeclRefExpr>(op) && cast<DeclRefExpr>(op)->getQualifier()) {
Sebastian Redl3d3f75a2009-02-03 20:19:35 +00006579 DeclContext *Ctx = dcl->getDeclContext();
Anders Carlsson0b675f52009-07-08 21:45:58 +00006580 if (Ctx && Ctx->isRecord()) {
6581 if (FD->getType()->isReferenceType()) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006582 Diag(OpLoc,
Anders Carlsson0b675f52009-07-08 21:45:58 +00006583 diag::err_cannot_form_pointer_to_member_of_reference_type)
6584 << FD->getDeclName() << FD->getType();
6585 return QualType();
6586 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006587
Sebastian Redl3d3f75a2009-02-03 20:19:35 +00006588 return Context.getMemberPointerType(op->getType(),
6589 Context.getTypeDeclType(cast<RecordDecl>(Ctx)).getTypePtr());
Anders Carlsson0b675f52009-07-08 21:45:58 +00006590 }
Sebastian Redl3d3f75a2009-02-03 20:19:35 +00006591 }
Anders Carlsson5b535762009-05-16 21:43:42 +00006592 } else if (!isa<FunctionDecl>(dcl))
Steve Narofff633d092007-04-25 19:01:39 +00006593 assert(0 && "Unknown/unexpected decl type");
Steve Naroff47500512007-04-19 23:00:49 +00006594 }
Sebastian Redl18f8ff62009-02-04 21:23:32 +00006595
Eli Friedmance7f9002009-05-16 23:27:50 +00006596 if (lval == Expr::LV_IncompleteVoidType) {
6597 // Taking the address of a void variable is technically illegal, but we
6598 // allow it in cases which are otherwise valid.
6599 // Example: "extern void x; void* y = &x;".
6600 Diag(OpLoc, diag::ext_typecheck_addrof_void) << op->getSourceRange();
6601 }
6602
Steve Naroff47500512007-04-19 23:00:49 +00006603 // If the operand has type "type", the result has type "pointer to type".
Douglas Gregor0bdcb8a2010-07-29 16:05:45 +00006604 if (op->getType()->isObjCObjectType())
6605 return Context.getObjCObjectPointerType(op->getType());
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006606 return Context.getPointerType(op->getType());
Steve Naroff47500512007-04-19 23:00:49 +00006607}
6608
Chris Lattner9156f1b2010-07-05 19:17:26 +00006609/// CheckIndirectionOperand - Type check unary indirection (prefix '*').
Chris Lattner6a2ed6f2008-11-23 09:13:29 +00006610QualType Sema::CheckIndirectionOperand(Expr *Op, SourceLocation OpLoc) {
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006611 if (Op->isTypeDependent())
6612 return Context.DependentTy;
6613
Chris Lattner6a2ed6f2008-11-23 09:13:29 +00006614 UsualUnaryConversions(Op);
Chris Lattner9156f1b2010-07-05 19:17:26 +00006615 QualType OpTy = Op->getType();
6616 QualType Result;
6617
6618 // Note that per both C89 and C99, indirection is always legal, even if OpTy
6619 // is an incomplete type or void. It would be possible to warn about
6620 // dereferencing a void pointer, but it's completely well-defined, and such a
6621 // warning is unlikely to catch any mistakes.
6622 if (const PointerType *PT = OpTy->getAs<PointerType>())
6623 Result = PT->getPointeeType();
6624 else if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *OPT =
6625 OpTy->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>())
6626 Result = OPT->getPointeeType();
John McCall36226622010-10-12 02:09:17 +00006627 else {
6628 ExprResult PR = CheckPlaceholderExpr(Op, OpLoc);
6629 if (PR.isInvalid()) return QualType();
6630 if (PR.take() != Op) return CheckIndirectionOperand(PR.take(), OpLoc);
6631 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006632
Chris Lattner9156f1b2010-07-05 19:17:26 +00006633 if (Result.isNull()) {
6634 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_indirection_requires_pointer)
6635 << OpTy << Op->getSourceRange();
6636 return QualType();
6637 }
6638
6639 return Result;
Steve Naroff1926c832007-04-24 00:23:05 +00006640}
Steve Naroff218bc2b2007-05-04 21:54:46 +00006641
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006642static inline BinaryOperatorKind ConvertTokenKindToBinaryOpcode(
Steve Naroff218bc2b2007-05-04 21:54:46 +00006643 tok::TokenKind Kind) {
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006644 BinaryOperatorKind Opc;
Steve Naroff218bc2b2007-05-04 21:54:46 +00006645 switch (Kind) {
6646 default: assert(0 && "Unknown binop!");
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006647 case tok::periodstar: Opc = BO_PtrMemD; break;
6648 case tok::arrowstar: Opc = BO_PtrMemI; break;
6649 case tok::star: Opc = BO_Mul; break;
6650 case tok::slash: Opc = BO_Div; break;
6651 case tok::percent: Opc = BO_Rem; break;
6652 case tok::plus: Opc = BO_Add; break;
6653 case tok::minus: Opc = BO_Sub; break;
6654 case tok::lessless: Opc = BO_Shl; break;
6655 case tok::greatergreater: Opc = BO_Shr; break;
6656 case tok::lessequal: Opc = BO_LE; break;
6657 case tok::less: Opc = BO_LT; break;
6658 case tok::greaterequal: Opc = BO_GE; break;
6659 case tok::greater: Opc = BO_GT; break;
6660 case tok::exclaimequal: Opc = BO_NE; break;
6661 case tok::equalequal: Opc = BO_EQ; break;
6662 case tok::amp: Opc = BO_And; break;
6663 case tok::caret: Opc = BO_Xor; break;
6664 case tok::pipe: Opc = BO_Or; break;
6665 case tok::ampamp: Opc = BO_LAnd; break;
6666 case tok::pipepipe: Opc = BO_LOr; break;
6667 case tok::equal: Opc = BO_Assign; break;
6668 case tok::starequal: Opc = BO_MulAssign; break;
6669 case tok::slashequal: Opc = BO_DivAssign; break;
6670 case tok::percentequal: Opc = BO_RemAssign; break;
6671 case tok::plusequal: Opc = BO_AddAssign; break;
6672 case tok::minusequal: Opc = BO_SubAssign; break;
6673 case tok::lesslessequal: Opc = BO_ShlAssign; break;
6674 case tok::greatergreaterequal: Opc = BO_ShrAssign; break;
6675 case tok::ampequal: Opc = BO_AndAssign; break;
6676 case tok::caretequal: Opc = BO_XorAssign; break;
6677 case tok::pipeequal: Opc = BO_OrAssign; break;
6678 case tok::comma: Opc = BO_Comma; break;
Steve Naroff218bc2b2007-05-04 21:54:46 +00006679 }
6680 return Opc;
6681}
6682
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006683static inline UnaryOperatorKind ConvertTokenKindToUnaryOpcode(
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006684 tok::TokenKind Kind) {
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006685 UnaryOperatorKind Opc;
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006686 switch (Kind) {
6687 default: assert(0 && "Unknown unary op!");
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006688 case tok::plusplus: Opc = UO_PreInc; break;
6689 case tok::minusminus: Opc = UO_PreDec; break;
6690 case tok::amp: Opc = UO_AddrOf; break;
6691 case tok::star: Opc = UO_Deref; break;
6692 case tok::plus: Opc = UO_Plus; break;
6693 case tok::minus: Opc = UO_Minus; break;
6694 case tok::tilde: Opc = UO_Not; break;
6695 case tok::exclaim: Opc = UO_LNot; break;
6696 case tok::kw___real: Opc = UO_Real; break;
6697 case tok::kw___imag: Opc = UO_Imag; break;
6698 case tok::kw___extension__: Opc = UO_Extension; break;
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006699 }
6700 return Opc;
6701}
6702
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006703/// CreateBuiltinBinOp - Creates a new built-in binary operation with
6704/// operator @p Opc at location @c TokLoc. This routine only supports
6705/// built-in operations; ActOnBinOp handles overloaded operators.
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00006706ExprResult Sema::CreateBuiltinBinOp(SourceLocation OpLoc,
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006707 unsigned Op,
6708 Expr *lhs, Expr *rhs) {
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006709 QualType ResultTy; // Result type of the binary operator.
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006710 BinaryOperatorKind Opc = (BinaryOperatorKind) Op;
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006711 // The following two variables are used for compound assignment operators
6712 QualType CompLHSTy; // Type of LHS after promotions for computation
6713 QualType CompResultTy; // Type of computation result
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006714
6715 switch (Opc) {
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006716 case BO_Assign:
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006717 ResultTy = CheckAssignmentOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, QualType());
6718 break;
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006719 case BO_PtrMemD:
6720 case BO_PtrMemI:
Sebastian Redl112a97662009-02-07 00:15:38 +00006721 ResultTy = CheckPointerToMemberOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc,
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006722 Opc == BO_PtrMemI);
Sebastian Redl112a97662009-02-07 00:15:38 +00006723 break;
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006724 case BO_Mul:
6725 case BO_Div:
Chris Lattnerfaa54172010-01-12 21:23:57 +00006726 ResultTy = CheckMultiplyDivideOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, false,
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006727 Opc == BO_Div);
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006728 break;
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006729 case BO_Rem:
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006730 ResultTy = CheckRemainderOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc);
6731 break;
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006732 case BO_Add:
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006733 ResultTy = CheckAdditionOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc);
6734 break;
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006735 case BO_Sub:
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006736 ResultTy = CheckSubtractionOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc);
6737 break;
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006738 case BO_Shl:
6739 case BO_Shr:
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006740 ResultTy = CheckShiftOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc);
6741 break;
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006742 case BO_LE:
6743 case BO_LT:
6744 case BO_GE:
6745 case BO_GT:
Douglas Gregor7a5bc762009-04-06 18:45:53 +00006746 ResultTy = CheckCompareOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, Opc, true);
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006747 break;
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006748 case BO_EQ:
6749 case BO_NE:
Douglas Gregor7a5bc762009-04-06 18:45:53 +00006750 ResultTy = CheckCompareOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, Opc, false);
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006751 break;
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006752 case BO_And:
6753 case BO_Xor:
6754 case BO_Or:
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006755 ResultTy = CheckBitwiseOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc);
6756 break;
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006757 case BO_LAnd:
6758 case BO_LOr:
Chris Lattner8406c512010-07-13 19:41:32 +00006759 ResultTy = CheckLogicalOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, Opc);
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006760 break;
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006761 case BO_MulAssign:
6762 case BO_DivAssign:
Chris Lattnerfaa54172010-01-12 21:23:57 +00006763 CompResultTy = CheckMultiplyDivideOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, true,
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006764 Opc == BO_DivAssign);
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006765 CompLHSTy = CompResultTy;
6766 if (!CompResultTy.isNull())
6767 ResultTy = CheckAssignmentOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, CompResultTy);
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006768 break;
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006769 case BO_RemAssign:
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006770 CompResultTy = CheckRemainderOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, true);
6771 CompLHSTy = CompResultTy;
6772 if (!CompResultTy.isNull())
6773 ResultTy = CheckAssignmentOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, CompResultTy);
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006774 break;
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006775 case BO_AddAssign:
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006776 CompResultTy = CheckAdditionOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, &CompLHSTy);
6777 if (!CompResultTy.isNull())
6778 ResultTy = CheckAssignmentOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, CompResultTy);
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006779 break;
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006780 case BO_SubAssign:
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006781 CompResultTy = CheckSubtractionOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, &CompLHSTy);
6782 if (!CompResultTy.isNull())
6783 ResultTy = CheckAssignmentOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, CompResultTy);
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006784 break;
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006785 case BO_ShlAssign:
6786 case BO_ShrAssign:
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006787 CompResultTy = CheckShiftOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, true);
6788 CompLHSTy = CompResultTy;
6789 if (!CompResultTy.isNull())
6790 ResultTy = CheckAssignmentOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, CompResultTy);
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006791 break;
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006792 case BO_AndAssign:
6793 case BO_XorAssign:
6794 case BO_OrAssign:
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006795 CompResultTy = CheckBitwiseOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, true);
6796 CompLHSTy = CompResultTy;
6797 if (!CompResultTy.isNull())
6798 ResultTy = CheckAssignmentOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, CompResultTy);
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006799 break;
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006800 case BO_Comma:
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006801 ResultTy = CheckCommaOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc);
6802 break;
6803 }
6804 if (ResultTy.isNull())
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00006805 return ExprError();
Fariborz Jahanian99311ba2010-08-16 21:51:12 +00006806 if (ResultTy->isObjCObjectType() && LangOpts.ObjCNonFragileABI) {
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006807 if (Opc >= BO_Assign && Opc <= BO_OrAssign)
Fariborz Jahanian99311ba2010-08-16 21:51:12 +00006808 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_assignment_requires_nonfragile_object)
6809 << ResultTy;
6810 }
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006811 if (CompResultTy.isNull())
Steve Narofff6009ed2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00006812 return Owned(new (Context) BinaryOperator(lhs, rhs, Opc, ResultTy, OpLoc));
6813 else
6814 return Owned(new (Context) CompoundAssignOperator(lhs, rhs, Opc, ResultTy,
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006815 CompLHSTy, CompResultTy,
6816 OpLoc));
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006817}
6818
Sebastian Redl44615072009-10-27 12:10:02 +00006819/// SuggestParentheses - Emit a diagnostic together with a fixit hint that wraps
6820/// ParenRange in parentheses.
Sebastian Redl4afb7c582009-10-26 17:01:32 +00006821static void SuggestParentheses(Sema &Self, SourceLocation Loc,
6822 const PartialDiagnostic &PD,
Douglas Gregor2bf2d3d2010-04-14 16:09:52 +00006823 const PartialDiagnostic &FirstNote,
6824 SourceRange FirstParenRange,
6825 const PartialDiagnostic &SecondNote,
Douglas Gregor89336232010-03-29 23:34:08 +00006826 SourceRange SecondParenRange) {
Douglas Gregor2bf2d3d2010-04-14 16:09:52 +00006827 Self.Diag(Loc, PD);
6828
6829 if (!FirstNote.getDiagID())
6830 return;
6831
6832 SourceLocation EndLoc = Self.PP.getLocForEndOfToken(FirstParenRange.getEnd());
6833 if (!FirstParenRange.getEnd().isFileID() || EndLoc.isInvalid()) {
6834 // We can't display the parentheses, so just return.
Sebastian Redl4afb7c582009-10-26 17:01:32 +00006835 return;
6836 }
6837
Douglas Gregor2bf2d3d2010-04-14 16:09:52 +00006838 Self.Diag(Loc, FirstNote)
6839 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(FirstParenRange.getBegin(), "(")
Douglas Gregora771f462010-03-31 17:46:05 +00006840 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(EndLoc, ")");
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00006841
Douglas Gregor2bf2d3d2010-04-14 16:09:52 +00006842 if (!SecondNote.getDiagID())
Douglas Gregorfa1e36d2010-01-08 00:20:23 +00006843 return;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00006844
Douglas Gregorfa1e36d2010-01-08 00:20:23 +00006845 EndLoc = Self.PP.getLocForEndOfToken(SecondParenRange.getEnd());
6846 if (!SecondParenRange.getEnd().isFileID() || EndLoc.isInvalid()) {
6847 // We can't display the parentheses, so just dig the
6848 // warning/error and return.
Douglas Gregor2bf2d3d2010-04-14 16:09:52 +00006849 Self.Diag(Loc, SecondNote);
Douglas Gregorfa1e36d2010-01-08 00:20:23 +00006850 return;
6851 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00006852
Douglas Gregor2bf2d3d2010-04-14 16:09:52 +00006853 Self.Diag(Loc, SecondNote)
Douglas Gregora771f462010-03-31 17:46:05 +00006854 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(SecondParenRange.getBegin(), "(")
6855 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(EndLoc, ")");
Sebastian Redl4afb7c582009-10-26 17:01:32 +00006856}
6857
Sebastian Redl44615072009-10-27 12:10:02 +00006858/// DiagnoseBitwisePrecedence - Emit a warning when bitwise and comparison
6859/// operators are mixed in a way that suggests that the programmer forgot that
6860/// comparison operators have higher precedence. The most typical example of
6861/// such code is "flags & 0x0020 != 0", which is equivalent to "flags & 1".
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006862static void DiagnoseBitwisePrecedence(Sema &Self, BinaryOperatorKind Opc,
Sebastian Redl43028242009-10-26 15:24:15 +00006863 SourceLocation OpLoc,Expr *lhs,Expr *rhs){
Sebastian Redl44615072009-10-27 12:10:02 +00006864 typedef BinaryOperator BinOp;
6865 BinOp::Opcode lhsopc = static_cast<BinOp::Opcode>(-1),
6866 rhsopc = static_cast<BinOp::Opcode>(-1);
6867 if (BinOp *BO = dyn_cast<BinOp>(lhs))
Sebastian Redl43028242009-10-26 15:24:15 +00006868 lhsopc = BO->getOpcode();
Sebastian Redl44615072009-10-27 12:10:02 +00006869 if (BinOp *BO = dyn_cast<BinOp>(rhs))
Sebastian Redl43028242009-10-26 15:24:15 +00006870 rhsopc = BO->getOpcode();
6871
6872 // Subs are not binary operators.
6873 if (lhsopc == -1 && rhsopc == -1)
6874 return;
6875
6876 // Bitwise operations are sometimes used as eager logical ops.
6877 // Don't diagnose this.
Sebastian Redl44615072009-10-27 12:10:02 +00006878 if ((BinOp::isComparisonOp(lhsopc) || BinOp::isBitwiseOp(lhsopc)) &&
6879 (BinOp::isComparisonOp(rhsopc) || BinOp::isBitwiseOp(rhsopc)))
Sebastian Redl43028242009-10-26 15:24:15 +00006880 return;
6881
Sebastian Redl44615072009-10-27 12:10:02 +00006882 if (BinOp::isComparisonOp(lhsopc))
Sebastian Redl4afb7c582009-10-26 17:01:32 +00006883 SuggestParentheses(Self, OpLoc,
Douglas Gregor89336232010-03-29 23:34:08 +00006884 Self.PDiag(diag::warn_precedence_bitwise_rel)
Sebastian Redl44615072009-10-27 12:10:02 +00006885 << SourceRange(lhs->getLocStart(), OpLoc)
6886 << BinOp::getOpcodeStr(Opc) << BinOp::getOpcodeStr(lhsopc),
Douglas Gregor89336232010-03-29 23:34:08 +00006887 Self.PDiag(diag::note_precedence_bitwise_first)
Douglas Gregorfa1e36d2010-01-08 00:20:23 +00006888 << BinOp::getOpcodeStr(Opc),
Douglas Gregor2bf2d3d2010-04-14 16:09:52 +00006889 SourceRange(cast<BinOp>(lhs)->getRHS()->getLocStart(), rhs->getLocEnd()),
6890 Self.PDiag(diag::note_precedence_bitwise_silence)
6891 << BinOp::getOpcodeStr(lhsopc),
6892 lhs->getSourceRange());
Sebastian Redl44615072009-10-27 12:10:02 +00006893 else if (BinOp::isComparisonOp(rhsopc))
Sebastian Redl4afb7c582009-10-26 17:01:32 +00006894 SuggestParentheses(Self, OpLoc,
Douglas Gregor89336232010-03-29 23:34:08 +00006895 Self.PDiag(diag::warn_precedence_bitwise_rel)
Sebastian Redl44615072009-10-27 12:10:02 +00006896 << SourceRange(OpLoc, rhs->getLocEnd())
6897 << BinOp::getOpcodeStr(Opc) << BinOp::getOpcodeStr(rhsopc),
Douglas Gregor89336232010-03-29 23:34:08 +00006898 Self.PDiag(diag::note_precedence_bitwise_first)
Douglas Gregorfa1e36d2010-01-08 00:20:23 +00006899 << BinOp::getOpcodeStr(Opc),
Douglas Gregor2bf2d3d2010-04-14 16:09:52 +00006900 SourceRange(lhs->getLocEnd(), cast<BinOp>(rhs)->getLHS()->getLocStart()),
6901 Self.PDiag(diag::note_precedence_bitwise_silence)
6902 << BinOp::getOpcodeStr(rhsopc),
6903 rhs->getSourceRange());
Sebastian Redl43028242009-10-26 15:24:15 +00006904}
6905
6906/// DiagnoseBinOpPrecedence - Emit warnings for expressions with tricky
6907/// precedence. This currently diagnoses only "arg1 'bitwise' arg2 'eq' arg3".
6908/// But it could also warn about arg1 && arg2 || arg3, as GCC 4.3+ does.
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006909static void DiagnoseBinOpPrecedence(Sema &Self, BinaryOperatorKind Opc,
Sebastian Redl43028242009-10-26 15:24:15 +00006910 SourceLocation OpLoc, Expr *lhs, Expr *rhs){
Sebastian Redl44615072009-10-27 12:10:02 +00006911 if (BinaryOperator::isBitwiseOp(Opc))
Sebastian Redl43028242009-10-26 15:24:15 +00006912 DiagnoseBitwisePrecedence(Self, Opc, OpLoc, lhs, rhs);
6913}
6914
Steve Naroff218bc2b2007-05-04 21:54:46 +00006915// Binary Operators. 'Tok' is the token for the operator.
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00006916ExprResult Sema::ActOnBinOp(Scope *S, SourceLocation TokLoc,
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006917 tok::TokenKind Kind,
6918 Expr *lhs, Expr *rhs) {
6919 BinaryOperatorKind Opc = ConvertTokenKindToBinaryOpcode(Kind);
Steve Naroff83895f72007-09-16 03:34:24 +00006920 assert((lhs != 0) && "ActOnBinOp(): missing left expression");
6921 assert((rhs != 0) && "ActOnBinOp(): missing right expression");
Steve Naroff218bc2b2007-05-04 21:54:46 +00006922
Sebastian Redl43028242009-10-26 15:24:15 +00006923 // Emit warnings for tricky precedence issues, e.g. "bitfield & 0x4 == 0"
6924 DiagnoseBinOpPrecedence(*this, Opc, TokLoc, lhs, rhs);
6925
Douglas Gregor5287f092009-11-05 00:51:44 +00006926 return BuildBinOp(S, TokLoc, Opc, lhs, rhs);
6927}
6928
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00006929ExprResult Sema::BuildBinOp(Scope *S, SourceLocation OpLoc,
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006930 BinaryOperatorKind Opc,
6931 Expr *lhs, Expr *rhs) {
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00006932 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus &&
Fariborz Jahanian805b74e2010-09-14 23:02:38 +00006933 ((!isa<ObjCImplicitSetterGetterRefExpr>(lhs) &&
6934 !isa<ObjCPropertyRefExpr>(lhs))
Fariborz Jahanianaaf44b22010-09-17 20:45:45 +00006935 || rhs->isTypeDependent() || Opc != BO_Assign) &&
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006936 (lhs->getType()->isOverloadableType() ||
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00006937 rhs->getType()->isOverloadableType())) {
6938 // Find all of the overloaded operators visible from this
6939 // point. We perform both an operator-name lookup from the local
6940 // scope and an argument-dependent lookup based on the types of
6941 // the arguments.
John McCall4c4c1df2010-01-26 03:27:55 +00006942 UnresolvedSet<16> Functions;
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00006943 OverloadedOperatorKind OverOp = BinaryOperator::getOverloadedOperator(Opc);
John McCall4c4c1df2010-01-26 03:27:55 +00006944 if (S && OverOp != OO_None)
6945 LookupOverloadedOperatorName(OverOp, S, lhs->getType(), rhs->getType(),
6946 Functions);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00006947
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00006948 // Build the (potentially-overloaded, potentially-dependent)
6949 // binary operation.
Douglas Gregor5287f092009-11-05 00:51:44 +00006950 return CreateOverloadedBinOp(OpLoc, Opc, Functions, lhs, rhs);
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00006951 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00006952
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006953 // Build a built-in binary operation.
Douglas Gregor5287f092009-11-05 00:51:44 +00006954 return CreateBuiltinBinOp(OpLoc, Opc, lhs, rhs);
Steve Naroff218bc2b2007-05-04 21:54:46 +00006955}
6956
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00006957ExprResult Sema::CreateBuiltinUnaryOp(SourceLocation OpLoc,
John McCall36226622010-10-12 02:09:17 +00006958 unsigned OpcIn,
6959 Expr *Input) {
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006960 UnaryOperatorKind Opc = static_cast<UnaryOperatorKind>(OpcIn);
Douglas Gregord08452f2008-11-19 15:42:04 +00006961
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006962 QualType resultType;
6963 switch (Opc) {
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006964 case UO_PreInc:
6965 case UO_PreDec:
6966 case UO_PostInc:
6967 case UO_PostDec:
Sebastian Redle10c2c32008-12-20 09:35:34 +00006968 resultType = CheckIncrementDecrementOperand(Input, OpLoc,
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006969 Opc == UO_PreInc ||
6970 Opc == UO_PostInc,
6971 Opc == UO_PreInc ||
6972 Opc == UO_PreDec);
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006973 break;
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006974 case UO_AddrOf:
Chris Lattner86554282007-06-08 22:32:33 +00006975 resultType = CheckAddressOfOperand(Input, OpLoc);
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006976 break;
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006977 case UO_Deref:
Douglas Gregorb92a1562010-02-03 00:27:59 +00006978 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(Input);
Chris Lattner86554282007-06-08 22:32:33 +00006979 resultType = CheckIndirectionOperand(Input, OpLoc);
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006980 break;
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006981 case UO_Plus:
6982 case UO_Minus:
Steve Naroff31090012007-07-16 21:54:35 +00006983 UsualUnaryConversions(Input);
6984 resultType = Input->getType();
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006985 if (resultType->isDependentType())
6986 break;
Douglas Gregora3208f92010-06-22 23:41:02 +00006987 if (resultType->isArithmeticType() || // C99 6.5.3.3p1
6988 resultType->isVectorType())
Douglas Gregord08452f2008-11-19 15:42:04 +00006989 break;
6990 else if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus && // C++ [expr.unary.op]p6-7
6991 resultType->isEnumeralType())
6992 break;
6993 else if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus && // C++ [expr.unary.op]p6
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006994 Opc == UO_Plus &&
Douglas Gregord08452f2008-11-19 15:42:04 +00006995 resultType->isPointerType())
6996 break;
John McCall36226622010-10-12 02:09:17 +00006997 else if (resultType->isPlaceholderType()) {
6998 ExprResult PR = CheckPlaceholderExpr(Input, OpLoc);
6999 if (PR.isInvalid()) return ExprError();
7000 return CreateBuiltinUnaryOp(OpLoc, OpcIn, PR.take());
7001 }
Douglas Gregord08452f2008-11-19 15:42:04 +00007002
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00007003 return ExprError(Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_unary_expr)
7004 << resultType << Input->getSourceRange());
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00007005 case UO_Not: // bitwise complement
Steve Naroff31090012007-07-16 21:54:35 +00007006 UsualUnaryConversions(Input);
7007 resultType = Input->getType();
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00007008 if (resultType->isDependentType())
7009 break;
Chris Lattner0d707612008-07-25 23:52:49 +00007010 // C99 6.5.3.3p1. We allow complex int and float as a GCC extension.
7011 if (resultType->isComplexType() || resultType->isComplexIntegerType())
7012 // C99 does not support '~' for complex conjugation.
Chris Lattner29e812b2008-11-20 06:06:08 +00007013 Diag(OpLoc, diag::ext_integer_complement_complex)
Chris Lattner1e5665e2008-11-24 06:25:27 +00007014 << resultType << Input->getSourceRange();
John McCall36226622010-10-12 02:09:17 +00007015 else if (resultType->hasIntegerRepresentation())
7016 break;
7017 else if (resultType->isPlaceholderType()) {
7018 ExprResult PR = CheckPlaceholderExpr(Input, OpLoc);
7019 if (PR.isInvalid()) return ExprError();
7020 return CreateBuiltinUnaryOp(OpLoc, OpcIn, PR.take());
7021 } else {
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00007022 return ExprError(Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_unary_expr)
7023 << resultType << Input->getSourceRange());
John McCall36226622010-10-12 02:09:17 +00007024 }
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00007025 break;
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00007026 case UO_LNot: // logical negation
Steve Naroff71b59a92007-06-04 22:22:31 +00007027 // Unlike +/-/~, integer promotions aren't done here (C99 6.5.3.3p5).
Douglas Gregorb92a1562010-02-03 00:27:59 +00007028 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(Input);
Steve Naroff31090012007-07-16 21:54:35 +00007029 resultType = Input->getType();
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00007030 if (resultType->isDependentType())
7031 break;
John McCall36226622010-10-12 02:09:17 +00007032 if (resultType->isScalarType()) { // C99 6.5.3.3p1
7033 // ok, fallthrough
7034 } else if (resultType->isPlaceholderType()) {
7035 ExprResult PR = CheckPlaceholderExpr(Input, OpLoc);
7036 if (PR.isInvalid()) return ExprError();
7037 return CreateBuiltinUnaryOp(OpLoc, OpcIn, PR.take());
7038 } else {
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00007039 return ExprError(Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_unary_expr)
7040 << resultType << Input->getSourceRange());
John McCall36226622010-10-12 02:09:17 +00007041 }
Douglas Gregordb8c6fd2010-09-20 17:13:33 +00007042
Chris Lattnerbe31ed82007-06-02 19:11:33 +00007043 // LNot always has type int. C99 6.5.3.3p5.
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00007044 // In C++, it's bool. C++ 5.3.1p8
7045 resultType = getLangOptions().CPlusPlus ? Context.BoolTy : Context.IntTy;
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00007046 break;
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00007047 case UO_Real:
7048 case UO_Imag:
7049 resultType = CheckRealImagOperand(Input, OpLoc, Opc == UO_Real);
Chris Lattner30b5dd02007-08-24 21:16:53 +00007050 break;
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00007051 case UO_Extension:
Chris Lattner86554282007-06-08 22:32:33 +00007052 resultType = Input->getType();
Steve Naroff043d45d2007-05-15 02:32:35 +00007053 break;
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00007054 }
7055 if (resultType.isNull())
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00007056 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00007057
Steve Narofff6009ed2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00007058 return Owned(new (Context) UnaryOperator(Input, Opc, resultType, OpLoc));
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00007059}
Chris Lattnereefa10e2007-05-28 06:56:27 +00007060
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00007061ExprResult Sema::BuildUnaryOp(Scope *S, SourceLocation OpLoc,
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00007062 UnaryOperatorKind Opc,
7063 Expr *Input) {
Anders Carlsson461a2c02009-11-14 21:26:41 +00007064 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus && Input->getType()->isOverloadableType() &&
Eli Friedman8ed2bac2010-09-05 23:15:52 +00007065 UnaryOperator::getOverloadedOperator(Opc) != OO_None) {
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00007066 // Find all of the overloaded operators visible from this
7067 // point. We perform both an operator-name lookup from the local
7068 // scope and an argument-dependent lookup based on the types of
7069 // the arguments.
John McCall4c4c1df2010-01-26 03:27:55 +00007070 UnresolvedSet<16> Functions;
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00007071 OverloadedOperatorKind OverOp = UnaryOperator::getOverloadedOperator(Opc);
John McCall4c4c1df2010-01-26 03:27:55 +00007072 if (S && OverOp != OO_None)
7073 LookupOverloadedOperatorName(OverOp, S, Input->getType(), QualType(),
7074 Functions);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007075
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00007076 return CreateOverloadedUnaryOp(OpLoc, Opc, Functions, Input);
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00007077 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007078
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00007079 return CreateBuiltinUnaryOp(OpLoc, Opc, Input);
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00007080}
7081
Douglas Gregor5287f092009-11-05 00:51:44 +00007082// Unary Operators. 'Tok' is the token for the operator.
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00007083ExprResult Sema::ActOnUnaryOp(Scope *S, SourceLocation OpLoc,
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00007084 tok::TokenKind Op, Expr *Input) {
7085 return BuildUnaryOp(S, OpLoc, ConvertTokenKindToUnaryOpcode(Op), Input);
Douglas Gregor5287f092009-11-05 00:51:44 +00007086}
7087
Steve Naroff66356bd2007-09-16 14:56:35 +00007088/// ActOnAddrLabel - Parse the GNU address of label extension: "&&foo".
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00007089ExprResult Sema::ActOnAddrLabel(SourceLocation OpLoc,
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00007090 SourceLocation LabLoc,
7091 IdentifierInfo *LabelII) {
Chris Lattnereefa10e2007-05-28 06:56:27 +00007092 // Look up the record for this label identifier.
John McCallaab3e412010-08-25 08:40:02 +00007093 LabelStmt *&LabelDecl = getCurFunction()->LabelMap[LabelII];
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007094
Daniel Dunbar88402ce2008-08-04 16:51:22 +00007095 // If we haven't seen this label yet, create a forward reference. It
7096 // will be validated and/or cleaned up in ActOnFinishFunctionBody.
Steve Naroff846b1ec2009-03-13 15:38:40 +00007097 if (LabelDecl == 0)
Steve Narofff6009ed2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00007098 LabelDecl = new (Context) LabelStmt(LabLoc, LabelII, 0);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007099
Argyrios Kyrtzidis72664df2010-09-19 21:21:25 +00007100 LabelDecl->setUsed();
Chris Lattnereefa10e2007-05-28 06:56:27 +00007101 // Create the AST node. The address of a label always has type 'void*'.
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00007102 return Owned(new (Context) AddrLabelExpr(OpLoc, LabLoc, LabelDecl,
7103 Context.getPointerType(Context.VoidTy)));
Chris Lattnereefa10e2007-05-28 06:56:27 +00007104}
7105
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00007106ExprResult
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00007107Sema::ActOnStmtExpr(SourceLocation LPLoc, Stmt *SubStmt,
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00007108 SourceLocation RPLoc) { // "({..})"
Chris Lattner366727f2007-07-24 16:58:17 +00007109 assert(SubStmt && isa<CompoundStmt>(SubStmt) && "Invalid action invocation!");
7110 CompoundStmt *Compound = cast<CompoundStmt>(SubStmt);
7111
Douglas Gregor6cf3f3c2010-03-10 04:54:39 +00007112 bool isFileScope
7113 = (getCurFunctionOrMethodDecl() == 0) && (getCurBlock() == 0);
Chris Lattnera69b0762009-04-25 19:11:05 +00007114 if (isFileScope)
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00007115 return ExprError(Diag(LPLoc, diag::err_stmtexpr_file_scope));
Eli Friedman52cc0162009-01-24 23:09:00 +00007116
Chris Lattner366727f2007-07-24 16:58:17 +00007117 // FIXME: there are a variety of strange constraints to enforce here, for
7118 // example, it is not possible to goto into a stmt expression apparently.
7119 // More semantic analysis is needed.
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007120
Chris Lattner366727f2007-07-24 16:58:17 +00007121 // If there are sub stmts in the compound stmt, take the type of the last one
7122 // as the type of the stmtexpr.
7123 QualType Ty = Context.VoidTy;
Fariborz Jahanian56143ae2010-10-25 23:27:26 +00007124 bool StmtExprMayBindToTemp = false;
Chris Lattner944d3062008-07-26 19:51:01 +00007125 if (!Compound->body_empty()) {
7126 Stmt *LastStmt = Compound->body_back();
Fariborz Jahanian56143ae2010-10-25 23:27:26 +00007127 LabelStmt *LastLabelStmt = 0;
Chris Lattner944d3062008-07-26 19:51:01 +00007128 // If LastStmt is a label, skip down through into the body.
Fariborz Jahanian56143ae2010-10-25 23:27:26 +00007129 while (LabelStmt *Label = dyn_cast<LabelStmt>(LastStmt)) {
7130 LastLabelStmt = Label;
Chris Lattner944d3062008-07-26 19:51:01 +00007131 LastStmt = Label->getSubStmt();
Fariborz Jahanian56143ae2010-10-25 23:27:26 +00007132 }
7133 if (Expr *LastExpr = dyn_cast<Expr>(LastStmt)) {
Fariborz Jahaniandd6907b2010-10-27 20:44:00 +00007134 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(LastExpr);
Chris Lattner366727f2007-07-24 16:58:17 +00007135 Ty = LastExpr->getType();
Fariborz Jahanian56143ae2010-10-25 23:27:26 +00007136 if (!Ty->isDependentType() && !LastExpr->isTypeDependent()) {
7137 ExprResult Res = PerformCopyInitialization(
7138 InitializedEntity::InitializeResult(LPLoc,
7139 Ty,
7140 false),
7141 SourceLocation(),
7142 Owned(LastExpr));
7143 if (Res.isInvalid())
7144 return ExprError();
7145 if ((LastExpr = Res.takeAs<Expr>())) {
7146 if (!LastLabelStmt)
7147 Compound->setLastStmt(LastExpr);
7148 else
7149 LastLabelStmt->setSubStmt(LastExpr);
7150 StmtExprMayBindToTemp = true;
7151 }
7152 }
7153 }
Chris Lattner944d3062008-07-26 19:51:01 +00007154 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007155
Eli Friedmanba961a92009-03-23 00:24:07 +00007156 // FIXME: Check that expression type is complete/non-abstract; statement
7157 // expressions are not lvalues.
Fariborz Jahanian56143ae2010-10-25 23:27:26 +00007158 Expr *ResStmtExpr = new (Context) StmtExpr(Compound, Ty, LPLoc, RPLoc);
7159 if (StmtExprMayBindToTemp)
7160 return MaybeBindToTemporary(ResStmtExpr);
7161 return Owned(ResStmtExpr);
Chris Lattner366727f2007-07-24 16:58:17 +00007162}
Steve Naroff78864672007-08-01 22:05:33 +00007163
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00007164ExprResult Sema::BuildBuiltinOffsetOf(SourceLocation BuiltinLoc,
John McCall36226622010-10-12 02:09:17 +00007165 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo,
7166 OffsetOfComponent *CompPtr,
7167 unsigned NumComponents,
7168 SourceLocation RParenLoc) {
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +00007169 QualType ArgTy = TInfo->getType();
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00007170 bool Dependent = ArgTy->isDependentType();
Abramo Bagnara1108e7b2010-05-20 10:00:11 +00007171 SourceRange TypeRange = TInfo->getTypeLoc().getLocalSourceRange();
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +00007172
Chris Lattnerf17bd422007-08-30 17:45:32 +00007173 // We must have at least one component that refers to the type, and the first
7174 // one is known to be a field designator. Verify that the ArgTy represents
7175 // a struct/union/class.
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00007176 if (!Dependent && !ArgTy->isRecordType())
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +00007177 return ExprError(Diag(BuiltinLoc, diag::err_offsetof_record_type)
7178 << ArgTy << TypeRange);
7179
7180 // Type must be complete per C99 7.17p3 because a declaring a variable
7181 // with an incomplete type would be ill-formed.
7182 if (!Dependent
7183 && RequireCompleteType(BuiltinLoc, ArgTy,
7184 PDiag(diag::err_offsetof_incomplete_type)
7185 << TypeRange))
7186 return ExprError();
7187
Chris Lattner78502cf2007-08-31 21:49:13 +00007188 // offsetof with non-identifier designators (e.g. "offsetof(x, a.b[c])") are a
7189 // GCC extension, diagnose them.
Eli Friedman988a16b2009-02-27 06:44:11 +00007190 // FIXME: This diagnostic isn't actually visible because the location is in
7191 // a system header!
Chris Lattner78502cf2007-08-31 21:49:13 +00007192 if (NumComponents != 1)
Chris Lattnerf490e152008-11-19 05:27:50 +00007193 Diag(BuiltinLoc, diag::ext_offsetof_extended_field_designator)
7194 << SourceRange(CompPtr[1].LocStart, CompPtr[NumComponents-1].LocEnd);
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +00007195
7196 bool DidWarnAboutNonPOD = false;
7197 QualType CurrentType = ArgTy;
7198 typedef OffsetOfExpr::OffsetOfNode OffsetOfNode;
7199 llvm::SmallVector<OffsetOfNode, 4> Comps;
7200 llvm::SmallVector<Expr*, 4> Exprs;
7201 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumComponents; ++i) {
7202 const OffsetOfComponent &OC = CompPtr[i];
7203 if (OC.isBrackets) {
7204 // Offset of an array sub-field. TODO: Should we allow vector elements?
7205 if (!CurrentType->isDependentType()) {
7206 const ArrayType *AT = Context.getAsArrayType(CurrentType);
7207 if(!AT)
7208 return ExprError(Diag(OC.LocEnd, diag::err_offsetof_array_type)
7209 << CurrentType);
7210 CurrentType = AT->getElementType();
7211 } else
7212 CurrentType = Context.DependentTy;
7213
7214 // The expression must be an integral expression.
7215 // FIXME: An integral constant expression?
7216 Expr *Idx = static_cast<Expr*>(OC.U.E);
7217 if (!Idx->isTypeDependent() && !Idx->isValueDependent() &&
7218 !Idx->getType()->isIntegerType())
7219 return ExprError(Diag(Idx->getLocStart(),
7220 diag::err_typecheck_subscript_not_integer)
7221 << Idx->getSourceRange());
7222
7223 // Record this array index.
7224 Comps.push_back(OffsetOfNode(OC.LocStart, Exprs.size(), OC.LocEnd));
7225 Exprs.push_back(Idx);
7226 continue;
7227 }
7228
7229 // Offset of a field.
7230 if (CurrentType->isDependentType()) {
7231 // We have the offset of a field, but we can't look into the dependent
7232 // type. Just record the identifier of the field.
7233 Comps.push_back(OffsetOfNode(OC.LocStart, OC.U.IdentInfo, OC.LocEnd));
7234 CurrentType = Context.DependentTy;
7235 continue;
7236 }
7237
7238 // We need to have a complete type to look into.
7239 if (RequireCompleteType(OC.LocStart, CurrentType,
7240 diag::err_offsetof_incomplete_type))
7241 return ExprError();
7242
7243 // Look for the designated field.
7244 const RecordType *RC = CurrentType->getAs<RecordType>();
7245 if (!RC)
7246 return ExprError(Diag(OC.LocEnd, diag::err_offsetof_record_type)
7247 << CurrentType);
7248 RecordDecl *RD = RC->getDecl();
7249
7250 // C++ [lib.support.types]p5:
7251 // The macro offsetof accepts a restricted set of type arguments in this
7252 // International Standard. type shall be a POD structure or a POD union
7253 // (clause 9).
7254 if (CXXRecordDecl *CRD = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(RD)) {
7255 if (!CRD->isPOD() && !DidWarnAboutNonPOD &&
7256 DiagRuntimeBehavior(BuiltinLoc,
7257 PDiag(diag::warn_offsetof_non_pod_type)
7258 << SourceRange(CompPtr[0].LocStart, OC.LocEnd)
7259 << CurrentType))
7260 DidWarnAboutNonPOD = true;
7261 }
7262
7263 // Look for the field.
7264 LookupResult R(*this, OC.U.IdentInfo, OC.LocStart, LookupMemberName);
7265 LookupQualifiedName(R, RD);
7266 FieldDecl *MemberDecl = R.getAsSingle<FieldDecl>();
7267 if (!MemberDecl)
7268 return ExprError(Diag(BuiltinLoc, diag::err_no_member)
7269 << OC.U.IdentInfo << RD << SourceRange(OC.LocStart,
7270 OC.LocEnd));
7271
Douglas Gregor10982ea2010-04-28 22:36:06 +00007272 // C99 7.17p3:
7273 // (If the specified member is a bit-field, the behavior is undefined.)
7274 //
7275 // We diagnose this as an error.
7276 if (MemberDecl->getBitWidth()) {
7277 Diag(OC.LocEnd, diag::err_offsetof_bitfield)
7278 << MemberDecl->getDeclName()
7279 << SourceRange(BuiltinLoc, RParenLoc);
7280 Diag(MemberDecl->getLocation(), diag::note_bitfield_decl);
7281 return ExprError();
7282 }
Eli Friedman74ef7cf2010-08-05 10:11:36 +00007283
7284 RecordDecl *Parent = MemberDecl->getParent();
7285 bool AnonStructUnion = Parent->isAnonymousStructOrUnion();
7286 if (AnonStructUnion) {
7287 do {
7288 Parent = cast<RecordDecl>(Parent->getParent());
7289 } while (Parent->isAnonymousStructOrUnion());
7290 }
7291
Douglas Gregord1702062010-04-29 00:18:15 +00007292 // If the member was found in a base class, introduce OffsetOfNodes for
7293 // the base class indirections.
7294 CXXBasePaths Paths(/*FindAmbiguities=*/true, /*RecordPaths=*/true,
7295 /*DetectVirtual=*/false);
Eli Friedman74ef7cf2010-08-05 10:11:36 +00007296 if (IsDerivedFrom(CurrentType, Context.getTypeDeclType(Parent), Paths)) {
Douglas Gregord1702062010-04-29 00:18:15 +00007297 CXXBasePath &Path = Paths.front();
7298 for (CXXBasePath::iterator B = Path.begin(), BEnd = Path.end();
7299 B != BEnd; ++B)
7300 Comps.push_back(OffsetOfNode(B->Base));
7301 }
Eli Friedman74ef7cf2010-08-05 10:11:36 +00007302
7303 if (AnonStructUnion) {
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +00007304 llvm::SmallVector<FieldDecl*, 4> Path;
7305 BuildAnonymousStructUnionMemberPath(MemberDecl, Path);
7306 unsigned n = Path.size();
7307 for (int j = n - 1; j > -1; --j)
7308 Comps.push_back(OffsetOfNode(OC.LocStart, Path[j], OC.LocEnd));
7309 } else {
7310 Comps.push_back(OffsetOfNode(OC.LocStart, MemberDecl, OC.LocEnd));
7311 }
7312 CurrentType = MemberDecl->getType().getNonReferenceType();
7313 }
7314
7315 return Owned(OffsetOfExpr::Create(Context, Context.getSizeType(), BuiltinLoc,
7316 TInfo, Comps.data(), Comps.size(),
7317 Exprs.data(), Exprs.size(), RParenLoc));
7318}
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007319
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00007320ExprResult Sema::ActOnBuiltinOffsetOf(Scope *S,
John McCall36226622010-10-12 02:09:17 +00007321 SourceLocation BuiltinLoc,
7322 SourceLocation TypeLoc,
7323 ParsedType argty,
7324 OffsetOfComponent *CompPtr,
7325 unsigned NumComponents,
7326 SourceLocation RPLoc) {
7327
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +00007328 TypeSourceInfo *ArgTInfo;
7329 QualType ArgTy = GetTypeFromParser(argty, &ArgTInfo);
7330 if (ArgTy.isNull())
7331 return ExprError();
7332
Eli Friedman06dcfd92010-08-05 10:15:45 +00007333 if (!ArgTInfo)
7334 ArgTInfo = Context.getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(ArgTy, TypeLoc);
7335
7336 return BuildBuiltinOffsetOf(BuiltinLoc, ArgTInfo, CompPtr, NumComponents,
7337 RPLoc);
Chris Lattnerf17bd422007-08-30 17:45:32 +00007338}
7339
7340
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00007341ExprResult Sema::ActOnTypesCompatibleExpr(SourceLocation BuiltinLoc,
John McCall36226622010-10-12 02:09:17 +00007342 ParsedType arg1, ParsedType arg2,
7343 SourceLocation RPLoc) {
Abramo Bagnara092990a2010-08-10 08:50:03 +00007344 TypeSourceInfo *argTInfo1;
7345 QualType argT1 = GetTypeFromParser(arg1, &argTInfo1);
7346 TypeSourceInfo *argTInfo2;
7347 QualType argT2 = GetTypeFromParser(arg2, &argTInfo2);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007348
Steve Naroff78864672007-08-01 22:05:33 +00007349 assert((!argT1.isNull() && !argT2.isNull()) && "Missing type argument(s)");
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007350
Abramo Bagnara092990a2010-08-10 08:50:03 +00007351 return BuildTypesCompatibleExpr(BuiltinLoc, argTInfo1, argTInfo2, RPLoc);
7352}
7353
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00007354ExprResult
Abramo Bagnara092990a2010-08-10 08:50:03 +00007355Sema::BuildTypesCompatibleExpr(SourceLocation BuiltinLoc,
7356 TypeSourceInfo *argTInfo1,
7357 TypeSourceInfo *argTInfo2,
7358 SourceLocation RPLoc) {
Douglas Gregorf907cbf2009-05-19 22:28:02 +00007359 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
7360 Diag(BuiltinLoc, diag::err_types_compatible_p_in_cplusplus)
7361 << SourceRange(BuiltinLoc, RPLoc);
7362 return ExprError();
7363 }
7364
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00007365 return Owned(new (Context) TypesCompatibleExpr(Context.IntTy, BuiltinLoc,
Abramo Bagnara092990a2010-08-10 08:50:03 +00007366 argTInfo1, argTInfo2, RPLoc));
Steve Naroff78864672007-08-01 22:05:33 +00007367}
7368
Abramo Bagnara092990a2010-08-10 08:50:03 +00007369
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00007370ExprResult Sema::ActOnChooseExpr(SourceLocation BuiltinLoc,
John McCall36226622010-10-12 02:09:17 +00007371 Expr *CondExpr,
7372 Expr *LHSExpr, Expr *RHSExpr,
7373 SourceLocation RPLoc) {
Steve Naroff9efdabc2007-08-03 21:21:27 +00007374 assert((CondExpr && LHSExpr && RHSExpr) && "Missing type argument(s)");
7375
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00007376 QualType resType;
Douglas Gregor56751b52009-09-25 04:25:58 +00007377 bool ValueDependent = false;
Douglas Gregor0df91122009-05-19 22:43:30 +00007378 if (CondExpr->isTypeDependent() || CondExpr->isValueDependent()) {
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00007379 resType = Context.DependentTy;
Douglas Gregor56751b52009-09-25 04:25:58 +00007380 ValueDependent = true;
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00007381 } else {
7382 // The conditional expression is required to be a constant expression.
7383 llvm::APSInt condEval(32);
7384 SourceLocation ExpLoc;
7385 if (!CondExpr->isIntegerConstantExpr(condEval, Context, &ExpLoc))
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00007386 return ExprError(Diag(ExpLoc,
7387 diag::err_typecheck_choose_expr_requires_constant)
7388 << CondExpr->getSourceRange());
Steve Naroff9efdabc2007-08-03 21:21:27 +00007389
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00007390 // If the condition is > zero, then the AST type is the same as the LSHExpr.
7391 resType = condEval.getZExtValue() ? LHSExpr->getType() : RHSExpr->getType();
Douglas Gregor56751b52009-09-25 04:25:58 +00007392 ValueDependent = condEval.getZExtValue() ? LHSExpr->isValueDependent()
7393 : RHSExpr->isValueDependent();
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00007394 }
7395
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00007396 return Owned(new (Context) ChooseExpr(BuiltinLoc, CondExpr, LHSExpr, RHSExpr,
Douglas Gregor56751b52009-09-25 04:25:58 +00007397 resType, RPLoc,
7398 resType->isDependentType(),
7399 ValueDependent));
Steve Naroff9efdabc2007-08-03 21:21:27 +00007400}
7401
Steve Naroffc540d662008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007402//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
7403// Clang Extensions.
7404//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
7405
7406/// ActOnBlockStart - This callback is invoked when a block literal is started.
Steve Naroff1d95e5a2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00007407void Sema::ActOnBlockStart(SourceLocation CaretLoc, Scope *BlockScope) {
Douglas Gregor9a28e842010-03-01 23:15:13 +00007408 BlockDecl *Block = BlockDecl::Create(Context, CurContext, CaretLoc);
7409 PushBlockScope(BlockScope, Block);
7410 CurContext->addDecl(Block);
Fariborz Jahanian1babe772010-07-09 18:44:02 +00007411 if (BlockScope)
7412 PushDeclContext(BlockScope, Block);
7413 else
7414 CurContext = Block;
Steve Naroff1d95e5a2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00007415}
7416
Mike Stump82f071f2009-02-04 22:31:32 +00007417void Sema::ActOnBlockArguments(Declarator &ParamInfo, Scope *CurScope) {
Mike Stumpf70bcf72009-05-07 18:43:07 +00007418 assert(ParamInfo.getIdentifier()==0 && "block-id should have no identifier!");
Douglas Gregor9a28e842010-03-01 23:15:13 +00007419 BlockScopeInfo *CurBlock = getCurBlock();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007420
John McCall8cb7bdf2010-06-04 23:28:52 +00007421 TypeSourceInfo *Sig = GetTypeForDeclarator(ParamInfo, CurScope);
John McCalla3ccba02010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007422 CurBlock->TheDecl->setSignatureAsWritten(Sig);
John McCall8cb7bdf2010-06-04 23:28:52 +00007423 QualType T = Sig->getType();
Mike Stump82f071f2009-02-04 22:31:32 +00007424
John McCall8e346702010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007425 bool isVariadic;
John McCalla3ccba02010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007426 QualType RetTy;
7427 if (const FunctionType *Fn = T->getAs<FunctionType>()) {
John McCall8e346702010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007428 CurBlock->FunctionType = T;
John McCalla3ccba02010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007429 RetTy = Fn->getResultType();
John McCall8e346702010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007430 isVariadic =
John McCalla3ccba02010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007431 !isa<FunctionProtoType>(Fn) || cast<FunctionProtoType>(Fn)->isVariadic();
7432 } else {
7433 RetTy = T;
John McCall8e346702010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007434 isVariadic = false;
John McCalla3ccba02010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007435 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007436
John McCall8e346702010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007437 CurBlock->TheDecl->setIsVariadic(isVariadic);
Douglas Gregorb92a1562010-02-03 00:27:59 +00007438
John McCalla3ccba02010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007439 // Don't allow returning an array by value.
7440 if (RetTy->isArrayType()) {
7441 Diag(ParamInfo.getSourceRange().getBegin(), diag::err_block_returns_array);
Mike Stump82f071f2009-02-04 22:31:32 +00007442 return;
7443 }
7444
John McCalla3ccba02010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007445 // Don't allow returning a objc interface by value.
7446 if (RetTy->isObjCObjectType()) {
7447 Diag(ParamInfo.getSourceRange().getBegin(),
7448 diag::err_object_cannot_be_passed_returned_by_value) << 0 << RetTy;
7449 return;
7450 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007451
John McCalla3ccba02010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007452 // Context.DependentTy is used as a placeholder for a missing block
John McCall8e346702010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007453 // return type. TODO: what should we do with declarators like:
7454 // ^ * { ... }
7455 // If the answer is "apply template argument deduction"....
John McCalla3ccba02010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007456 if (RetTy != Context.DependentTy)
7457 CurBlock->ReturnType = RetTy;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007458
John McCalla3ccba02010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007459 // Push block parameters from the declarator if we had them.
John McCall8e346702010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007460 llvm::SmallVector<ParmVarDecl*, 8> Params;
John McCalla3ccba02010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007461 if (isa<FunctionProtoType>(T)) {
7462 FunctionProtoTypeLoc TL = cast<FunctionProtoTypeLoc>(Sig->getTypeLoc());
7463 for (unsigned I = 0, E = TL.getNumArgs(); I != E; ++I) {
7464 ParmVarDecl *Param = TL.getArg(I);
Fariborz Jahanian5ec502e2010-02-12 21:53:14 +00007465 if (Param->getIdentifier() == 0 &&
7466 !Param->isImplicit() &&
7467 !Param->isInvalidDecl() &&
7468 !getLangOptions().CPlusPlus)
7469 Diag(Param->getLocation(), diag::err_parameter_name_omitted);
John McCall8e346702010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007470 Params.push_back(Param);
Fariborz Jahanian5ec502e2010-02-12 21:53:14 +00007471 }
John McCalla3ccba02010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007472
7473 // Fake up parameter variables if we have a typedef, like
7474 // ^ fntype { ... }
7475 } else if (const FunctionProtoType *Fn = T->getAs<FunctionProtoType>()) {
7476 for (FunctionProtoType::arg_type_iterator
7477 I = Fn->arg_type_begin(), E = Fn->arg_type_end(); I != E; ++I) {
7478 ParmVarDecl *Param =
7479 BuildParmVarDeclForTypedef(CurBlock->TheDecl,
7480 ParamInfo.getSourceRange().getBegin(),
7481 *I);
John McCall8e346702010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007482 Params.push_back(Param);
John McCalla3ccba02010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007483 }
Steve Naroffc540d662008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007484 }
John McCalla3ccba02010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007485
John McCall8e346702010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007486 // Set the parameters on the block decl.
Douglas Gregorb524d902010-11-01 18:37:59 +00007487 if (!Params.empty()) {
John McCall8e346702010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007488 CurBlock->TheDecl->setParams(Params.data(), Params.size());
Douglas Gregorb524d902010-11-01 18:37:59 +00007489 CheckParmsForFunctionDef(CurBlock->TheDecl->param_begin(),
7490 CurBlock->TheDecl->param_end(),
7491 /*CheckParameterNames=*/false);
7492 }
7493
John McCalla3ccba02010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007494 // Finally we can process decl attributes.
Douglas Gregor758a8692009-06-17 21:51:59 +00007495 ProcessDeclAttributes(CurScope, CurBlock->TheDecl, ParamInfo);
John McCalldf8b37c2010-03-22 09:20:08 +00007496
John McCall8e346702010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007497 if (!isVariadic && CurBlock->TheDecl->getAttr<SentinelAttr>()) {
John McCalla3ccba02010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007498 Diag(ParamInfo.getAttributes()->getLoc(),
7499 diag::warn_attribute_sentinel_not_variadic) << 1;
7500 // FIXME: remove the attribute.
7501 }
7502
7503 // Put the parameter variables in scope. We can bail out immediately
7504 // if we don't have any.
John McCall8e346702010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007505 if (Params.empty())
John McCalla3ccba02010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007506 return;
7507
John McCalldf8b37c2010-03-22 09:20:08 +00007508 bool ShouldCheckShadow =
7509 Diags.getDiagnosticLevel(diag::warn_decl_shadow) != Diagnostic::Ignored;
7510
Steve Naroff1d95e5a2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00007511 for (BlockDecl::param_iterator AI = CurBlock->TheDecl->param_begin(),
John McCallf7b2fb52010-01-22 00:28:27 +00007512 E = CurBlock->TheDecl->param_end(); AI != E; ++AI) {
7513 (*AI)->setOwningFunction(CurBlock->TheDecl);
7514
Steve Naroff1d95e5a2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00007515 // If this has an identifier, add it to the scope stack.
John McCalldf8b37c2010-03-22 09:20:08 +00007516 if ((*AI)->getIdentifier()) {
7517 if (ShouldCheckShadow)
7518 CheckShadow(CurBlock->TheScope, *AI);
7519
Steve Naroff1d95e5a2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00007520 PushOnScopeChains(*AI, CurBlock->TheScope);
John McCalldf8b37c2010-03-22 09:20:08 +00007521 }
John McCallf7b2fb52010-01-22 00:28:27 +00007522 }
Steve Naroffc540d662008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007523}
7524
7525/// ActOnBlockError - If there is an error parsing a block, this callback
7526/// is invoked to pop the information about the block from the action impl.
7527void Sema::ActOnBlockError(SourceLocation CaretLoc, Scope *CurScope) {
Steve Naroffc540d662008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007528 // Pop off CurBlock, handle nested blocks.
Chris Lattner41b86942009-04-21 22:38:46 +00007529 PopDeclContext();
Douglas Gregor9a28e842010-03-01 23:15:13 +00007530 PopFunctionOrBlockScope();
Steve Naroffc540d662008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007531}
7532
7533/// ActOnBlockStmtExpr - This is called when the body of a block statement
7534/// literal was successfully completed. ^(int x){...}
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00007535ExprResult Sema::ActOnBlockStmtExpr(SourceLocation CaretLoc,
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00007536 Stmt *Body, Scope *CurScope) {
Chris Lattner9eac9312009-03-27 04:18:06 +00007537 // If blocks are disabled, emit an error.
7538 if (!LangOpts.Blocks)
7539 Diag(CaretLoc, diag::err_blocks_disable);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007540
Douglas Gregor9a28e842010-03-01 23:15:13 +00007541 BlockScopeInfo *BSI = cast<BlockScopeInfo>(FunctionScopes.back());
Fariborz Jahanian1babe772010-07-09 18:44:02 +00007542
Steve Naroff1d95e5a2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00007543 PopDeclContext();
7544
Steve Naroffc540d662008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007545 QualType RetTy = Context.VoidTy;
Fariborz Jahanian3fd73102009-06-19 23:37:08 +00007546 if (!BSI->ReturnType.isNull())
7547 RetTy = BSI->ReturnType;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007548
Mike Stump3bf1ab42009-07-28 22:04:01 +00007549 bool NoReturn = BSI->TheDecl->getAttr<NoReturnAttr>();
Steve Naroffc540d662008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007550 QualType BlockTy;
John McCall8e346702010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007551
7552 // If the user wrote a function type in some form, try to use that.
7553 if (!BSI->FunctionType.isNull()) {
7554 const FunctionType *FTy = BSI->FunctionType->getAs<FunctionType>();
7555
7556 FunctionType::ExtInfo Ext = FTy->getExtInfo();
7557 if (NoReturn && !Ext.getNoReturn()) Ext = Ext.withNoReturn(true);
7558
7559 // Turn protoless block types into nullary block types.
7560 if (isa<FunctionNoProtoType>(FTy)) {
7561 BlockTy = Context.getFunctionType(RetTy, 0, 0, false, 0,
7562 false, false, 0, 0, Ext);
7563
7564 // Otherwise, if we don't need to change anything about the function type,
7565 // preserve its sugar structure.
7566 } else if (FTy->getResultType() == RetTy &&
7567 (!NoReturn || FTy->getNoReturnAttr())) {
7568 BlockTy = BSI->FunctionType;
7569
7570 // Otherwise, make the minimal modifications to the function type.
7571 } else {
7572 const FunctionProtoType *FPT = cast<FunctionProtoType>(FTy);
7573 BlockTy = Context.getFunctionType(RetTy,
7574 FPT->arg_type_begin(),
7575 FPT->getNumArgs(),
7576 FPT->isVariadic(),
7577 /*quals*/ 0,
7578 FPT->hasExceptionSpec(),
7579 FPT->hasAnyExceptionSpec(),
7580 FPT->getNumExceptions(),
7581 FPT->exception_begin(),
7582 Ext);
7583 }
7584
7585 // If we don't have a function type, just build one from nothing.
7586 } else {
7587 BlockTy = Context.getFunctionType(RetTy, 0, 0, false, 0,
7588 false, false, 0, 0,
7589 FunctionType::ExtInfo(NoReturn, 0, CC_Default));
7590 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007591
John McCall8e346702010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007592 DiagnoseUnusedParameters(BSI->TheDecl->param_begin(),
7593 BSI->TheDecl->param_end());
Steve Naroffc540d662008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007594 BlockTy = Context.getBlockPointerType(BlockTy);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007595
Chris Lattner45542ea2009-04-19 05:28:12 +00007596 // If needed, diagnose invalid gotos and switches in the block.
John McCallaab3e412010-08-25 08:40:02 +00007597 if (getCurFunction()->NeedsScopeChecking() && !hasAnyErrorsInThisFunction())
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00007598 DiagnoseInvalidJumps(cast<CompoundStmt>(Body));
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007599
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00007600 BSI->TheDecl->setBody(cast<CompoundStmt>(Body));
Mike Stump314825b2010-01-19 23:08:01 +00007601
7602 bool Good = true;
7603 // Check goto/label use.
7604 for (llvm::DenseMap<IdentifierInfo*, LabelStmt*>::iterator
7605 I = BSI->LabelMap.begin(), E = BSI->LabelMap.end(); I != E; ++I) {
7606 LabelStmt *L = I->second;
7607
7608 // Verify that we have no forward references left. If so, there was a goto
7609 // or address of a label taken, but no definition of it.
Argyrios Kyrtzidis72664df2010-09-19 21:21:25 +00007610 if (L->getSubStmt() != 0) {
7611 if (!L->isUsed())
7612 Diag(L->getIdentLoc(), diag::warn_unused_label) << L->getName();
Mike Stump314825b2010-01-19 23:08:01 +00007613 continue;
Argyrios Kyrtzidis72664df2010-09-19 21:21:25 +00007614 }
Mike Stump314825b2010-01-19 23:08:01 +00007615
7616 // Emit error.
7617 Diag(L->getIdentLoc(), diag::err_undeclared_label_use) << L->getName();
7618 Good = false;
7619 }
Douglas Gregor9a28e842010-03-01 23:15:13 +00007620 if (!Good) {
7621 PopFunctionOrBlockScope();
Mike Stump314825b2010-01-19 23:08:01 +00007622 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregor9a28e842010-03-01 23:15:13 +00007623 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007624
John McCall1d570a72010-08-25 05:56:39 +00007625 BlockExpr *Result = new (Context) BlockExpr(BSI->TheDecl, BlockTy,
7626 BSI->hasBlockDeclRefExprs);
7627
Ted Kremenek918fe842010-03-20 21:06:02 +00007628 // Issue any analysis-based warnings.
Ted Kremenek0b405322010-03-23 00:13:23 +00007629 const sema::AnalysisBasedWarnings::Policy &WP =
7630 AnalysisWarnings.getDefaultPolicy();
John McCall1d570a72010-08-25 05:56:39 +00007631 AnalysisWarnings.IssueWarnings(WP, Result);
Ted Kremenek918fe842010-03-20 21:06:02 +00007632
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007633 PopFunctionOrBlockScope();
Douglas Gregor9a28e842010-03-01 23:15:13 +00007634 return Owned(Result);
Steve Naroffc540d662008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007635}
7636
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00007637ExprResult Sema::ActOnVAArg(SourceLocation BuiltinLoc,
John McCallba7bf592010-08-24 05:47:05 +00007638 Expr *expr, ParsedType type,
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00007639 SourceLocation RPLoc) {
Abramo Bagnara27db2392010-08-10 10:06:15 +00007640 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo;
7641 QualType T = GetTypeFromParser(type, &TInfo);
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00007642 return BuildVAArgExpr(BuiltinLoc, expr, TInfo, RPLoc);
Abramo Bagnara27db2392010-08-10 10:06:15 +00007643}
7644
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00007645ExprResult Sema::BuildVAArgExpr(SourceLocation BuiltinLoc,
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00007646 Expr *E, TypeSourceInfo *TInfo,
Abramo Bagnara27db2392010-08-10 10:06:15 +00007647 SourceLocation RPLoc) {
Chris Lattner56382aa2009-04-05 15:49:53 +00007648 Expr *OrigExpr = E;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007649
Eli Friedman121ba0c2008-08-09 23:32:40 +00007650 // Get the va_list type
7651 QualType VaListType = Context.getBuiltinVaListType();
Eli Friedmane2cad652009-05-16 12:46:54 +00007652 if (VaListType->isArrayType()) {
7653 // Deal with implicit array decay; for example, on x86-64,
7654 // va_list is an array, but it's supposed to decay to
7655 // a pointer for va_arg.
Eli Friedman121ba0c2008-08-09 23:32:40 +00007656 VaListType = Context.getArrayDecayedType(VaListType);
Eli Friedmane2cad652009-05-16 12:46:54 +00007657 // Make sure the input expression also decays appropriately.
7658 UsualUnaryConversions(E);
7659 } else {
7660 // Otherwise, the va_list argument must be an l-value because
7661 // it is modified by va_arg.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007662 if (!E->isTypeDependent() &&
Douglas Gregorad3150c2009-05-19 23:10:31 +00007663 CheckForModifiableLvalue(E, BuiltinLoc, *this))
Eli Friedmane2cad652009-05-16 12:46:54 +00007664 return ExprError();
7665 }
Eli Friedman121ba0c2008-08-09 23:32:40 +00007666
Douglas Gregorad3150c2009-05-19 23:10:31 +00007667 if (!E->isTypeDependent() &&
7668 !Context.hasSameType(VaListType, E->getType())) {
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00007669 return ExprError(Diag(E->getLocStart(),
7670 diag::err_first_argument_to_va_arg_not_of_type_va_list)
Chris Lattner56382aa2009-04-05 15:49:53 +00007671 << OrigExpr->getType() << E->getSourceRange());
Chris Lattner3f5cd772009-04-05 00:59:53 +00007672 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007673
Eli Friedmanba961a92009-03-23 00:24:07 +00007674 // FIXME: Check that type is complete/non-abstract
Anders Carlsson7e13ab82007-10-15 20:28:48 +00007675 // FIXME: Warn if a non-POD type is passed in.
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007676
Abramo Bagnara27db2392010-08-10 10:06:15 +00007677 QualType T = TInfo->getType().getNonLValueExprType(Context);
7678 return Owned(new (Context) VAArgExpr(BuiltinLoc, E, TInfo, RPLoc, T));
Anders Carlsson7e13ab82007-10-15 20:28:48 +00007679}
7680
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00007681ExprResult Sema::ActOnGNUNullExpr(SourceLocation TokenLoc) {
Douglas Gregor3be4b122008-11-29 04:51:27 +00007682 // The type of __null will be int or long, depending on the size of
7683 // pointers on the target.
7684 QualType Ty;
7685 if (Context.Target.getPointerWidth(0) == Context.Target.getIntWidth())
7686 Ty = Context.IntTy;
7687 else
7688 Ty = Context.LongTy;
7689
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00007690 return Owned(new (Context) GNUNullExpr(Ty, TokenLoc));
Douglas Gregor3be4b122008-11-29 04:51:27 +00007691}
7692
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00007693static void MakeObjCStringLiteralFixItHint(Sema& SemaRef, QualType DstType,
Douglas Gregora771f462010-03-31 17:46:05 +00007694 Expr *SrcExpr, FixItHint &Hint) {
Anders Carlssonace5d072009-11-10 04:46:30 +00007695 if (!SemaRef.getLangOptions().ObjC1)
7696 return;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007697
Anders Carlssonace5d072009-11-10 04:46:30 +00007698 const ObjCObjectPointerType *PT = DstType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
7699 if (!PT)
7700 return;
7701
7702 // Check if the destination is of type 'id'.
7703 if (!PT->isObjCIdType()) {
7704 // Check if the destination is the 'NSString' interface.
7705 const ObjCInterfaceDecl *ID = PT->getInterfaceDecl();
7706 if (!ID || !ID->getIdentifier()->isStr("NSString"))
7707 return;
7708 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007709
Anders Carlssonace5d072009-11-10 04:46:30 +00007710 // Strip off any parens and casts.
7711 StringLiteral *SL = dyn_cast<StringLiteral>(SrcExpr->IgnoreParenCasts());
7712 if (!SL || SL->isWide())
7713 return;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007714
Douglas Gregora771f462010-03-31 17:46:05 +00007715 Hint = FixItHint::CreateInsertion(SL->getLocStart(), "@");
Anders Carlssonace5d072009-11-10 04:46:30 +00007716}
7717
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00007718bool Sema::DiagnoseAssignmentResult(AssignConvertType ConvTy,
7719 SourceLocation Loc,
7720 QualType DstType, QualType SrcType,
Douglas Gregor4f4946a2010-04-22 00:20:18 +00007721 Expr *SrcExpr, AssignmentAction Action,
7722 bool *Complained) {
7723 if (Complained)
7724 *Complained = false;
7725
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00007726 // Decode the result (notice that AST's are still created for extensions).
7727 bool isInvalid = false;
7728 unsigned DiagKind;
Douglas Gregora771f462010-03-31 17:46:05 +00007729 FixItHint Hint;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007730
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00007731 switch (ConvTy) {
7732 default: assert(0 && "Unknown conversion type");
7733 case Compatible: return false;
Chris Lattner940cfeb2008-01-04 18:22:42 +00007734 case PointerToInt:
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00007735 DiagKind = diag::ext_typecheck_convert_pointer_int;
7736 break;
Chris Lattner940cfeb2008-01-04 18:22:42 +00007737 case IntToPointer:
7738 DiagKind = diag::ext_typecheck_convert_int_pointer;
7739 break;
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00007740 case IncompatiblePointer:
Douglas Gregora771f462010-03-31 17:46:05 +00007741 MakeObjCStringLiteralFixItHint(*this, DstType, SrcExpr, Hint);
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00007742 DiagKind = diag::ext_typecheck_convert_incompatible_pointer;
7743 break;
Eli Friedman80160bd2009-03-22 23:59:44 +00007744 case IncompatiblePointerSign:
7745 DiagKind = diag::ext_typecheck_convert_incompatible_pointer_sign;
7746 break;
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00007747 case FunctionVoidPointer:
7748 DiagKind = diag::ext_typecheck_convert_pointer_void_func;
7749 break;
7750 case CompatiblePointerDiscardsQualifiers:
Douglas Gregoraa1e21d2008-09-12 00:47:35 +00007751 // If the qualifiers lost were because we were applying the
7752 // (deprecated) C++ conversion from a string literal to a char*
7753 // (or wchar_t*), then there was no error (C++ 4.2p2). FIXME:
7754 // Ideally, this check would be performed in
7755 // CheckPointerTypesForAssignment. However, that would require a
7756 // bit of refactoring (so that the second argument is an
7757 // expression, rather than a type), which should be done as part
7758 // of a larger effort to fix CheckPointerTypesForAssignment for
7759 // C++ semantics.
7760 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus &&
7761 IsStringLiteralToNonConstPointerConversion(SrcExpr, DstType))
7762 return false;
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00007763 DiagKind = diag::ext_typecheck_convert_discards_qualifiers;
7764 break;
Alexis Hunt6f3de502009-11-08 07:46:34 +00007765 case IncompatibleNestedPointerQualifiers:
Fariborz Jahanianb98dade2009-11-09 22:16:37 +00007766 DiagKind = diag::ext_nested_pointer_qualifier_mismatch;
Fariborz Jahaniand7aa9d82009-11-07 20:20:40 +00007767 break;
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00007768 case IntToBlockPointer:
7769 DiagKind = diag::err_int_to_block_pointer;
7770 break;
7771 case IncompatibleBlockPointer:
Mike Stumpd79b5a82009-04-21 22:51:42 +00007772 DiagKind = diag::err_typecheck_convert_incompatible_block_pointer;
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00007773 break;
Steve Naroff8afa9892008-10-14 22:18:38 +00007774 case IncompatibleObjCQualifiedId:
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007775 // FIXME: Diagnose the problem in ObjCQualifiedIdTypesAreCompatible, since
Steve Naroff8afa9892008-10-14 22:18:38 +00007776 // it can give a more specific diagnostic.
7777 DiagKind = diag::warn_incompatible_qualified_id;
7778 break;
Anders Carlssondb5a9b62009-01-30 23:17:46 +00007779 case IncompatibleVectors:
7780 DiagKind = diag::warn_incompatible_vectors;
7781 break;
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00007782 case Incompatible:
7783 DiagKind = diag::err_typecheck_convert_incompatible;
7784 isInvalid = true;
7785 break;
7786 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007787
Douglas Gregorc68e1402010-04-09 00:35:39 +00007788 QualType FirstType, SecondType;
7789 switch (Action) {
7790 case AA_Assigning:
7791 case AA_Initializing:
7792 // The destination type comes first.
7793 FirstType = DstType;
7794 SecondType = SrcType;
7795 break;
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00007796
Douglas Gregorc68e1402010-04-09 00:35:39 +00007797 case AA_Returning:
7798 case AA_Passing:
7799 case AA_Converting:
7800 case AA_Sending:
7801 case AA_Casting:
7802 // The source type comes first.
7803 FirstType = SrcType;
7804 SecondType = DstType;
7805 break;
7806 }
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00007807
Douglas Gregorc68e1402010-04-09 00:35:39 +00007808 Diag(Loc, DiagKind) << FirstType << SecondType << Action
Anders Carlssonace5d072009-11-10 04:46:30 +00007809 << SrcExpr->getSourceRange() << Hint;
Douglas Gregor4f4946a2010-04-22 00:20:18 +00007810 if (Complained)
7811 *Complained = true;
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00007812 return isInvalid;
7813}
Anders Carlssone54e8a12008-11-30 19:50:32 +00007814
Chris Lattnerc71d08b2009-04-25 21:59:05 +00007815bool Sema::VerifyIntegerConstantExpression(const Expr *E, llvm::APSInt *Result){
Eli Friedmanbb967cc2009-04-25 22:26:58 +00007816 llvm::APSInt ICEResult;
7817 if (E->isIntegerConstantExpr(ICEResult, Context)) {
7818 if (Result)
7819 *Result = ICEResult;
7820 return false;
7821 }
7822
Anders Carlssone54e8a12008-11-30 19:50:32 +00007823 Expr::EvalResult EvalResult;
7824
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007825 if (!E->Evaluate(EvalResult, Context) || !EvalResult.Val.isInt() ||
Anders Carlssone54e8a12008-11-30 19:50:32 +00007826 EvalResult.HasSideEffects) {
7827 Diag(E->getExprLoc(), diag::err_expr_not_ice) << E->getSourceRange();
7828
7829 if (EvalResult.Diag) {
7830 // We only show the note if it's not the usual "invalid subexpression"
7831 // or if it's actually in a subexpression.
7832 if (EvalResult.Diag != diag::note_invalid_subexpr_in_ice ||
7833 E->IgnoreParens() != EvalResult.DiagExpr->IgnoreParens())
7834 Diag(EvalResult.DiagLoc, EvalResult.Diag);
7835 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007836
Anders Carlssone54e8a12008-11-30 19:50:32 +00007837 return true;
7838 }
7839
Eli Friedmanbb967cc2009-04-25 22:26:58 +00007840 Diag(E->getExprLoc(), diag::ext_expr_not_ice) <<
7841 E->getSourceRange();
Anders Carlssone54e8a12008-11-30 19:50:32 +00007842
Eli Friedmanbb967cc2009-04-25 22:26:58 +00007843 if (EvalResult.Diag &&
7844 Diags.getDiagnosticLevel(diag::ext_expr_not_ice) != Diagnostic::Ignored)
7845 Diag(EvalResult.DiagLoc, EvalResult.Diag);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007846
Anders Carlssone54e8a12008-11-30 19:50:32 +00007847 if (Result)
7848 *Result = EvalResult.Val.getInt();
7849 return false;
7850}
Douglas Gregorc9c02ed2009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007851
Douglas Gregorff790f12009-11-26 00:44:06 +00007852void
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007853Sema::PushExpressionEvaluationContext(ExpressionEvaluationContext NewContext) {
Douglas Gregorff790f12009-11-26 00:44:06 +00007854 ExprEvalContexts.push_back(
7855 ExpressionEvaluationContextRecord(NewContext, ExprTemporaries.size()));
Douglas Gregor0b6a6242009-06-22 20:57:11 +00007856}
7857
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007858void
Douglas Gregorff790f12009-11-26 00:44:06 +00007859Sema::PopExpressionEvaluationContext() {
7860 // Pop the current expression evaluation context off the stack.
7861 ExpressionEvaluationContextRecord Rec = ExprEvalContexts.back();
7862 ExprEvalContexts.pop_back();
Douglas Gregor0b6a6242009-06-22 20:57:11 +00007863
Douglas Gregorfab31f42009-12-12 07:57:52 +00007864 if (Rec.Context == PotentiallyPotentiallyEvaluated) {
7865 if (Rec.PotentiallyReferenced) {
7866 // Mark any remaining declarations in the current position of the stack
7867 // as "referenced". If they were not meant to be referenced, semantic
7868 // analysis would have eliminated them (e.g., in ActOnCXXTypeId).
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007869 for (PotentiallyReferencedDecls::iterator
Douglas Gregorfab31f42009-12-12 07:57:52 +00007870 I = Rec.PotentiallyReferenced->begin(),
7871 IEnd = Rec.PotentiallyReferenced->end();
7872 I != IEnd; ++I)
7873 MarkDeclarationReferenced(I->first, I->second);
7874 }
7875
7876 if (Rec.PotentiallyDiagnosed) {
7877 // Emit any pending diagnostics.
7878 for (PotentiallyEmittedDiagnostics::iterator
7879 I = Rec.PotentiallyDiagnosed->begin(),
7880 IEnd = Rec.PotentiallyDiagnosed->end();
7881 I != IEnd; ++I)
7882 Diag(I->first, I->second);
7883 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007884 }
Douglas Gregorff790f12009-11-26 00:44:06 +00007885
7886 // When are coming out of an unevaluated context, clear out any
7887 // temporaries that we may have created as part of the evaluation of
7888 // the expression in that context: they aren't relevant because they
7889 // will never be constructed.
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007890 if (Rec.Context == Unevaluated &&
Douglas Gregorff790f12009-11-26 00:44:06 +00007891 ExprTemporaries.size() > Rec.NumTemporaries)
7892 ExprTemporaries.erase(ExprTemporaries.begin() + Rec.NumTemporaries,
7893 ExprTemporaries.end());
7894
7895 // Destroy the popped expression evaluation record.
7896 Rec.Destroy();
Douglas Gregor0b6a6242009-06-22 20:57:11 +00007897}
Douglas Gregorc9c02ed2009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007898
7899/// \brief Note that the given declaration was referenced in the source code.
7900///
7901/// This routine should be invoke whenever a given declaration is referenced
7902/// in the source code, and where that reference occurred. If this declaration
7903/// reference means that the the declaration is used (C++ [basic.def.odr]p2,
7904/// C99 6.9p3), then the declaration will be marked as used.
7905///
7906/// \param Loc the location where the declaration was referenced.
7907///
7908/// \param D the declaration that has been referenced by the source code.
7909void Sema::MarkDeclarationReferenced(SourceLocation Loc, Decl *D) {
7910 assert(D && "No declaration?");
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007911
Douglas Gregorebada0772010-06-17 23:14:26 +00007912 if (D->isUsed(false))
Douglas Gregor77b50e12009-06-22 23:06:13 +00007913 return;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007914
Douglas Gregor3beaf9b2009-10-08 21:35:42 +00007915 // Mark a parameter or variable declaration "used", regardless of whether we're in a
7916 // template or not. The reason for this is that unevaluated expressions
7917 // (e.g. (void)sizeof()) constitute a use for warning purposes (-Wunused-variables and
7918 // -Wunused-parameters)
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007919 if (isa<ParmVarDecl>(D) ||
Douglas Gregorfd27fed2010-04-07 20:29:57 +00007920 (isa<VarDecl>(D) && D->getDeclContext()->isFunctionOrMethod())) {
Anders Carlsson73067a02010-10-22 23:37:08 +00007921 D->setUsed();
Douglas Gregorfd27fed2010-04-07 20:29:57 +00007922 return;
7923 }
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00007924
Douglas Gregorfd27fed2010-04-07 20:29:57 +00007925 if (!isa<VarDecl>(D) && !isa<FunctionDecl>(D))
7926 return;
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00007927
Douglas Gregorc9c02ed2009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007928 // Do not mark anything as "used" within a dependent context; wait for
7929 // an instantiation.
7930 if (CurContext->isDependentContext())
7931 return;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007932
Douglas Gregorff790f12009-11-26 00:44:06 +00007933 switch (ExprEvalContexts.back().Context) {
Douglas Gregor0b6a6242009-06-22 20:57:11 +00007934 case Unevaluated:
7935 // We are in an expression that is not potentially evaluated; do nothing.
7936 return;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007937
Douglas Gregor0b6a6242009-06-22 20:57:11 +00007938 case PotentiallyEvaluated:
7939 // We are in a potentially-evaluated expression, so this declaration is
7940 // "used"; handle this below.
7941 break;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007942
Douglas Gregor0b6a6242009-06-22 20:57:11 +00007943 case PotentiallyPotentiallyEvaluated:
7944 // We are in an expression that may be potentially evaluated; queue this
7945 // declaration reference until we know whether the expression is
7946 // potentially evaluated.
Douglas Gregorff790f12009-11-26 00:44:06 +00007947 ExprEvalContexts.back().addReferencedDecl(Loc, D);
Douglas Gregor0b6a6242009-06-22 20:57:11 +00007948 return;
Douglas Gregor8a01b2a2010-09-11 20:24:53 +00007949
7950 case PotentiallyEvaluatedIfUsed:
7951 // Referenced declarations will only be used if the construct in the
7952 // containing expression is used.
7953 return;
Douglas Gregor0b6a6242009-06-22 20:57:11 +00007954 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007955
Douglas Gregorc9c02ed2009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007956 // Note that this declaration has been used.
Fariborz Jahanian3a363432009-06-22 17:30:33 +00007957 if (CXXConstructorDecl *Constructor = dyn_cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(D)) {
Fariborz Jahanian477d2422009-06-22 23:34:40 +00007958 unsigned TypeQuals;
Fariborz Jahanian18eb69a2009-06-22 20:37:23 +00007959 if (Constructor->isImplicit() && Constructor->isDefaultConstructor()) {
Chandler Carruthc9262402010-08-23 07:55:51 +00007960 if (Constructor->getParent()->hasTrivialConstructor())
7961 return;
7962 if (!Constructor->isUsed(false))
7963 DefineImplicitDefaultConstructor(Loc, Constructor);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007964 } else if (Constructor->isImplicit() &&
Douglas Gregor507eb872009-12-22 00:34:07 +00007965 Constructor->isCopyConstructor(TypeQuals)) {
Douglas Gregorebada0772010-06-17 23:14:26 +00007966 if (!Constructor->isUsed(false))
Fariborz Jahanian477d2422009-06-22 23:34:40 +00007967 DefineImplicitCopyConstructor(Loc, Constructor, TypeQuals);
7968 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007969
Douglas Gregor88d292c2010-05-13 16:44:06 +00007970 MarkVTableUsed(Loc, Constructor->getParent());
Fariborz Jahanian24a175b2009-06-26 23:49:16 +00007971 } else if (CXXDestructorDecl *Destructor = dyn_cast<CXXDestructorDecl>(D)) {
Douglas Gregorebada0772010-06-17 23:14:26 +00007972 if (Destructor->isImplicit() && !Destructor->isUsed(false))
Fariborz Jahanian24a175b2009-06-26 23:49:16 +00007973 DefineImplicitDestructor(Loc, Destructor);
Douglas Gregor88d292c2010-05-13 16:44:06 +00007974 if (Destructor->isVirtual())
7975 MarkVTableUsed(Loc, Destructor->getParent());
Fariborz Jahanian41f79272009-06-25 21:45:19 +00007976 } else if (CXXMethodDecl *MethodDecl = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(D)) {
7977 if (MethodDecl->isImplicit() && MethodDecl->isOverloadedOperator() &&
7978 MethodDecl->getOverloadedOperator() == OO_Equal) {
Douglas Gregorebada0772010-06-17 23:14:26 +00007979 if (!MethodDecl->isUsed(false))
Douglas Gregora57478e2010-05-01 15:04:51 +00007980 DefineImplicitCopyAssignment(Loc, MethodDecl);
Douglas Gregor88d292c2010-05-13 16:44:06 +00007981 } else if (MethodDecl->isVirtual())
7982 MarkVTableUsed(Loc, MethodDecl->getParent());
Fariborz Jahanian41f79272009-06-25 21:45:19 +00007983 }
Fariborz Jahanian49796cc72009-06-24 22:09:44 +00007984 if (FunctionDecl *Function = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(D)) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007985 // Implicit instantiation of function templates and member functions of
Douglas Gregor4adbc6d2009-06-26 00:10:03 +00007986 // class templates.
Douglas Gregor69f6a362010-05-17 17:34:56 +00007987 if (Function->isImplicitlyInstantiable()) {
Douglas Gregor06db9f52009-10-12 20:18:28 +00007988 bool AlreadyInstantiated = false;
7989 if (FunctionTemplateSpecializationInfo *SpecInfo
7990 = Function->getTemplateSpecializationInfo()) {
7991 if (SpecInfo->getPointOfInstantiation().isInvalid())
7992 SpecInfo->setPointOfInstantiation(Loc);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007993 else if (SpecInfo->getTemplateSpecializationKind()
Douglas Gregorafca3b42009-10-27 20:53:28 +00007994 == TSK_ImplicitInstantiation)
Douglas Gregor06db9f52009-10-12 20:18:28 +00007995 AlreadyInstantiated = true;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007996 } else if (MemberSpecializationInfo *MSInfo
Douglas Gregor06db9f52009-10-12 20:18:28 +00007997 = Function->getMemberSpecializationInfo()) {
7998 if (MSInfo->getPointOfInstantiation().isInvalid())
7999 MSInfo->setPointOfInstantiation(Loc);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00008000 else if (MSInfo->getTemplateSpecializationKind()
Douglas Gregorafca3b42009-10-27 20:53:28 +00008001 == TSK_ImplicitInstantiation)
Douglas Gregor06db9f52009-10-12 20:18:28 +00008002 AlreadyInstantiated = true;
8003 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00008004
Douglas Gregor7f792cf2010-01-16 22:29:39 +00008005 if (!AlreadyInstantiated) {
8006 if (isa<CXXRecordDecl>(Function->getDeclContext()) &&
8007 cast<CXXRecordDecl>(Function->getDeclContext())->isLocalClass())
8008 PendingLocalImplicitInstantiations.push_back(std::make_pair(Function,
8009 Loc));
8010 else
Chandler Carruth54080172010-08-25 08:44:16 +00008011 PendingInstantiations.push_back(std::make_pair(Function, Loc));
Douglas Gregor7f792cf2010-01-16 22:29:39 +00008012 }
Gabor Greifb6aba3e2010-08-28 00:16:06 +00008013 } else // Walk redefinitions, as some of them may be instantiable.
8014 for (FunctionDecl::redecl_iterator i(Function->redecls_begin()),
8015 e(Function->redecls_end()); i != e; ++i) {
Gabor Greif34ecff22010-08-28 01:58:12 +00008016 if (!i->isUsed(false) && i->isImplicitlyInstantiable())
Gabor Greifb6aba3e2010-08-28 00:16:06 +00008017 MarkDeclarationReferenced(Loc, *i);
8018 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00008019
Douglas Gregorc9c02ed2009-06-19 23:52:42 +00008020 // FIXME: keep track of references to static functions
Argyrios Kyrtzidisdfffabd2010-08-25 10:34:54 +00008021
8022 // Recursive functions should be marked when used from another function.
8023 if (CurContext != Function)
8024 Function->setUsed(true);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00008025
Douglas Gregorc9c02ed2009-06-19 23:52:42 +00008026 return;
Douglas Gregor77b50e12009-06-22 23:06:13 +00008027 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00008028
Douglas Gregorc9c02ed2009-06-19 23:52:42 +00008029 if (VarDecl *Var = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(D)) {
Douglas Gregora6ef8f02009-07-24 20:34:43 +00008030 // Implicit instantiation of static data members of class templates.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00008031 if (Var->isStaticDataMember() &&
Douglas Gregor06db9f52009-10-12 20:18:28 +00008032 Var->getInstantiatedFromStaticDataMember()) {
8033 MemberSpecializationInfo *MSInfo = Var->getMemberSpecializationInfo();
8034 assert(MSInfo && "Missing member specialization information?");
8035 if (MSInfo->getPointOfInstantiation().isInvalid() &&
8036 MSInfo->getTemplateSpecializationKind()== TSK_ImplicitInstantiation) {
8037 MSInfo->setPointOfInstantiation(Loc);
Chandler Carruth54080172010-08-25 08:44:16 +00008038 PendingInstantiations.push_back(std::make_pair(Var, Loc));
Douglas Gregor06db9f52009-10-12 20:18:28 +00008039 }
8040 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00008041
Douglas Gregorc9c02ed2009-06-19 23:52:42 +00008042 // FIXME: keep track of references to static data?
Douglas Gregora6ef8f02009-07-24 20:34:43 +00008043
Douglas Gregorc9c02ed2009-06-19 23:52:42 +00008044 D->setUsed(true);
Douglas Gregora6ef8f02009-07-24 20:34:43 +00008045 return;
Sam Weinigbae69142009-09-11 03:29:30 +00008046 }
Douglas Gregorc9c02ed2009-06-19 23:52:42 +00008047}
Anders Carlsson7f84ed92009-10-09 23:51:55 +00008048
Douglas Gregor5597ab42010-05-07 23:12:07 +00008049namespace {
Chandler Carruthaf80f662010-06-09 08:17:30 +00008050 // Mark all of the declarations referenced
Douglas Gregor5597ab42010-05-07 23:12:07 +00008051 // FIXME: Not fully implemented yet! We need to have a better understanding
Chandler Carruthaf80f662010-06-09 08:17:30 +00008052 // of when we're entering
Douglas Gregor5597ab42010-05-07 23:12:07 +00008053 class MarkReferencedDecls : public RecursiveASTVisitor<MarkReferencedDecls> {
8054 Sema &S;
8055 SourceLocation Loc;
Chandler Carruthaf80f662010-06-09 08:17:30 +00008056
Douglas Gregor5597ab42010-05-07 23:12:07 +00008057 public:
8058 typedef RecursiveASTVisitor<MarkReferencedDecls> Inherited;
Chandler Carruthaf80f662010-06-09 08:17:30 +00008059
Douglas Gregor5597ab42010-05-07 23:12:07 +00008060 MarkReferencedDecls(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc) : S(S), Loc(Loc) { }
Chandler Carruthaf80f662010-06-09 08:17:30 +00008061
8062 bool TraverseTemplateArgument(const TemplateArgument &Arg);
8063 bool TraverseRecordType(RecordType *T);
Douglas Gregor5597ab42010-05-07 23:12:07 +00008064 };
8065}
8066
Chandler Carruthaf80f662010-06-09 08:17:30 +00008067bool MarkReferencedDecls::TraverseTemplateArgument(
8068 const TemplateArgument &Arg) {
Douglas Gregor5597ab42010-05-07 23:12:07 +00008069 if (Arg.getKind() == TemplateArgument::Declaration) {
8070 S.MarkDeclarationReferenced(Loc, Arg.getAsDecl());
8071 }
Chandler Carruthaf80f662010-06-09 08:17:30 +00008072
8073 return Inherited::TraverseTemplateArgument(Arg);
Douglas Gregor5597ab42010-05-07 23:12:07 +00008074}
8075
Chandler Carruthaf80f662010-06-09 08:17:30 +00008076bool MarkReferencedDecls::TraverseRecordType(RecordType *T) {
Douglas Gregor5597ab42010-05-07 23:12:07 +00008077 if (ClassTemplateSpecializationDecl *Spec
8078 = dyn_cast<ClassTemplateSpecializationDecl>(T->getDecl())) {
8079 const TemplateArgumentList &Args = Spec->getTemplateArgs();
Douglas Gregor1ccc8412010-11-07 23:05:16 +00008080 return TraverseTemplateArguments(Args.data(), Args.size());
Douglas Gregor5597ab42010-05-07 23:12:07 +00008081 }
8082
Chandler Carruthc65667c2010-06-10 10:31:57 +00008083 return true;
Douglas Gregor5597ab42010-05-07 23:12:07 +00008084}
8085
8086void Sema::MarkDeclarationsReferencedInType(SourceLocation Loc, QualType T) {
8087 MarkReferencedDecls Marker(*this, Loc);
Chandler Carruthaf80f662010-06-09 08:17:30 +00008088 Marker.TraverseType(Context.getCanonicalType(T));
Douglas Gregor5597ab42010-05-07 23:12:07 +00008089}
8090
Douglas Gregor8a01b2a2010-09-11 20:24:53 +00008091namespace {
8092 /// \brief Helper class that marks all of the declarations referenced by
8093 /// potentially-evaluated subexpressions as "referenced".
8094 class EvaluatedExprMarker : public EvaluatedExprVisitor<EvaluatedExprMarker> {
8095 Sema &S;
8096
8097 public:
8098 typedef EvaluatedExprVisitor<EvaluatedExprMarker> Inherited;
8099
8100 explicit EvaluatedExprMarker(Sema &S) : Inherited(S.Context), S(S) { }
8101
8102 void VisitDeclRefExpr(DeclRefExpr *E) {
8103 S.MarkDeclarationReferenced(E->getLocation(), E->getDecl());
8104 }
8105
8106 void VisitMemberExpr(MemberExpr *E) {
8107 S.MarkDeclarationReferenced(E->getMemberLoc(), E->getMemberDecl());
Douglas Gregor32b3de52010-09-11 23:32:50 +00008108 Inherited::VisitMemberExpr(E);
Douglas Gregor8a01b2a2010-09-11 20:24:53 +00008109 }
8110
8111 void VisitCXXNewExpr(CXXNewExpr *E) {
8112 if (E->getConstructor())
8113 S.MarkDeclarationReferenced(E->getLocStart(), E->getConstructor());
8114 if (E->getOperatorNew())
8115 S.MarkDeclarationReferenced(E->getLocStart(), E->getOperatorNew());
8116 if (E->getOperatorDelete())
8117 S.MarkDeclarationReferenced(E->getLocStart(), E->getOperatorDelete());
Douglas Gregor32b3de52010-09-11 23:32:50 +00008118 Inherited::VisitCXXNewExpr(E);
Douglas Gregor8a01b2a2010-09-11 20:24:53 +00008119 }
8120
8121 void VisitCXXDeleteExpr(CXXDeleteExpr *E) {
8122 if (E->getOperatorDelete())
8123 S.MarkDeclarationReferenced(E->getLocStart(), E->getOperatorDelete());
Douglas Gregor6ed2fee2010-09-14 22:55:20 +00008124 QualType Destroyed = S.Context.getBaseElementType(E->getDestroyedType());
8125 if (const RecordType *DestroyedRec = Destroyed->getAs<RecordType>()) {
8126 CXXRecordDecl *Record = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(DestroyedRec->getDecl());
8127 S.MarkDeclarationReferenced(E->getLocStart(),
8128 S.LookupDestructor(Record));
8129 }
8130
Douglas Gregor32b3de52010-09-11 23:32:50 +00008131 Inherited::VisitCXXDeleteExpr(E);
Douglas Gregor8a01b2a2010-09-11 20:24:53 +00008132 }
8133
8134 void VisitCXXConstructExpr(CXXConstructExpr *E) {
8135 S.MarkDeclarationReferenced(E->getLocStart(), E->getConstructor());
Douglas Gregor32b3de52010-09-11 23:32:50 +00008136 Inherited::VisitCXXConstructExpr(E);
Douglas Gregor8a01b2a2010-09-11 20:24:53 +00008137 }
8138
8139 void VisitBlockDeclRefExpr(BlockDeclRefExpr *E) {
8140 S.MarkDeclarationReferenced(E->getLocation(), E->getDecl());
8141 }
Douglas Gregorf0873f42010-10-19 17:17:35 +00008142
8143 void VisitCXXDefaultArgExpr(CXXDefaultArgExpr *E) {
8144 Visit(E->getExpr());
8145 }
Douglas Gregor8a01b2a2010-09-11 20:24:53 +00008146 };
8147}
8148
8149/// \brief Mark any declarations that appear within this expression or any
8150/// potentially-evaluated subexpressions as "referenced".
8151void Sema::MarkDeclarationsReferencedInExpr(Expr *E) {
8152 EvaluatedExprMarker(*this).Visit(E);
8153}
8154
Douglas Gregorda8cdbc2009-12-22 01:01:55 +00008155/// \brief Emit a diagnostic that describes an effect on the run-time behavior
8156/// of the program being compiled.
8157///
8158/// This routine emits the given diagnostic when the code currently being
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00008159/// type-checked is "potentially evaluated", meaning that there is a
Douglas Gregorda8cdbc2009-12-22 01:01:55 +00008160/// possibility that the code will actually be executable. Code in sizeof()
8161/// expressions, code used only during overload resolution, etc., are not
8162/// potentially evaluated. This routine will suppress such diagnostics or,
8163/// in the absolutely nutty case of potentially potentially evaluated
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00008164/// expressions (C++ typeid), queue the diagnostic to potentially emit it
Douglas Gregorda8cdbc2009-12-22 01:01:55 +00008165/// later.
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00008166///
Douglas Gregorda8cdbc2009-12-22 01:01:55 +00008167/// This routine should be used for all diagnostics that describe the run-time
8168/// behavior of a program, such as passing a non-POD value through an ellipsis.
8169/// Failure to do so will likely result in spurious diagnostics or failures
8170/// during overload resolution or within sizeof/alignof/typeof/typeid.
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00008171bool Sema::DiagRuntimeBehavior(SourceLocation Loc,
Douglas Gregorda8cdbc2009-12-22 01:01:55 +00008172 const PartialDiagnostic &PD) {
8173 switch (ExprEvalContexts.back().Context ) {
8174 case Unevaluated:
8175 // The argument will never be evaluated, so don't complain.
8176 break;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00008177
Douglas Gregorda8cdbc2009-12-22 01:01:55 +00008178 case PotentiallyEvaluated:
Douglas Gregor8a01b2a2010-09-11 20:24:53 +00008179 case PotentiallyEvaluatedIfUsed:
Douglas Gregorda8cdbc2009-12-22 01:01:55 +00008180 Diag(Loc, PD);
8181 return true;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00008182
Douglas Gregorda8cdbc2009-12-22 01:01:55 +00008183 case PotentiallyPotentiallyEvaluated:
8184 ExprEvalContexts.back().addDiagnostic(Loc, PD);
8185 break;
8186 }
8187
8188 return false;
8189}
8190
Anders Carlsson7f84ed92009-10-09 23:51:55 +00008191bool Sema::CheckCallReturnType(QualType ReturnType, SourceLocation Loc,
8192 CallExpr *CE, FunctionDecl *FD) {
8193 if (ReturnType->isVoidType() || !ReturnType->isIncompleteType())
8194 return false;
8195
8196 PartialDiagnostic Note =
8197 FD ? PDiag(diag::note_function_with_incomplete_return_type_declared_here)
8198 << FD->getDeclName() : PDiag();
8199 SourceLocation NoteLoc = FD ? FD->getLocation() : SourceLocation();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00008200
Anders Carlsson7f84ed92009-10-09 23:51:55 +00008201 if (RequireCompleteType(Loc, ReturnType,
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00008202 FD ?
Anders Carlsson7f84ed92009-10-09 23:51:55 +00008203 PDiag(diag::err_call_function_incomplete_return)
8204 << CE->getSourceRange() << FD->getDeclName() :
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00008205 PDiag(diag::err_call_incomplete_return)
Anders Carlsson7f84ed92009-10-09 23:51:55 +00008206 << CE->getSourceRange(),
8207 std::make_pair(NoteLoc, Note)))
8208 return true;
8209
8210 return false;
8211}
8212
John McCalld5707ab2009-10-12 21:59:07 +00008213// Diagnose the common s/=/==/ typo. Note that adding parentheses
8214// will prevent this condition from triggering, which is what we want.
8215void Sema::DiagnoseAssignmentAsCondition(Expr *E) {
8216 SourceLocation Loc;
8217
John McCall0506e4a2009-11-11 02:41:58 +00008218 unsigned diagnostic = diag::warn_condition_is_assignment;
8219
John McCalld5707ab2009-10-12 21:59:07 +00008220 if (isa<BinaryOperator>(E)) {
8221 BinaryOperator *Op = cast<BinaryOperator>(E);
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00008222 if (Op->getOpcode() != BO_Assign)
John McCalld5707ab2009-10-12 21:59:07 +00008223 return;
8224
John McCallb0e419e2009-11-12 00:06:05 +00008225 // Greylist some idioms by putting them into a warning subcategory.
8226 if (ObjCMessageExpr *ME
8227 = dyn_cast<ObjCMessageExpr>(Op->getRHS()->IgnoreParenCasts())) {
8228 Selector Sel = ME->getSelector();
8229
John McCallb0e419e2009-11-12 00:06:05 +00008230 // self = [<foo> init...]
8231 if (isSelfExpr(Op->getLHS())
8232 && Sel.getIdentifierInfoForSlot(0)->getName().startswith("init"))
8233 diagnostic = diag::warn_condition_is_idiomatic_assignment;
8234
8235 // <foo> = [<bar> nextObject]
8236 else if (Sel.isUnarySelector() &&
8237 Sel.getIdentifierInfoForSlot(0)->getName() == "nextObject")
8238 diagnostic = diag::warn_condition_is_idiomatic_assignment;
8239 }
John McCall0506e4a2009-11-11 02:41:58 +00008240
John McCalld5707ab2009-10-12 21:59:07 +00008241 Loc = Op->getOperatorLoc();
8242 } else if (isa<CXXOperatorCallExpr>(E)) {
8243 CXXOperatorCallExpr *Op = cast<CXXOperatorCallExpr>(E);
8244 if (Op->getOperator() != OO_Equal)
8245 return;
8246
8247 Loc = Op->getOperatorLoc();
8248 } else {
8249 // Not an assignment.
8250 return;
8251 }
8252
John McCalld5707ab2009-10-12 21:59:07 +00008253 SourceLocation Open = E->getSourceRange().getBegin();
John McCalle724ae92009-10-12 22:25:59 +00008254 SourceLocation Close = PP.getLocForEndOfToken(E->getSourceRange().getEnd());
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00008255
Douglas Gregor2bf2d3d2010-04-14 16:09:52 +00008256 Diag(Loc, diagnostic) << E->getSourceRange();
Douglas Gregorfa1e36d2010-01-08 00:20:23 +00008257 Diag(Loc, diag::note_condition_assign_to_comparison)
Douglas Gregora771f462010-03-31 17:46:05 +00008258 << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(Loc, "==");
Douglas Gregor2bf2d3d2010-04-14 16:09:52 +00008259 Diag(Loc, diag::note_condition_assign_silence)
8260 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(Open, "(")
8261 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(Close, ")");
John McCalld5707ab2009-10-12 21:59:07 +00008262}
8263
8264bool Sema::CheckBooleanCondition(Expr *&E, SourceLocation Loc) {
8265 DiagnoseAssignmentAsCondition(E);
8266
8267 if (!E->isTypeDependent()) {
Argyrios Kyrtzidisca766292010-11-01 18:49:26 +00008268 if (E->isBoundMemberFunction(Context))
8269 return Diag(E->getLocStart(), diag::err_invalid_use_of_bound_member_func)
8270 << E->getSourceRange();
8271
Douglas Gregorb92a1562010-02-03 00:27:59 +00008272 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(E);
John McCalld5707ab2009-10-12 21:59:07 +00008273
8274 QualType T = E->getType();
8275
8276 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
8277 if (CheckCXXBooleanCondition(E)) // C++ 6.4p4
8278 return true;
8279 } else if (!T->isScalarType()) { // C99 6.8.4.1p1
8280 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_statement_requires_scalar)
8281 << T << E->getSourceRange();
8282 return true;
8283 }
8284 }
8285
8286 return false;
8287}
Douglas Gregore60e41a2010-05-06 17:25:47 +00008288
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00008289ExprResult Sema::ActOnBooleanCondition(Scope *S, SourceLocation Loc,
8290 Expr *Sub) {
Douglas Gregor12cc7ee2010-05-06 21:39:56 +00008291 if (!Sub)
Douglas Gregore60e41a2010-05-06 17:25:47 +00008292 return ExprError();
8293
Douglas Gregorb412e172010-07-25 18:17:45 +00008294 if (CheckBooleanCondition(Sub, Loc))
Douglas Gregore60e41a2010-05-06 17:25:47 +00008295 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregore60e41a2010-05-06 17:25:47 +00008296
8297 return Owned(Sub);
8298}
John McCall36e7fe32010-10-12 00:20:44 +00008299
8300/// Check for operands with placeholder types and complain if found.
8301/// Returns true if there was an error and no recovery was possible.
8302ExprResult Sema::CheckPlaceholderExpr(Expr *E, SourceLocation Loc) {
8303 const BuiltinType *BT = E->getType()->getAs<BuiltinType>();
8304 if (!BT || !BT->isPlaceholderType()) return Owned(E);
8305
8306 // If this is overload, check for a single overload.
8307 if (BT->getKind() == BuiltinType::Overload) {
8308 if (FunctionDecl *Specialization
8309 = ResolveSingleFunctionTemplateSpecialization(E)) {
8310 // The access doesn't really matter in this case.
8311 DeclAccessPair Found = DeclAccessPair::make(Specialization,
8312 Specialization->getAccess());
8313 E = FixOverloadedFunctionReference(E, Found, Specialization);
8314 if (!E) return ExprError();
8315 return Owned(E);
8316 }
8317
John McCall36226622010-10-12 02:09:17 +00008318 Diag(Loc, diag::err_ovl_unresolvable) << E->getSourceRange();
John McCall36e7fe32010-10-12 00:20:44 +00008319 return ExprError();
8320 }
8321
8322 // Otherwise it's a use of undeduced auto.
8323 assert(BT->getKind() == BuiltinType::UndeducedAuto);
8324
8325 DeclRefExpr *DRE = cast<DeclRefExpr>(E->IgnoreParens());
8326 Diag(Loc, diag::err_auto_variable_cannot_appear_in_own_initializer)
8327 << DRE->getDecl() << E->getSourceRange();
8328 return ExprError();
8329}